| Metamath Proof Explorer Most Recent Proofs |
||
| Mirrors > Home > MPE Home > Th. List > Recent | ILE Most Recent Other > MM 100 | |
The original proofs of theorems with recently shortened proofs can often be found by appending "OLD" to the theorem name, for example 19.43OLD for 19.43. The "OLD" versions are usually deleted after a year.
Other links Email: Norm Megill. Mailing list: Metamath Google Group Updated 7-Dec-2021 . Contributing: How can I contribute to Metamath? Syndication: RSS feed (courtesy of Dan Getz) Related wikis: Ghilbert site; Ghilbert Google Group.
Recent news items (7-Aug-2021) Version 0.198 of the metamath program fixes a bug in "write source ... /rewrap" that prevented end-of-sentence punctuation from appearing in column 79, causing some rewrapped lines to be shorter than necessary. Because this affects about 2000 lines in set.mm, you should use version 0.198 or later for rewrapping before submitting to GitHub.
(7-May-2021) Mario Carneiro has written a Metamath verifier in Lean.
(5-May-2021) Marnix Klooster has written a Metamath verifier in Zig.
(24-Mar-2021) Metamath was mentioned in a couple of articles about OpenAI: Researchers find that large language models struggle with math and What Is GPT-F?.
(26-Dec-2020) Version 0.194 of the metamath program adds the keyword "htmlexturl" to the $t comment to specify external versions of theorem pages. This keyward has been added to set.mm, and you must update your local copy of set.mm for "verify markup" to pass with the new program version.
(19-Dec-2020) Aleksandr A. Adamov has translated the Wikipedia Metamath page into Russian.
(19-Nov-2020) Eric Schmidt's checkmm.cpp was used as a test case for C'est, "a non-standard version of the C++20 standard library, with enhanced support for compile-time evaluation." See C++20 Compile-time Metamath Proof Verification using C'est.
(10-Nov-2020) Filip Cernatescu has updated the XPuzzle (Android app) to version 1.2. XPuzzle is a puzzle with math formulas derived from the Metamath system. At the bottom of the web page is a link to the Google Play Store, where the app can be found.
(7-Nov-2020) Richard Penner created a cross-reference guide between Frege's logic notation and the notation used by set.mm.
(4-Sep-2020) Version 0.192 of the metamath program adds the qualifier '/extract' to 'write source'. See 'help write source' and also this Google Group post.
(23-Aug-2020) Version 0.188 of the metamath program adds keywords Conclusion, Fact, Introduction, Paragraph, Scolia, Scolion, Subsection, and Table to bibliographic references. See 'help write bibliography' for the complete current list.
| Color key: |
| Date | Label | Description |
|---|---|---|
| Theorem | ||
| 26-May-2026 | axpowg3 35336 | A generalization of ax-pow 5301 that combines axpowg 35334 and axpowg2 35335 into a single theorem scheme. Unlike ax-pow 5301, this scheme lacks a distinct variable condition for 𝑦 and 𝑤 as well as for 𝑥 and 𝑤. Usage of this theorem is discouraged because it depends on ax-13 2380. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 26-May-2026.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦∀𝑧(∀𝑤(𝑤 ∈ 𝑧 → 𝑤 ∈ 𝑥) → 𝑧 ∈ 𝑦) | ||
| 26-May-2026 | axpowg2 35335 | A generalization of ax-pow 5301 in which 𝑥 and 𝑤 need not be distinct. This theorem scheme bundles ax-pow 5301 with the degenerate instance ∃𝑦∀𝑧(∀𝑥(𝑥 ∈ 𝑧 → 𝑥 ∈ 𝑥) → 𝑧 ∈ 𝑦) which is satisfied by the existence of a set that contains all empty sets (see axprlem1 5359). Usage of this theorem is discouraged because it depends on ax-13 2380. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 26-May-2026.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦∀𝑧(∀𝑤(𝑤 ∈ 𝑧 → 𝑤 ∈ 𝑥) → 𝑧 ∈ 𝑦) | ||
| 26-May-2026 | axpowg 35334 | A generalization of ax-pow 5301 that combines it and zfpow 5302 into a single theorem scheme. Unlike ax-pow 5301, this scheme lacks a distinct variable condition for 𝑦 and 𝑤. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 26-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦∀𝑧(∀𝑤(𝑤 ∈ 𝑧 → 𝑤 ∈ 𝑥) → 𝑧 ∈ 𝑦) | ||
| 25-May-2026 | expt 177 | Exportation theorem pm3.3 449 (closed form of ex 413) expressed with primitive connectives. (Contributed by NM, 28-Dec-1992.) (Proof shortened by Garrett Katz, 25-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((¬ (𝜑 → ¬ 𝜓) → 𝜒) → (𝜑 → (𝜓 → 𝜒))) | ||
| 24-May-2026 | axsepg5 35332 | A generalization of ax-sep 5225 that combines axsepg 5226, axsepg2 35328, and axsepg3 35329 into a single theorem scheme. Unlike ax-sep 5225, this scheme lacks a distinct variable condition for 𝜑 and 𝑧, for 𝑥 and 𝑧, and for 𝑦 and 𝑧. Usage of this theorem is discouraged because it depends on ax-13 2380. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 24-May-2026.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦∀𝑥(𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 ↔ (𝑥 ∈ 𝑧 ∧ 𝜑)) | ||
| 24-May-2026 | axsepg4 35331 | A generalization of ax-sep 5225 that combines axsepg 5226 and axsepg2 35328 into a single theorem scheme. Unlike ax-sep 5225, this scheme lacks a distinct variable condition for 𝜑 and 𝑧 as well as for 𝑥 and 𝑧. Usage of this theorem is discouraged because it depends on ax-13 2380. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 24-May-2026.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦∀𝑥(𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 ↔ (𝑥 ∈ 𝑧 ∧ 𝜑)) | ||
| 23-May-2026 | elirrv 9509 | The membership relation is irreflexive: no set is a member of itself. Theorem 105 of [Suppes] p. 54. This is trivial to prove from zfregfr 9523 and efrirr 5605 (see elirrvALT 9524), but this proof is direct from ax-reg 9504. (Contributed by NM, 19-Aug-1993.) Reduce axiom dependencies and make use of ax-reg 9504 directly. (Revised by BTernaryTau, 27-Dec-2025.) Avoid ax-pr 5369. (Revised by BTernaryTau, 21-May-2026.) (Proof shortened by Matthew House, 23-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ ¬ 𝑥 ∈ 𝑥 | ||
| 22-May-2026 | bilanri 507 | Inference adding a conjunct to the right-hand side of a biconditional. (Contributed by Matthew House, 22-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 ↔ 𝜓) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝜒 ∧ 𝜓) → 𝜑) | ||
| 22-May-2026 | biranri 506 | Inference adding a conjunct to the right-hand side of a biconditional. (Contributed by Matthew House, 22-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 ↔ 𝜓) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝜓 ∧ 𝜒) → 𝜑) | ||
| 22-May-2026 | bilani 505 | Inference adding a conjunct to the left-hand side of a biconditional. (Contributed by Matthew House, 22-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 ↔ 𝜓) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝜒 ∧ 𝜑) → 𝜓) | ||
| 22-May-2026 | birani 504 | Inference adding a conjunct to the left-hand side of a biconditional. (Contributed by Matthew House, 22-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 ↔ 𝜓) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝜒) → 𝜓) | ||
| 21-May-2026 | axsepg2 35328 | A generalization of ax-sep 5225 in which 𝑥 and 𝑧 need not be distinct. This theorem scheme bundles ax-sep 5225 with the degenerate instance ∃𝑦∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 ↔ (𝑧 ∈ 𝑧 ∧ 𝜑)) which is satisfied by the existence of the empty set. Usage of this theorem is discouraged because it depends on ax-13 2380. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 21-May-2026.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦∀𝑥(𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 ↔ (𝑥 ∈ 𝑧 ∧ 𝜑)) | ||
| 9-May-2026 | goldratmolem2 47356 | Lemma 2 for determining the value of golden ratio. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 9-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐹 = (2 · (cos‘(π / 5))) ⇒ ⊢ -1 = ((((𝐹↑5) / 2) − (5 · ((𝐹↑3) / 2))) + (5 · (𝐹 / 2))) | ||
| 9-May-2026 | goldracos5teq 47355 | Lemma 1 for determining the value of golden ratio. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 9-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐹 = (2 · (cos‘(π / 5))) ⇒ ⊢ (cos‘π) = (((;16 · ((𝐹 / 2)↑5)) − (;20 · ((𝐹 / 2)↑3))) + (5 · (𝐹 / 2))) | ||
| 9-May-2026 | cos5teq 47350 | Five-times-angle formula for cosine, substitution helper. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 9-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℂ ∧ 𝐵 = (5 · 𝐴) ∧ 𝐶 = (cos‘𝐴)) → (cos‘𝐵) = (((;16 · (𝐶↑5)) − (;20 · (𝐶↑3))) + (5 · 𝐶))) | ||
| 9-May-2026 | quantgodel 47324 | There can be no formula asserting its own non-universality, in parallel to bj-babygodel 36921; proof path is shorter but relying on a property of specialization which provability predicates do not have. For a matching proof, see quantgodelALT 47325. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 9-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 ↔ ¬ ∀𝑥𝜑) ⇒ ⊢ ⊥ | ||
| 9-May-2026 | funopsn 7097 | If a function is an ordered pair then it is a singleton of an ordered pair. (Contributed by AV, 20-Sep-2020.) (Proof shortened by AV, 15-Jul-2021.) (Proof shortened by Eric Schmidt, 9-May-2026.) A function is a class of ordered pairs, so the fact that an ordered pair may sometimes be itself a function is an "accident" depending on the specific encoding of ordered pairs as classes (in set.mm, the Kuratowski encoding). A more meaningful statement is funsng 6543, as relsnopg 5753 is to relop 5799. (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ 𝑋 ∈ V & ⊢ 𝑌 ∈ V ⇒ ⊢ ((Fun 𝐹 ∧ 𝐹 = 〈𝑋, 𝑌〉) → ∃𝑎(𝑋 = {𝑎} ∧ 𝐹 = {〈𝑎, 𝑎〉})) | ||
| 9-May-2026 | iunopeqop 5469 | Implication of an ordered pair being equal to an indexed union of singletons of ordered pairs. (Contributed by AV, 20-Sep-2020.) Remove antecedent. (Revised by Eric Schmidt, 9-May-2026.) (Avoid depending on this detail.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 ∈ V & ⊢ 𝐶 ∈ V & ⊢ 𝐷 ∈ V ⇒ ⊢ (∪ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 {〈𝑥, 𝐵〉} = 〈𝐶, 𝐷〉 → ∃𝑧 𝐴 = {𝑧}) | ||
| 7-May-2026 | quantgodelALT 47325 | There can be no formula asserting its own non-universality; follows the steps of bj-babygodel 36921. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 7-May-2026.) (New usage is discouraged.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 ↔ ¬ ∀𝑥𝜑) ⇒ ⊢ ⊥ | ||
| 4-May-2026 | mplidom 33719 | The multivariate polynomials over an integral domain form an integral domain. See ply1idom 26115. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 4-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑃 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ IDomn) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑃 ∈ IDomn) | ||
| 4-May-2026 | mplidomlem 33718 | Lemma for mplidom 33719. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 4-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑃 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ IDomn) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (𝑓 ∈ 𝐶 ↦ (𝑛 ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 1o) ↦ (((((𝑗 ∪ {𝑥}) selectVars 𝑅)‘{𝑥})‘𝑓)‘{〈𝑥, (𝑛‘∅)〉}))) & ⊢ 𝐶 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ 𝑆 = ((𝑗 ∪ {𝑥}) mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑈 = (((𝑗 ∪ {𝑥}) ∖ {𝑥}) mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (Poly1‘𝑈) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑃 ∈ IDomn) | ||
| 4-May-2026 | selvply1rhm0 33717 | The ring homomorphism 𝐻 built in selvply1rhm 33716 is injective. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 4-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑈 = ((𝐼 ∖ {𝑋}) mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (Poly1‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (𝑓 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ (𝑛 ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 1o) ↦ ((((𝐼 selectVars 𝑅)‘{𝑋})‘𝑓)‘{〈𝑋, (𝑛‘∅)〉}))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝑍 = (0g‘𝑃) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐻‘𝐹) = 0 ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = 𝑍) | ||
| 4-May-2026 | selvply1rhm 33716 | Build a ring homomorphism 𝐻 between the multivariate polynomials 𝑃 with variables in 𝐼 and the univariate polynomials 𝑄 in a single variable 𝑋 element of 𝐼. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 4-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑈 = ((𝐼 ∖ {𝑋}) mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (Poly1‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (𝑓 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ (𝑛 ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 1o) ↦ ((((𝐼 selectVars 𝑅)‘{𝑋})‘𝑓)‘{〈𝑋, (𝑛‘∅)〉}))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ CRing) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐻 ∈ (𝑃 RingHom 𝑄)) | ||
| 4-May-2026 | selvply1rhmlem5 33715 | Lemma for selvply1rhm 33716. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 4-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑈 = ((𝐼 ∖ {𝑋}) mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (Poly1‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (𝑓 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ (𝑛 ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 1o) ↦ ((((𝐼 selectVars 𝑅)‘{𝑋})‘𝑓)‘{〈𝑋, (𝑛‘∅)〉}))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (𝑞 ∈ (Base‘({𝑋} mPoly 𝑈)) ↦ (𝑠 ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 1o) ↦ (𝑞‘{〈𝑋, (𝑠‘∅)〉}))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐻‘𝐹) = (𝑀‘(((𝐼 selectVars 𝑅)‘{𝑋})‘𝐹))) | ||
| 4-May-2026 | selvply1rhmlem4 33714 | Lemma for selvply1rhm 33716: The mapping 𝐻 is linear. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 4-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑈 = ((𝐼 ∖ {𝑋}) mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (Poly1‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (𝑓 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ (𝑛 ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 1o) ↦ ((((𝐼 selectVars 𝑅)‘{𝑋})‘𝑓)‘{〈𝑋, (𝑛‘∅)〉}))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐻‘(𝐹(+g‘𝑃)𝐺)) = ((𝐻‘𝐹)(+g‘𝑄)(𝐻‘𝐺))) | ||
| 4-May-2026 | selvply1rhmlem3 33713 | Lemma for selvply1rhm 33716. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 4-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑈 = ((𝐼 ∖ {𝑋}) mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (Poly1‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (𝑓 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ (𝑛 ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 1o) ↦ ((((𝐼 selectVars 𝑅)‘{𝑋})‘𝑓)‘{〈𝑋, (𝑛‘∅)〉}))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 1o)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐻‘𝐹)‘𝑁) = ((((𝐼 selectVars 𝑅)‘{𝑋})‘𝐹)‘{〈𝑋, (𝑁‘∅)〉})) | ||
| 4-May-2026 | selvply1rhmlem2 33712 | Lemma for selvply1rhm 33716: Image of the ring unit by the mapping 𝐻 (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 4-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑈 = ((𝐼 ∖ {𝑋}) mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (Poly1‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (𝑓 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ (𝑛 ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 1o) ↦ ((((𝐼 selectVars 𝑅)‘{𝑋})‘𝑓)‘{〈𝑋, (𝑛‘∅)〉}))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ CRing) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐻‘(1r‘𝑃)) = (1r‘𝑄)) | ||
| 4-May-2026 | selvply1rhmlem1 33711 | Lemma for selvply1rhm 33716. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 4-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑈 = ((𝐼 ∖ {𝑋}) mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (Poly1‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (𝑓 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ (𝑛 ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 1o) ↦ ((((𝐼 selectVars 𝑅)‘{𝑋})‘𝑓)‘{〈𝑋, (𝑛‘∅)〉}))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ CRing) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐻:𝐵⟶(Base‘𝑄)) | ||
| 4-May-2026 | selvply1rhmlemb 33710 | Lemma for selvply1rhm 33716. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 4-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑃 = ({𝑋} mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑃) & ⊢ × = (.r‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (Poly1‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (𝑓 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ (𝑛 ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 1o) ↦ (𝑓‘{〈𝑋, (𝑛‘∅)〉}))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑀‘(𝐹 · 𝐺)) = ((𝑀‘𝐹) × (𝑀‘𝐺))) | ||
| 4-May-2026 | selvply1rhmlema 33709 | Lemma for selvply1rhm 33716. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 4-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑃 = ({𝑋} mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑃) & ⊢ × = (.r‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (Poly1‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (𝑓 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ (𝑛 ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 1o) ↦ (𝑓‘{〈𝑋, (𝑛‘∅)〉}))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑀‘𝐹) ∈ (Base‘𝑄)) | ||
| 4-May-2026 | selvascl 33708 | The "variable selection" function evaluated at a scalar. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 4-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (algSc‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝐶 = (algSc‘𝑇) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ 𝑈 = ((𝐼 ∖ 𝐽) mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑇 = (𝐽 mPoly 𝑈) & ⊢ 𝐷 = (𝐶 ∘ (algSc‘𝑈)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐽 ⊆ 𝐼) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (((𝐼 selectVars 𝑅)‘𝐽)‘(𝐴‘𝑋)) = (𝐷‘𝑋)) | ||
| 4-May-2026 | mplasclco 33707 | Case where composing an algebra scalar lifting functions with a scalar leads to a scalar. This is useful when working with selectVars. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 4-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑂 = (𝐽 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑂) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (algSc‘𝑂) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (algSc‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝐶 = (algSc‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ (◡ℎ “ ℕ) ∈ Fin} & ⊢ 𝐸 = {𝑗 ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐽) ∣ (◡𝑗 “ ℕ) ∈ Fin} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐽 ⊆ 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝑆) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 ∘ (𝐵‘𝑋)) = (𝐶‘(𝐴‘𝑋))) | ||
| 4-May-2026 | 0mplric 33706 | Multivariate polynomials with no variables are isomorphic with the underlying ring. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 4-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (∅ mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑃 ≃𝑟 𝑅) | ||
| 4-May-2026 | 0mplrim 33705 | Build a ring isomorphism between multivariate polynomials with no variables and the underlying ring. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 4-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (∅ mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑝 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ (𝑝‘∅)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑃 RingIso 𝑅)) | ||
| 4-May-2026 | mplnzr 33704 | The multivariate polynomials over a nonzero ring form a nonzero ring. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 4-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑃 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ NzRing) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑃 ∈ NzRing) | ||
| 4-May-2026 | psrnzr 33703 | The ring of power series over a nonzero ring form a nonzero ring. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 4-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (𝐼 mPwSer 𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ NzRing) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑆 ∈ NzRing) | ||
| 4-May-2026 | ricdomn 33378 | A ring is a domain if and only if an isomorphic ring is a domain. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 4-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ≃𝑟 𝑆 → (𝑅 ∈ Domn ↔ 𝑆 ∈ Domn)) | ||
| 4-May-2026 | ricdomn1 33377 | A ring isomorphism maps a domain to a domain. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 4-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑅 ≃𝑟 𝑆 ∧ 𝑅 ∈ Domn) → 𝑆 ∈ Domn) | ||
| 4-May-2026 | ricnzr1 33376 | A ring isomorphism maps a nonzero ring to a nonzero ring. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 4-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑅 ≃𝑟 𝑆 ∧ 𝑅 ∈ NzRing) → 𝑆 ∈ NzRing) | ||
| 4-May-2026 | grpidcld 33126 | The identity element of a group belongs to the group. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 4-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ Grp) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 0 ∈ 𝐵) | ||
| 4-May-2026 | ififcom 32645 | Commute two nested conditionals. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 4-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ if(𝜑, if(𝜓, 𝐴, 𝐵), 𝐵) = if(𝜓, if(𝜑, 𝐴, 𝐵), 𝐵) | ||
| 2-May-2026 | copsexgw 5437 | Version of copsexg 5439 with a disjoint variable condition, which does not require ax-13 2380. (Contributed by GG, 26-Jan-2024.) Shorten proof and remove dependency on ax-10 2152. (Revised by Eric Schmidt, 2-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 = 〈𝑥, 𝑦〉 → (𝜑 ↔ ∃𝑥∃𝑦(𝐴 = 〈𝑥, 𝑦〉 ∧ 𝜑))) | ||
| 1-May-2026 | vprc 5249 | The universal class is not a member of itself (and thus is not a set). Proposition 5.21 of [TakeutiZaring] p. 21; our proof, however, does not depend on the Axiom of Regularity. (Contributed by NM, 23-Aug-1993.) (Proof shortened by BJ, 1-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ ¬ V ∈ V | ||
| 1-May-2026 | nvel 5248 | The universal class does not belong to any class. (Contributed by FL, 31-Dec-2006.) Prove it without using vprc 5249, which is then proved as an instance of it. (Revised by BJ, 1-May-2026.) |
| ⊢ ¬ V ∈ 𝐴 | ||
| 27-Apr-2026 | qdiffALT 37695 | Alternate proof of qdiff 37694. This is a proof from irrdiff 37693 using excluded middle in a variety of places. (Contributed by Jim Kingdon, 27-Apr-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℝ → (𝐴 ∈ ℚ ↔ ∃𝑞 ∈ ℚ ∃𝑟 ∈ ℚ (𝑞 ≠ 𝑟 ∧ (abs‘(𝐴 − 𝑞)) = (abs‘(𝐴 − 𝑟))))) | ||
| 25-Apr-2026 | unidif0 5295 | The removal of the empty set from a class does not affect its union. (Contributed by NM, 22-Mar-2004.) (Proof shortened by Eric Schmidt, 25-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∪ (𝐴 ∖ {∅}) = ∪ 𝐴 | ||
| 25-Apr-2026 | vnex 5246 | The universal class does not exist as a set. (Contributed by NM, 4-Jul-2005.) (Proof shortened by BJ, 25-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ¬ ∃𝑥 𝑥 = V | ||
| 25-Apr-2026 | vneqv 5245 | The universal class is not equal to any setvar. (Contributed by NM, 4-Jul-2005.) Extract from vnex 5246 and shorten proof. (Revised by BJ, 25-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ¬ 𝑥 = V | ||
| 24-Apr-2026 | qdiff 37694 | The rationals are exactly those reals for which there exist two distinct rationals that are the same distance from the original number. Similar to irrdiff 37693 but here proved with a proof which would also work in constructive mathematics. From an online post by Ingo Blechschmidt. For a proof using irrdiff 37693, see qdiffALT 37695. (Contributed by Jim Kingdon, 24-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℝ → (𝐴 ∈ ℚ ↔ ∃𝑞 ∈ ℚ ∃𝑟 ∈ ℚ (𝑞 ≠ 𝑟 ∧ (abs‘(𝐴 − 𝑞)) = (abs‘(𝐴 − 𝑟))))) | ||
| 22-Apr-2026 | sucprcreg 9518 | A class is equal to its successor iff it is a proper class (assuming the Axiom of Regularity). (Contributed by NM, 9-Jul-2004.) (Proof shortened by BJ, 16-Apr-2019.) (Proof shortened by SN, 22-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (¬ 𝐴 ∈ V ↔ suc 𝐴 = 𝐴) | ||
| 22-Apr-2026 | nelaneq 9514 | A class is not an element of and equal to a class at the same time. Variant of elneq 9513 analogously to elnotel 9529 and en2lp 9525. (Proposed by BJ, 18-Jun-2022.) (Contributed by AV, 18-Jun-2022.) (Proof shortened by TM, 31-Dec-2025.) (Proof shortened by SN, 22-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ¬ (𝐴 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ 𝐴 = 𝐵) | ||
| 20-Apr-2026 | cos5t 47349 | Five-times-angle formula for cosine, in pure cosine form. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℂ → (cos‘(5 · 𝐴)) = (((;16 · ((cos‘𝐴)↑5)) − (;20 · ((cos‘𝐴)↑3))) + (5 · (cos‘𝐴)))) | ||
| 19-Apr-2026 | trun 5197 | The union of transitive classes is transitive. (Contributed by Eric Schmidt, 19-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((Tr 𝐴 ∧ Tr 𝐵) → Tr (𝐴 ∪ 𝐵)) | ||
| 17-Apr-2026 | sin5t 47348 | Five-times-angle formula for sine, in pure sine form. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 17-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℂ → (sin‘(5 · 𝐴)) = (((;16 · ((sin‘𝐴)↑5)) − (;20 · ((sin‘𝐴)↑3))) + (5 · (sin‘𝐴)))) | ||
| 17-Apr-2026 | sin5tlem5 47347 | Lemma 5 for quintupled angle sine calculation: sine of triple-angle and double-angle sum, as a polynomial in sine straight. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 17-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ ℂ ∧ 𝑀 ∈ ℂ ∧ (𝑁↑2) = (1 − (𝑀↑2))) → ((((3 · 𝑀) − (4 · (𝑀↑3))) · (1 − (2 · (𝑀↑2)))) + (((4 · (𝑁↑3)) − (3 · 𝑁)) · (2 · (𝑀 · 𝑁)))) = (((;16 · (𝑀↑5)) − (;20 · (𝑀↑3))) + (5 · 𝑀))) | ||
| 17-Apr-2026 | sin5tlem4 47346 | Lemma 4 for quintupled angle sine calculation: expanding lemma 3 result to difference of polynomials. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 17-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ ℂ ∧ 𝑀 ∈ ℂ ∧ (𝑁↑2) = (1 − (𝑀↑2))) → (((4 · (𝑁↑3)) − (3 · 𝑁)) · (2 · (𝑀 · 𝑁))) = ((((8 · (𝑀↑5)) − (;16 · (𝑀↑3))) + (8 · 𝑀)) − ((6 · 𝑀) − (6 · (𝑀↑3))))) | ||
| 16-Apr-2026 | goldrarp 47354 | The golden ratio is a positive real. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 16-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐹 = (2 · (cos‘(π / 5))) ⇒ ⊢ 𝐹 ∈ ℝ+ | ||
| 16-Apr-2026 | goldrapos 47353 | Golden ratio is positive. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 16-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐹 = (2 · (cos‘(π / 5))) ⇒ ⊢ 0 < 𝐹 | ||
| 16-Apr-2026 | sin5tlem3 47345 | Lemma 3 for quintupled angle sine calculation, multiplicating triple angle cosine by double angle sine. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 16-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ ℂ ∧ 𝑀 ∈ ℂ ∧ (𝑁↑2) = (1 − (𝑀↑2))) → (((4 · (𝑁↑3)) − (3 · 𝑁)) · (2 · (𝑀 · 𝑁))) = (((4 · ((1 − (2 · (𝑀↑2))) + (𝑀↑4))) − (3 · (1 − (𝑀↑2)))) · (2 · 𝑀))) | ||
| 16-Apr-2026 | sin5tlem2 47344 | Lemma 2 for quintupled angle sine calculation, multiplicating triple angle cosine by cosine straight and converting into sine. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 16-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ ℂ ∧ 𝑀 ∈ ℂ ∧ (𝑁↑2) = (1 − (𝑀↑2))) → (((4 · (𝑁↑3)) − (3 · 𝑁)) · 𝑁) = ((4 · ((1 − (2 · (𝑀↑2))) + (𝑀↑4))) − (3 · (1 − (𝑀↑2))))) | ||
| 13-Apr-2026 | wl-dfclel 37884 | The defining characterization of class membership. Unlike the forms on which it is based, it is unrestricted. Proven in Tarski's FOL, from the axiom of (set) extensionality (ax-ext 2712), the definitions df-clel 2815 and df-cleq . (Contributed by BJ, 27-Jun-2019.) Base on wl-dfclel.just 37882. (Revised by Wolf Lammen, 13-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝐵 ↔ ∃𝑥(𝑥 = 𝐴 ∧ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐵)) | ||
| 13-Apr-2026 | mh-infprim3bi 36783 | An axiom of infinity in primitive symbols not requiring ax-reg 9504. This version of the axiom was designed by Stefan O'Rear for his zf2.nql program, see https://github.com/sorear/metamath-turing-machines 9504. It directly implies ax-inf 9557, but deriving ax-inf2 9560 requires ax-ext 2712 and ax-rep 5206, see mh-inf3sn 36777. (Contributed by Matthew House, 13-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑦(𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 ∧ ∀𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 {𝑧} ∈ 𝑦) ↔ ¬ ∀𝑦 ¬ ¬ (𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ ∀𝑥(𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ ∀𝑧 ¬ ¬ (𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ ∀𝑦 ¬ ((𝑦 ∈ 𝑧 → 𝑦 = 𝑥) → ¬ (𝑦 = 𝑥 → 𝑦 ∈ 𝑧)))))) | ||
| 13-Apr-2026 | mh-infprim2bi 36782 | Shortest possible axiom of infinity in primitive symbols not requiring ax-reg 9504. Deriving ax-inf 9557 or ax-inf2 9560 from this axiom requires ax-ext 2712 and ax-rep 5206, see mh-inf3sn 36777 and inf0 9540. (Contributed by Matthew House, 13-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥(∅ ∈ 𝑥 ∧ ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 {𝑦} ∈ 𝑥) ↔ ¬ ∀𝑥 ¬ ∀𝑦∀𝑧(∀𝑤(𝑤 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ (𝑤 ∈ 𝑥 → ¬ 𝑤 = 𝑧)) → 𝑦 ∈ 𝑥)) | ||
| 13-Apr-2026 | mh-infprim1bi 36781 | Shortest possible axiom of infinity in primitive symbols. Deriving ax-inf 9557 or ax-inf2 9560 from this axiom requires ax-ext 2712, ax-rep 5206, and ax-reg 9504, see inf3 9554 and inf0 9540. (Contributed by Matthew House, 13-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥(𝑥 ≠ ∅ ∧ 𝑥 ⊆ ∪ 𝑥) ↔ ¬ ∀𝑥 ¬ ∀𝑦 ¬ ∀𝑧((𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 → 𝑦 ∈ 𝑧) → ¬ 𝑧 ∈ 𝑥)) | ||
| 13-Apr-2026 | mh-regprimbi 36780 | Shortest possible version of ax-reg 9504 in primitive symbols. The equivalence is nontrivial, but it still follows solely from the axioms of predicate calculus. (Contributed by Matthew House, 13-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((∃𝑦 𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 → ∃𝑦(𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ 𝑧 ∈ 𝑥))) ↔ ¬ ∀𝑦 ¬ ∀𝑧((𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 → 𝑧 ∈ 𝑦) → ¬ 𝑧 ∈ 𝑥)) | ||
| 13-Apr-2026 | mh-unprimbi 36779 | Shortest possible version of ax-un 7685 in primitive symbols. (Contributed by Matthew House, 13-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑦∀𝑧(∃𝑤(𝑧 ∈ 𝑤 ∧ 𝑤 ∈ 𝑥) → 𝑧 ∈ 𝑦) ↔ ¬ ∀𝑦 ¬ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑥 → ∀𝑤(𝑤 ∈ 𝑧 → 𝑤 ∈ 𝑦))) | ||
| 13-Apr-2026 | mh-prprimbi 36778 | Shortest possible version of ax-pr 5369 in primitive symbols. (Contributed by Matthew House, 13-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑧∀𝑤((𝑤 = 𝑥 ∨ 𝑤 = 𝑦) → 𝑤 ∈ 𝑧) ↔ ¬ ∀𝑧(𝑥 ∈ 𝑧 → ¬ 𝑦 ∈ 𝑧)) | ||
| 13-Apr-2026 | mh-inf3sn 36777 | Version of inf3 9554 for the set of Zermelo ordinals ∅, {∅}, {{∅}}, {{{∅}}}, etc., where the successor of 𝑦 is {𝑦}. Unlike inf3 9554, the proof does not require ax-reg 9504, since the singleton properties snnz 4715 and sneqr 4778 are sufficient to guarantee that all elements of the sequence are distinct. (Contributed by Matthew House, 13-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑥(∅ ∈ 𝑥 ∧ ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 {𝑦} ∈ 𝑥) ⇒ ⊢ ω ∈ V | ||
| 13-Apr-2026 | mh-inf3f1 36776 | A variant of inf3 9554. If 𝐹 is a one-to-one function from 𝐴 into itself, and there exists an element 𝐵 not in its range, then (rec(𝐹, 𝐵) ↾ ω) is an infinite sequence of distinct elements from 𝐴. If 𝐴 is a set, we can use this theorem to prove ω ∈ V via f1dmex 7906. (Contributed by Matthew House, 13-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝐴–1-1→𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ (𝐴 ∖ ran 𝐹)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (rec(𝐹, 𝐵) ↾ ω):ω–1-1→𝐴) | ||
| 12-Apr-2026 | nalset 5243 | No set contains all sets. Theorem 41 of [Suppes] p. 30. (Contributed by NM, 23-Aug-1993.) Extract exnelv 5242. (Revised by Matthew House, 12-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ¬ ∃𝑥∀𝑦 𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 | ||
| 12-Apr-2026 | exnelv 5242 | For any set 𝑥, there is a set not contained in 𝑥. The proof is based on Russell's paradox. (Contributed by NM, 23-Aug-1993.) Remove use of ax-12 2189 and ax-13 2380. (Revised by BJ, 31-May-2019.) Extract from nalset 5243. (Revised by Matthew House, 12-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦 ¬ 𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 | ||
| 11-Apr-2026 | indsum 15789 | Finite sum of a product with the indicator function / Cartesian product with the indicator function. Note: this theorem cannot be efficiently shortened using sumss2 15686, unless there are some additional auxiliary theorems like (if(𝑥 ∈ 𝐴, 1, 0) · 𝐵) = if(𝑥 ∈ 𝐴, 𝐵, 0). (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 14-Aug-2017.) (Proof shortened by AV, 11-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑂 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ⊆ 𝑂) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 ∈ 𝑂) → 𝐵 ∈ ℂ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → Σ𝑥 ∈ 𝑂 ((((𝟭‘𝑂)‘𝐴)‘𝑥) · 𝐵) = Σ𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝐵) | ||
| 11-Apr-2026 | indval0 12161 | The indicator function generator does not generate a (meaningful) indicator function for a class which is not a subset of the domain. (Contributed by AV, 11-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (¬ 𝐴 ⊆ 𝑂 → ((𝟭‘𝑂)‘𝐴) = ∅) | ||
| 10-Apr-2026 | ppivalnn 48117 | Value of the prime-counting function pi for positive integers, according to Ján Mináč, see statement in [Ribenboim], p. 181. (Contributed by AV, 10-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ ℕ → (π‘𝑁) = Σ𝑘 ∈ (2...𝑁)(⌊‘((((!‘(𝑘 − 1)) + 1) / 𝑘) − (⌊‘((!‘(𝑘 − 1)) / 𝑘))))) | ||
| 10-Apr-2026 | ppivalnnprm 48110 | Value of a term of the prime-counting function pi for positive integers, according to Ján Mináč, for a prime number. (Contributed by AV, 10-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑃 ∈ ℙ → (⌊‘((((!‘(𝑃 − 1)) + 1) / 𝑃) − (⌊‘((!‘(𝑃 − 1)) / 𝑃)))) = 1) | ||
| 10-Apr-2026 | flmrecm1 47813 | The floor of an integer minus the reciprocal of a positive integer is the integer minus 1. (Contributed by AV, 10-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑀 ∈ ℤ ∧ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ) → (⌊‘(𝑀 − (1 / 𝑁))) = (𝑀 − 1)) | ||
| 10-Apr-2026 | nnge2recfl0 47812 | The floor of the reciprocal of an integer greater than 1 is 0. (Contributed by AV, 10-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘2) → (⌊‘(1 / 𝑁)) = 0) | ||
| 10-Apr-2026 | prmssuz2 16664 | The primes are integers greater than 1. (Contributed by AV, 10-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ℙ ⊆ (ℤ≥‘2) | ||
| 10-Apr-2026 | indsumhash 15790 | The finite sum of the indicator function is the number of elements of the corresponding subset. (Contributed by AV, 10-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 1 = ((𝟭‘𝑂)‘𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑂 ∈ Fin ∧ 𝐴 ⊆ 𝑂) → Σ𝑘 ∈ 𝑂 ( 1 ‘𝑘) = (♯‘𝐴)) | ||
| 10-Apr-2026 | fsumconst1 15751 | The sum of 1 over a finite set equals the size of the set. (Contributed by AV, 10-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ Fin → Σ𝑘 ∈ 𝐴 1 = (♯‘𝐴)) | ||
| 10-Apr-2026 | nnge2recico01 13458 | The reciprocal of an integer greater than 1 is in the right open interval between 0 and 1. (Contributed by AV, 10-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘2) → (1 / 𝑁) ∈ (0[,)1)) | ||
| 10-Apr-2026 | fvindre 12165 | The range of the indicator function is a subset of ℝ. (Contributed by AV, 10-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (((𝑂 ∈ Fin ∧ 𝐴 ⊆ 𝑂) ∧ 𝑋 ∈ 𝑂) → (((𝟭‘𝑂)‘𝐴)‘𝑋) ∈ ℝ) | ||
| 9-Apr-2026 | rediv11d 42947 | One-to-one relationship for division. (Contributed by SN, 9-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 /ℝ 𝐶) = (𝐵 /ℝ 𝐶) ↔ 𝐴 = 𝐵)) | ||
| 9-Apr-2026 | redivdird 42946 | Distribution of division over addition. (Contributed by SN, 9-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 + 𝐵) /ℝ 𝐶) = ((𝐴 /ℝ 𝐶) + (𝐵 /ℝ 𝐶))) | ||
| 9-Apr-2026 | rediv23d 42945 | A "commutative"/associative law for division. (Contributed by SN, 9-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 · 𝐵) /ℝ 𝐶) = ((𝐴 /ℝ 𝐶) · 𝐵)) | ||
| 9-Apr-2026 | redivrec2d 42944 | Relationship between division and reciprocal. (Contributed by SN, 9-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 /ℝ 𝐵) = ((1 /ℝ 𝐵) · 𝐴)) | ||
| 8-Apr-2026 | ppivalnnnprm 48113 | Value of a term of the prime-counting function pi for positive integers, according to Ján Miná&ccaron, for a non-prime number greater than 1. (Contributed by AV, 8-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘2) ∧ 𝑁 ∉ ℙ) → (⌊‘((((!‘(𝑁 − 1)) + 1) / 𝑁) − (⌊‘((!‘(𝑁 − 1)) / 𝑁)))) = 0) | ||
| 8-Apr-2026 | ppivalnn4 48112 | Value of the term of the prime-counting function pi for positive integers, according to Ján Mináč, for 4. (Contributed by AV, 8-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (⌊‘((((!‘(4 − 1)) + 1) / 4) − (⌊‘((!‘(4 − 1)) / 4)))) = 0 | ||
| 7-Apr-2026 | nprmdvdsfacm1 48109 | A non-prime integer greater than 5 divides the factorial of the integer decreased by 1 (see remark in [Ribenboim] p. 181). Note: not valid for 𝑁 = 4, but for 𝑁 = 1! (Contributed by AV, 7-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘6) ∧ 𝑁 ∉ ℙ) → 𝑁 ∥ (!‘(𝑁 − 1))) | ||
| 7-Apr-2026 | nprmdvdsfacm1lem4 48108 | Lemma 4 for nprmdvdsfacm1 48109. (Contributed by AV, 7-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘6) ∧ 𝐴 ∈ (2..^𝑁) ∧ 𝑁 = (𝐴↑2)) → 𝑁 ∥ (!‘(𝑁 − 1))) | ||
| 7-Apr-2026 | nprmdvdsfacm1lem3 48107 | Lemma 3 for nprmdvdsfacm1 48109. (Contributed by AV, 7-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘6) ∧ 𝐴 ∈ (2..^𝑁) ∧ 𝑁 = (𝐴↑2)) → (2 · 𝐴) < (𝑁 − 1)) | ||
| 7-Apr-2026 | nprmdvdsfacm1lem2 48106 | Lemma 2 for nprmdvdsfacm1 48109. (Contributed by AV, 7-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘6) ∧ 𝐴 ∈ (2..^𝑁) ∧ 𝑁 = (𝐴↑2)) → 3 ≤ 𝐴) | ||
| 7-Apr-2026 | nprmdvdsfacm1lem1 48105 | Lemma 1 for nprmdvdsfacm1 48109. (Contributed by AV, 7-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘6) ∧ 𝐴 ∈ (2..^𝑁) ∧ 𝑁 = (𝐴↑2)) → 𝑁 ∥ (𝐴 · (2 · 𝐴))) | ||
| 7-Apr-2026 | 2timesltsqm1 47849 | Two times an integer greater than 2 is less than the square of the integer minus 1. (Contributed by AV, 7-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ (ℤ≥‘3) → (2 · 𝐴) < ((𝐴↑2) − 1)) | ||
| 7-Apr-2026 | wl-dfcleq 37883 |
The defining characterization of class equality. This version of
df-cleq 2732 has no restrictions, unlike the forms on
which it is based.
It is proved in Tarski's FOL from the axiom of extensionality
(ax-ext 2712), the definition of class equality (df-cleq 2732), and the
definition of class membership (df-clel 2815).
Its forward implication is known as "class extensionality". (Contributed by NM, 15-Sep-1993.) (Revised by BJ, 24-Jun-2019.) Base on wl-dfcleq.just 37879. (Revised by Wolf Lammen, 7-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 = 𝐵 ↔ ∀𝑥(𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ↔ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐵)) | ||
| 7-Apr-2026 | wl-dfclel.just 37882 | Add a hypothesis to wl-dfclel.basic 37881, that permits alpha-renaming. (Contributed by Wolf Lammen, 7-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥(𝑥 = 𝐴 ∧ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐵) ↔ ∃𝑦(𝑦 = 𝐴 ∧ 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝐵 ↔ ∃𝑥(𝑥 = 𝐴 ∧ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐵)) | ||
| 7-Apr-2026 | wl-dfcleq.just 37879 |
The hypotheses added to this version of df-cleq 2732 address the following:
1. Equality of classes is an equivalence relation, as expected of equality. 2. Equality of classes obeys the Law of Indiscernibles (Leibniz's Law), and is compatible with class membership. 3. Alpha-renaming is explicitly permitted. (Contributed by Wolf Lammen, 7-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∀𝑥(𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ↔ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐵) ↔ ∀𝑦(𝑦 ∈ 𝐴 ↔ 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵)) & ⊢ 𝐴 = 𝐴 & ⊢ (𝐴 = 𝐵 → (𝐵 = 𝐶 → 𝐶 = 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝐴 = 𝐵 → (𝐴 ∈ 𝐶 → 𝐵 ∈ 𝐶)) & ⊢ (𝐴 = 𝐵 → (𝐶 ∈ 𝐴 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝐵)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐴 = 𝐵 ↔ ∀𝑥(𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ↔ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐵)) | ||
| 7-Apr-2026 | elALTtco 36716 | Derivation of el 5384 from ax-tco 36707. Use el 5384 instead. (Contributed by Matthew House, 7-Apr-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦 𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 | ||
| 7-Apr-2026 | axnulregtco 36715 | Derivation of ax-nul 5235 from ax-reg 9504 and ax-tco 36707. Use ax-nul 5235 instead. (Contributed by Matthew House, 7-Apr-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑥∀𝑦 ¬ 𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 | ||
| 7-Apr-2026 | axtco1 36708 | Strong form of the Axiom of Transitive Containment. See ax-tco 36707 for more information. In particular, this theorem generalizes the statement of ax-tco 36707, allowing it to be written with only three variables, since 𝑥 need not be distinct from both 𝑧 and 𝑤. (Contributed by Matthew House, 7-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦(𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ∀𝑤(𝑤 ∈ 𝑧 → 𝑤 ∈ 𝑦))) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | nprmmul2 48010 | Special factorization of a non-prime integer greater than 3. (Contributed by AV, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘4) → (𝑁 ∉ ℙ ↔ ∃𝑎 ∈ (2..^𝑁)∃𝑏 ∈ (2..^𝑁)(𝑎 ≤ 𝑏 ∧ 𝑁 = (𝑎 · 𝑏)))) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | muldvdsfacm1 47857 | The product of two different positive integers less than a third integer divides the factorial of the third integer decreased by 1. By assumption, the third integer must be greater than 3. (Contributed by AV, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ (1..^𝐵) ∧ 𝐵 ∈ (1..^𝑁)) → (𝐴 · 𝐵) ∥ (!‘(𝑁 − 1))) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | muldvdsfacgt 47856 | The product of two different positive integers divides the factorial of the bigger integer. (Contributed by AV, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ (1..^𝐵) → (𝐴 · 𝐵) ∥ (!‘𝐵)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | facnn0dvdsfac 47855 | The factorial of a nonnegative integer divides the factorial of an integer which is greater than or equal to the first integer. (Contributed by AV, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑀 ∈ (0...𝑁) → (!‘𝑀) ∥ (!‘𝑁)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | 2timesltsq 47848 | Two times an integer greater than 2 is less than the square of the integer. (Contributed by AV, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ (ℤ≥‘3) → (2 · 𝐴) < (𝐴↑2)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttc0el 36770 | A transitive closure contains ∅ as an element iff it is nonempty, assuming Regularity and Transitive Containment. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ≠ ∅ ↔ ∅ ∈ TC+ 𝐴) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | dfttc3g 36769 | The transitive closure of a set 𝐴 is (TC‘𝐴), assuming Transitive Containment. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → TC+ 𝐴 = (TC‘𝐴)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcexbi 36768 | A class is a set iff its transitive closure is a set, assuming Transitive Containment. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ V ↔ TC+ 𝐴 ∈ V) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcexg 36767 | The transitive closure of a set is a set, assuming Transitive Containment. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → TC+ 𝐴 ∈ V) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | elttcirr 36766 | Irreflexivity of 𝐴 ∈ TC+ 𝐵 relationship. This is a consequence of Regularity, but it does not require Transitive Containment. We use the alternative expression dfttc4 36765 to construct a set in which 𝐴 is both ∈-minimal and not ∈-minimal. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ¬ 𝐴 ∈ TC+ 𝐴 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | dfttc4 36765 | An alternative expression for the transitive closure of a class, assuming Regularity. A set 𝑥 is contained in the transitive closure of 𝐴 iff we can construct an ∈-chain from 𝑥 to an element of 𝐴. This weak definition is primarily useful for proving elttcirr 36766. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ TC+ 𝐴 = {𝑥 ∣ ∃𝑦((𝐴 ∩ 𝑦) ≠ ∅ ∧ ∀𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 ((𝑧 ∩ 𝑦) = ∅ → 𝑧 = 𝑥))} | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | dfttc4lem2 36764 | Lemma for dfttc4 36765. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = {𝑥 ∣ ∃𝑦((𝐴 ∩ 𝑦) ≠ ∅ ∧ ∀𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 ((𝑧 ∩ 𝑦) = ∅ → 𝑧 = 𝑥))} ⇒ ⊢ (𝐴 ⊆ 𝐵 ∧ Tr 𝐵) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | dfttc4lem1 36763 | Lemma for dfttc4 36765. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = {𝑥 ∣ ∃𝑦((𝐴 ∩ 𝑦) ≠ ∅ ∧ ∀𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 ((𝑧 ∩ 𝑦) = ∅ → 𝑧 = 𝑥))} & ⊢ 𝐶 ∈ V & ⊢ 𝐷 ∈ V ⇒ ⊢ (((𝐴 ∩ 𝐶) ≠ ∅ ∧ ∀𝑧 ∈ 𝐶 ((𝑧 ∩ 𝐶) = ∅ → 𝑧 = 𝐷)) → 𝐷 ∈ 𝐵) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttc0elw 36762 | If a transitive closure is a set, then it contains ∅ as an element iff it is nonempty, assuming Regularity. If we also assume Transitive Containment, then we can remove the TC+ 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 hypothesis, see ttc0el 36770. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (TC+ 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → (𝐴 ≠ ∅ ↔ ∅ ∈ TC+ 𝐴)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcwf3 36761 | The sets whose transitive closures are sets are precisely the well-founded sets, assuming Regularity. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (TC+ 𝐴 ∈ V ↔ 𝐴 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcwf2 36760 | If a transitive closure class is a set, then it is well-founded, assuming Regularity. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (TC+ 𝐴 ∈ V ↔ TC+ 𝐴 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcwf 36759 | A set is well-founded iff its transitive closure is well-founded. As a corollary, the transitive closure of any well-founded set is a set. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On) ↔ TC+ 𝐴 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | dfttc3gw 36758 | If the transitive closure of 𝐴 is a set, then its value is (TC‘𝐴). If we assume Transitive Containment, then we can weaken the hypothesis to 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉, see dfttc3g 36769. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (TC+ 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → TC+ 𝐴 = (TC‘𝐴)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcsntrsucg 36757 | The singleton transitive closure of a transitive set is its successor. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ Tr 𝐴) → TC+ {𝐴} = suc 𝐴) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcsnexbig 36756 | The transitive closure of a set is a set iff its singleton transitive closure is a set. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → (TC+ 𝐴 ∈ V ↔ TC+ {𝐴} ∈ V)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcsnexg 36755 | If the transitive closure of a class is a set, then its singleton transitive closure is a set. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (TC+ 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → TC+ {𝐴} ∈ V) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcsng 36754 | Relationship between TC+ {𝐴} and TC+ 𝐴: the former contains the additional element 𝐴. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → TC+ {𝐴} = (TC+ 𝐴 ∪ {𝐴})) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcsnmin 36753 | The singleton transitive closure is the minimal transitive class containing 𝐴 as an element. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ Tr 𝐵) → TC+ {𝐴} ⊆ 𝐵) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcsnidg 36752 | The singleton transitive closure contains its argument 𝐴 as an element. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → 𝐴 ∈ TC+ {𝐴}) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcsnssg 36751 | The transitive closure is contained in the singleton transitive closure. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → TC+ 𝐴 ⊆ TC+ {𝐴}) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcpwss 36750 | The transitive closure of a power class is contained in the power class of the transitive closure. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ TC+ 𝒫 𝐴 ⊆ 𝒫 TC+ 𝐴 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttciun 36749 | Distribute indexed union through a transitive closure. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ TC+ ∪ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝐵 = ∪ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 TC+ 𝐵 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcuni 36748 | Distribute union of a class through a transitive closure. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ TC+ ∪ 𝐴 = ∪ TC+ 𝐴 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcun 36747 | Distribute union of two classes through a transitive closure. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ TC+ (𝐴 ∪ 𝐵) = (TC+ 𝐴 ∪ TC+ 𝐵) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttciunun 36746 | Relationship between TC+ 𝐴 and ∪ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴TC+ 𝑥: we can decompose TC+ 𝐴 into the elements of ∪ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴TC+ 𝑥 plus the elements of 𝐴 itself. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ TC+ 𝐴 = (∪ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 TC+ 𝑥 ∪ 𝐴) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcuniun 36745 | Relationship between TC+ 𝐴 and TC+ ∪ 𝐴: we can decompose TC+ 𝐴 into the elements of TC+ ∪ 𝐴 plus the elements of 𝐴 itself. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ TC+ 𝐴 = (TC+ ∪ 𝐴 ∪ 𝐴) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | csbttc 36744 | Distribute proper substitution through a transitive closure. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ⦋𝐴 / 𝑥⦌TC+ 𝐵 = TC+ ⦋𝐴 / 𝑥⦌𝐵 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttc00 36743 | A class has an empty transitive closure iff it is the empty set. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 = ∅ ↔ TC+ 𝐴 = ∅) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttc0 36742 | The transitive closure of the empty set is the empty set. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ TC+ ∅ = ∅ | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | dfttc2g 36741 | A shorter expression for the transitive closure of a set. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → TC+ 𝐴 = ∪ (rec((𝑥 ∈ V ↦ ∪ 𝑥), 𝐴) “ ω)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | elttctr 36740 | Transitivity of 𝐴 ∈ TC+ 𝐵 relationship. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ TC+ 𝐵 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ TC+ 𝐶) → 𝐴 ∈ TC+ 𝐶) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ssttctr 36739 | Transitivity of 𝐴 ⊆ TC+ 𝐵 relationship. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ⊆ TC+ 𝐵 ∧ 𝐵 ⊆ TC+ 𝐶) → 𝐴 ⊆ TC+ 𝐶) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcidm 36738 | The transitive closure operation is idempotent. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ TC+ TC+ 𝐴 = TC+ 𝐴 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttctrid 36737 | The transitive closure of a transitive class is the class itself. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (Tr 𝐴 → TC+ 𝐴 = 𝐴) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcel2 36736 | Elements turn into subclasses upon taking transitive closures. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝐵 → TC+ 𝐴 ⊆ TC+ 𝐵) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcel 36735 | A transitive closure contains the transitive closures of all its elements. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ TC+ 𝐵 → TC+ 𝐴 ⊆ TC+ 𝐵) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcss2 36734 | The subclass relationship is inherited by transitive closures. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ⊆ 𝐵 → TC+ 𝐴 ⊆ TC+ 𝐵) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcss 36733 | A transitive closure contains the transitive closures of all its subclasses. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ⊆ TC+ 𝐵 → TC+ 𝐴 ⊆ TC+ 𝐵) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcexrg 36732 | If the transitive closure of a class is a set, then the class is a set. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (TC+ 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → 𝐴 ∈ V) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcmin 36731 | The transitive closure of 𝐴 is a subclass of every transitive class containing 𝐴. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ⊆ 𝐵 ∧ Tr 𝐵) → TC+ 𝐴 ⊆ 𝐵) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttctr3 36730 | The transitive closure of a class is transitive. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∪ TC+ 𝐴 ⊆ TC+ 𝐴 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttctr2 36729 | The transitive closure of a class is transitive. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ TC+ 𝐵 → 𝐴 ⊆ TC+ 𝐵) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttctr 36728 | The transitive closure of a class is transitive. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ Tr TC+ 𝐴 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttcid 36727 | The transitive closure contains its argument as a subclass. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐴 ⊆ TC+ 𝐴 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | nfttc 36726 | Bound-variable hypothesis builder for transitive closure. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥𝐴 ⇒ ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥TC+ 𝐴 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttceqd 36725 | Equality deduction for transitive closure. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 = 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → TC+ 𝐴 = TC+ 𝐵) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttceqi 36724 | Equality inference for transitive closure. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐴 = 𝐵 ⇒ ⊢ TC+ 𝐴 = TC+ 𝐵 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ttceq 36723 | Equality theorem for transitive closure. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 = 𝐵 → TC+ 𝐴 = TC+ 𝐵) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | df-ttc 36722 | Transitive closure of a class. Unlike (TC‘𝐴) (see df-tc 9654), this definition works even if 𝐴 or its transitive closure is a proper class. Note that unless we assume Transitive Containment, the transitive closure of a set may be a proper class. If we only assume Regularity, then the class of sets whose transitive closure is a set is precisely the class of well-founded sets, see ttcwf3 36761. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ TC+ 𝐴 = ∪ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∪ (rec((𝑦 ∈ V ↦ ∪ 𝑦), {𝑥}) “ ω) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | cttc 36721 | Extend class notation with the transitive closure of a class. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| class TC+ 𝐴 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | tr0el 36720 | Every nonempty transitive class contains the empty set ∅ as an element, a consequence of Regularity and Transitive Containment. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ≠ ∅ ∧ Tr 𝐴) → ∅ ∈ 𝐴) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | tr0elw 36719 | Every nonempty transitive set contains the empty set ∅ as an element, a consequence of Regularity. If we assume Transitive Containment, then we can omit the 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 hypothesis, see tr0el 36720. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐴 ≠ ∅ ∧ Tr 𝐴) → ∅ ∈ 𝐴) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | tz9.1tco 36718 | Version of tz9.1 9648 derived from ax-tco 36707. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐴 ∈ V ⇒ ⊢ ∃𝑥(𝐴 ⊆ 𝑥 ∧ Tr 𝑥 ∧ ∀𝑦((𝐴 ⊆ 𝑦 ∧ Tr 𝑦) → 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑦)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | tz9.1ctco 36717 | Version of tz9.1c 9649 derived from ax-tco 36707. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐴 ∈ V ⇒ ⊢ ∩ {𝑥 ∣ (𝐴 ⊆ 𝑥 ∧ Tr 𝑥)} ∈ V | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | axuntco 36714 | Derivation of ax-un 7685 from ax-tco 36707. Use ax-un 7685 instead. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦∀𝑧(∃𝑤(𝑧 ∈ 𝑤 ∧ 𝑤 ∈ 𝑥) → 𝑧 ∈ 𝑦) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | axtcond 36713 | A version of the Axiom of Transitive Containment with no distinct variable conditions. Usage of this theorem is discouraged because it depends on ax-13 2380. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦∀𝑧((𝑧 = 𝑥 ∨ 𝑧 ∈ 𝑦) → ∀𝑥(𝑥 ∈ 𝑧 → 𝑥 ∈ 𝑦)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | axtco2g 36712 | Weak form of the Axiom of Transitive Containment using class variables and abbreviations. See ax-tco 36707 for more information. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → ∃𝑥(𝐴 ⊆ 𝑥 ∧ Tr 𝑥)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | axtco1g 36711 | Strong form of the Axiom of Transitive Containment using class variables and abbreviations. See ax-tco 36707 for more information. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → ∃𝑥(𝐴 ∈ 𝑥 ∧ Tr 𝑥)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | axtco1from2 36710 | Strong form axtco1 36708 of the Axiom of Transitive Containment, derived from the weak form axtco2 36709. See ax-tco 36707 for more information. As written, the proof uses ax-pr 5369 via el 5384, but we could alternatively use ax-pow 5301 via elALT2 5305. Use axtco1 36708 instead. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦(𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ∀𝑤(𝑤 ∈ 𝑧 → 𝑤 ∈ 𝑦))) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | axtco2 36709 | Weak form of the Axiom of Transitive Containment. See ax-tco 36707 for more information. In particular, this theorem shows the derivation of the weak form from the strong form. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦∀𝑧((𝑧 = 𝑥 ∨ 𝑧 ∈ 𝑦) → ∀𝑤(𝑤 ∈ 𝑧 → 𝑤 ∈ 𝑦)) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | ax-tco 36707 |
The Axiom of Transitive Containment of ZF set theory. It was derived as
axtco 36706 above and is therefore redundant if we
assume ax-ext 2712,
ax-rep 5206 and ax-inf2 9560, but we state it as a separate axiom here so
that its uses can be identified more easily. It states that a
transitive set 𝑦 exists that contains a given set
𝑥.
In
particular, the transitive closure of 𝑥 is a set, since it is a
subset of 𝑦, see df-tc 9654.
Traditionally, this statement is not counted as an axiom at all, but as a theorem from Replacement and Infinity. In fact, from the transitive closure of 𝑥 we can construct the set of iterated unions of 𝑥 (and vice versa), and Skolem took the existence of the latter set as a motivation for introducing the Axiom of Replacement. But Transitive Containment is strictly weaker than either of those axioms, so many authors identify it as its own axiom when investigating subsystems of ZF, such as Zermelo set theory or finitist set theory. We follow this separation in order to avoid nonessential usage of the stronger axioms. There are two main versions of this axiom that appear in the literature: the strong form ⊢ ∃𝑦(𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 ∧ Tr 𝑦), see axtco1 36708 and axtco1g 36711, and the weak form ⊢ ∃𝑦(𝑥 ⊆ 𝑦 ∧ Tr 𝑦), see axtco2 36709 and axtco2g 36712. The weak form follows directly from the strong form, see axtco2 36709. But the strong form only follows from the weak form if we allow el 5384 or one of its variants, see axtco1from2 36710. We take the strong form here as the axiom, since it is slightly shorter when expanded to primitive symbols. Yet the weak form turns out to be more suitable for axtcond 36713 for reasons of syntax. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦(𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ∀𝑤(𝑤 ∈ 𝑧 → 𝑤 ∈ 𝑦))) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | axtco 36706 | Axiom of Transitive Containment, derived as a theorem from ax-ext 2712, ax-rep 5206, and ax-inf2 9560. Use ax-tco 36707 instead. (Contributed by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦(𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ∀𝑤(𝑤 ∈ 𝑧 → 𝑤 ∈ 𝑦))) | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | el 5384 | Any set is an element of some other set. See elALT 5388 for a shorter proof using more axioms, and see elALT2 5305 for a proof that uses ax-9 2129 and ax-pow 5301 instead of ax-pr 5369. (Contributed by NM, 4-Jan-2002.) (Proof shortened by Andrew Salmon, 25-Jul-2011.) Use ax-pr 5369 instead of ax-9 2129 and ax-pow 5301. (Revised by BTernaryTau, 2-Dec-2024.) (Proof shortened by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑦 𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 | ||
| 6-Apr-2026 | axprlem1 5359 | Lemma for axpr 5363. There exists a set to which all empty sets belong. (Contributed by Rohan Ridenour, 10-Aug-2023.) (Revised by BJ, 13-Aug-2023.) (Proof shortened by Matthew House, 6-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑥∀𝑦(∀𝑧 ¬ 𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → 𝑦 ∈ 𝑥) | ||
| 5-Apr-2026 | nprmmul1 48009 | Special factorization of a non-prime integer greater than 3. (Contributed by AV, 5-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘4) → (𝑁 ∉ ℙ ↔ ∃𝑎 ∈ (2..^𝑁)∃𝑏 ∈ (2..^𝑁)𝑁 = (𝑎 · 𝑏))) | ||
| 5-Apr-2026 | nndivides2 47854 | Definition of the divides relation for divisors greater than 1. (Contributed by AV, 5-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑀 ∈ (2..^𝑁) ∧ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ) → (𝑀 ∥ 𝑁 ↔ ∃𝑛 ∈ (2..^𝑁)(𝑛 · 𝑀) = 𝑁)) | ||
| 5-Apr-2026 | nnmul2b 47801 | A factor of a product of integers is at least 2 and less then the product iff the second factor is at least 2 and less then the product. (Contributed by AV, 5-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℕ ∧ 𝐵 ∈ ℕ ∧ (𝐴 · 𝐵) = 𝑁) → (𝐴 ∈ (2..^𝑁) ↔ 𝐵 ∈ (2..^𝑁))) | ||
| 5-Apr-2026 | nnmul2 47800 | If one factor of a product of integers is at least 2 and less then the product, so is the second factor. (Contributed by AV, 5-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ (2..^𝑁) ∧ 𝐵 ∈ ℕ ∧ (𝐴 · 𝐵) = 𝑁) → 𝐵 ∈ (2..^𝑁)) | ||
| 5-Apr-2026 | elfzo2nn 47799 | A member of a half-open range of integers starting at 2 is a positive integer. (Contributed by AV, 5-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐾 ∈ (2..^𝑁) → 𝐾 ∈ ℕ) | ||
| 5-Apr-2026 | elfz2nn 47792 | A member of a finite set of sequential integers starting at 2 is a positive integer. (Contributed by AV, 5-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐾 ∈ (2...𝑁) → 𝐾 ∈ ℕ) | ||
| 5-Apr-2026 | bj-alrimdh 36942 | Deduction form of Theorem 19.21 of [Margaris] p. 90, see 19.21 2219 and 19.21h 2298. (Contributed by NM, 10-Feb-1997.) (Proof shortened by Andrew Salmon, 13-May-2011.) State the most general derivable instance. (Revised by BJ, 5-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜓) & ⊢ (𝜒 → ∀𝑥𝜃) & ⊢ (𝜓 → (𝜃 → 𝜏)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜒 → ∀𝑥𝜏)) | ||
| 5-Apr-2026 | bj-alimdh 36941 | General instance of alimdh 1824. (Contributed by NM, 4-Jan-2002.) State the most general derivable instance. (Revised by BJ, 5-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜓) & ⊢ (𝜓 → (𝜒 → 𝜃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜒 → ∀𝑥𝜃)) | ||
| 5-Apr-2026 | zfrep6 5218 | A version of the Axiom of Replacement. Normally 𝜑 would have free variables 𝑥 and 𝑦. Axiom 6 of [Kunen] p. 12. The Separation Scheme ax-sep 5225 cannot be derived from this version and must be stated as a separate axiom in an axiom system (such as Kunen's) that uses this version in place of our ax-rep 5206. (Contributed by NM, 10-Oct-2003.) Shorten proof and reduce axiom dependencies. (Revised by BJ, 5-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∀𝑥 ∈ 𝑧 ∃!𝑦𝜑 → ∃𝑤∀𝑥 ∈ 𝑧 ∃𝑦 ∈ 𝑤 𝜑) | ||
| 5-Apr-2026 | replem 5217 | A lemma for variants of the axiom of replacement: if we can form the set of images of the functional relation, then we can also form a set containing all its images. The converse requires the axiom of separation. (Contributed by BJ, 5-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((∀𝑥 ∈ 𝑧 ∃𝑦𝜑 ∧ ∃𝑤∀𝑦(𝑦 ∈ 𝑤 ↔ ∃𝑥 ∈ 𝑧 𝜑)) → ∃𝑤∀𝑥 ∈ 𝑧 ∃𝑦 ∈ 𝑤 𝜑) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | ppi1sum 48116 | Value of the prime-counting function pi for 1, according to Ján Mináč. (Contributed by AV, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (π‘1) = Σ𝑘 ∈ ∅ (⌊‘((((!‘(𝑘 − 1)) + 1) / 𝑘) − (⌊‘((!‘(𝑘 − 1)) / 𝑘)))) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | indprmfz 48115 | An indicator function for prime numbers in a finite interval of integers, according to Ján Mináč. (Contributed by AV, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (2...𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝟭‘𝐼)‘(𝐼 ∩ ℙ)) = (𝑘 ∈ 𝐼 ↦ (⌊‘((((!‘(𝑘 − 1)) + 1) / 𝑘) − (⌊‘((!‘(𝑘 − 1)) / 𝑘))))) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | indprm 48114 | An indicator function for prime numbers, according to Ján Mináč. (Contributed by AV, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝟭‘(ℤ≥‘2))‘ℙ) = (𝑘 ∈ (ℤ≥‘2) ↦ (⌊‘((((!‘(𝑘 − 1)) + 1) / 𝑘) − (⌊‘((!‘(𝑘 − 1)) / 𝑘))))) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | ppivalnnnprmge6 48111 | Value of a term of the prime-counting function pi for positive integers, according to Ján Mináč, for a non-prime number greater than 4. (Contributed by AV, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘6) ∧ 𝑁 ∉ ℙ) → (⌊‘((((!‘(𝑁 − 1)) + 1) / 𝑁) − (⌊‘((!‘(𝑁 − 1)) / 𝑁)))) = 0) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | nprmmul3 48011 | Special factorization of a non-prime integer greater than 3. (Contributed by AV, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘4) → (𝑁 ∉ ℙ ↔ (∃𝑎 ∈ (2..^𝑁)∃𝑏 ∈ (2..^𝑁)(𝑎 < 𝑏 ∧ 𝑁 = (𝑎 · 𝑏)) ∨ ∃𝑎 ∈ (2..^𝑁)𝑁 = (𝑎↑2)))) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | rerecne0d 42940 | The reciprocal of a nonzero number is nonzero. (Contributed by SN, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (1 /ℝ 𝐴) ≠ 0) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-nnf-cbval 37130 | Compared with cbvalv1 2349, this saves ax-12 2189. (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑦𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → Ⅎ'𝑦𝜓) & ⊢ (𝜑 → Ⅎ'𝑥𝜒) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 = 𝑦) → (𝜓 ↔ 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜓 ↔ ∀𝑦𝜒)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-nnf-cbvali 37129 | Compared with bj-nnf-cbvaliv 37126, replacing the DV condition on 𝑦, 𝜓 with the nonfreeness condition requires ax-11 2168. (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑦𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → Ⅎ'𝑦𝜓) & ⊢ (𝜑 → Ⅎ'𝑥𝜒) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 = 𝑦) → (𝜓 → 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜓 → ∀𝑦𝜒)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-nnf-cbvaliv 37126 | The only DV conditions are those saying that 𝑦 is a fresh variable used to construct 𝜒. (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → Ⅎ'𝑥𝜒) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 = 𝑦) → (𝜓 → 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜓 → ∀𝑦𝜒)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-nnf-spime 37125 | An existential generalization result in deduction form, from ax-1 6-- ax-6 1974, where the only DV condition is on 𝑥, 𝑦, and where 𝑥 should be nonfree in the new proposition 𝜒 (and in the context 𝜑). (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → Ⅎ'𝑥𝜓) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 = 𝑦) → (𝜓 → 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜓 → ∃𝑥𝜒)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-nnf-spim 37124 | A universal specialization result in deduction form, proved from ax-1 6 -- ax-6 1974, where the only DV condition is on 𝑥, 𝑦 and where 𝑥 should be nonfree in the new proposition 𝜒 (and in the context 𝜑). (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → Ⅎ'𝑥𝜒) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 = 𝑦) → (𝜓 → 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜓 → 𝜒)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-hbex 37062 | A more general instance of hbex 2334. (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜓) ⇒ ⊢ (∃𝑦𝜑 → ∀𝑥∃𝑦𝜓) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-hbexd 37060 | A more general instance of the deduction form of hbex 2334. (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑦𝜓) & ⊢ (𝜓 → (𝜒 → ∀𝑥𝜃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∃𝑦𝜒 → ∀𝑥∃𝑦𝜃)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-hbal 37031 | More general instance of hbal 2178. (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜓) ⇒ ⊢ (∀𝑦𝜑 → ∀𝑥∀𝑦𝜓) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-hbald 37029 | General statement that hbald 2179 proves . (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑦𝜓) & ⊢ (𝜓 → (𝜒 → ∀𝑥𝜃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑦𝜒 → ∀𝑥∀𝑦𝜃)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-spim0 37016 | A universal specialization result in deduction form, proved from ax-1 6 -- ax-6 1974, where the only DV condition is on 𝑥, 𝑦 and where 𝑥 should be nonfree in the new proposition 𝜒 (and in the context 𝜑). (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (∃𝑥𝜒 → 𝜒)) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 = 𝑦) → (𝜓 → 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜓 → 𝜒)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-cbveximdv 36981 | A lemma for alpha-renaming of variables bound by an existential quantifier. (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑦𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜒 → ∀𝑦𝜒)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥∃𝑦𝜓) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝜓) → (𝜒 → 𝜃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∃𝑥𝜒 → ∃𝑦𝜃)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-cbvalimdv 36980 | A lemma for alpha-renaming of variables bound by a universal quantifier. (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑦𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (∃𝑥𝜃 → 𝜃)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑦∃𝑥𝜓) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝜓) → (𝜒 → 𝜃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜒 → ∀𝑦𝜃)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-cbveximd 36979 | A lemma for alpha-renaming of variables bound by an existential quantifier. (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑦𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜒 → ∀𝑦𝜒)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (∃𝑥𝜃 → 𝜃)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥∃𝑦𝜓) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝜓) → (𝜒 → 𝜃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∃𝑥𝜒 → ∃𝑦𝜃)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-cbvalimd 36978 | A lemma for alpha-renaming of variables bound by a universal quantifier. (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑦𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜒 → ∀𝑦𝜒)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (∃𝑥𝜃 → 𝜃)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑦∃𝑥𝜓) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝜓) → (𝜒 → 𝜃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜒 → ∀𝑦𝜃)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-cbvalimd0 36975 | A lemma for alpha-renaming of variables bound by a universal quantifier. In applications, 𝑥 = 𝑦 will be substituted for 𝜓 and ax6ev 1976 will prove Hypothesis bj-cbvalimd0.denote. When ax6ev 1976 is not available but only its universal closure is, then bj-cbvalimd 36978 or bj-cbvalimdv 36980 should be used (see bj-cbvalimdlem 36976, bj-cbval 36993). (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑦𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜒 → ∀𝑦𝜒)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (∃𝑥𝜃 → 𝜃)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∃𝑥𝜓) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝜓) → (𝜒 → 𝜃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜒 → ∀𝑦𝜃)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-spime 36974 | A lemma for existential generalization. In applications, 𝑥 = 𝑦 will be substituted for 𝜓 and ax6ev 1976 will prove Hypothesis bj-spime.denote. (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜒 → ∀𝑥𝜒)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∃𝑥𝜓) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝜓) → (𝜒 → 𝜃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜒 → ∃𝑥𝜃)) | ||
| 4-Apr-2026 | bj-spim 36973 | A lemma for universal specification. In applications, 𝑥 = 𝑦 will be substituted for 𝜓 and ax6ev 1976 will prove Hypothesis bj-spim.denote. (Contributed by BJ, 4-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (∃𝑥𝜃 → 𝜃)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∃𝑥𝜓) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝜓) → (𝜒 → 𝜃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜒 → 𝜃)) | ||
| 3-Apr-2026 | bj-spimenfa 36972 | An existential generalization result: if 𝜑 holds and implies 𝜓 for at least one value of 𝑥, and if furthermore 𝑥 is ∀ -weakly nonfree in 𝜑, then 𝜓 holds for at least one value of 𝑥. (Contributed by BJ, 3-Apr-2026.) Proof should not use 19.35 1884. (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ((𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) → (∃𝑥(𝜑 → 𝜓) → (𝜑 → ∃𝑥𝜓))) | ||
| 3-Apr-2026 | bj-spimnfe 36971 | A universal specification result: if 𝜑 is true for all values of 𝑥 and implies 𝜓 for at least one value, and if furthermore 𝑥 is ∃-weakly nonfree in 𝜓, then 𝜓 follows. An intermediate result on the way to prove 19.36i 2243, bj-19.36im 37113, 19.36imv 1952, spimfw 1972... (Contributed by BJ, 3-Apr-2026.) Proof should not use 19.35 1884. (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ((∃𝑥𝜓 → 𝜓) → (∃𝑥(𝜑 → 𝜓) → (∀𝑥𝜑 → 𝜓))) | ||
| 3-Apr-2026 | bj-imim11i 36867 | The propositional function ((. → 𝜑) → 𝜓) is increasing. Its associated inference is wl-syls2 37887. (Contributed by BJ, 3-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝜓) ⇒ ⊢ (((𝜑 → 𝜒) → 𝜃) → ((𝜓 → 𝜒) → 𝜃)) | ||
| 3-Apr-2026 | bj-imim11 36866 | The propositional function ((. → 𝜑) → 𝜓) is increasing. (Contributed by BJ, 3-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝜑 → 𝜓) → (((𝜑 → 𝜒) → 𝜃) → ((𝜓 → 𝜒) → 𝜃))) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | hoicvr 46998 | 𝐼 is a countable set of half-open intervals that covers the whole multidimensional reals. See Definition 1135 (b) of [Fremlin1] p. 29. (Contributed by Glauco Siliprandi, 11-Oct-2020.) Avoid ax-rep 5206 and shorten proof. (Revised by GG, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (𝑗 ∈ ℕ ↦ (𝑥 ∈ 𝑋 ↦ 〈-𝑗, 𝑗〉)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ Fin) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (ℝ ↑m 𝑋) ⊆ ∪ 𝑗 ∈ ℕ X𝑖 ∈ 𝑋 (([,) ∘ (𝐼‘𝑗))‘𝑖)) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | rerecrecd 42943 | A number is equal to the reciprocal of its reciprocal. (Contributed by SN, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (1 /ℝ (1 /ℝ 𝐴)) = 𝐴) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | sn-redividd 42938 | A number divided by itself is 1. (Contributed by SN, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 /ℝ 𝐴) = 1) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | sn-rediv0d 42937 | Division into zero is zero. (Contributed by SN, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (0 /ℝ 𝐴) = 0) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | sn-rediv1d 42936 | A number divided by 1 is itself. (Contributed by SN, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 /ℝ 1) = 𝐴) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | rediveq1d 42935 | Equality in terms of unit ratio. (Contributed by SN, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 /ℝ 𝐵) = 1 ↔ 𝐴 = 𝐵)) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | redivne0bd 42934 | The ratio of nonzero numbers is nonzero. (Contributed by SN, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 ≠ 0 ↔ (𝐴 /ℝ 𝐵) ≠ 0)) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | redivmul2d 42930 | Relationship between division and multiplication. (Contributed by SN, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 /ℝ 𝐶) = 𝐵 ↔ 𝐴 = (𝐶 · 𝐵))) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | padct 32817 | Index a countable set with integers and pad with 𝑍. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 1-Jun-2020.) Avoid ax-rep 5206. (Revised by GG, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ≼ ω ∧ 𝑍 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ ¬ 𝑍 ∈ 𝐴) → ∃𝑓(𝑓:ℕ⟶(𝐴 ∪ {𝑍}) ∧ 𝐴 ⊆ ran 𝑓 ∧ Fun (◡𝑓 ↾ 𝐴))) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | istrkg2ld 28553 | Property of fulfilling the lower dimension 2 axiom. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 20-Nov-2019.) Avoid ax-rep 5206. (Revised by GG, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑃 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ − = (dist‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Itv‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐺 ∈ 𝑉 → (𝐺DimTarskiG≥2 ↔ ∃𝑥 ∈ 𝑃 ∃𝑦 ∈ 𝑃 ∃𝑧 ∈ 𝑃 ¬ (𝑧 ∈ (𝑥𝐼𝑦) ∨ 𝑥 ∈ (𝑧𝐼𝑦) ∨ 𝑦 ∈ (𝑥𝐼𝑧)))) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | smndex1igid 18872 | The composition of the modulo function 𝐼 and a constant function (𝐺‘𝐾) results in (𝐺‘𝐾) itself. (Contributed by AV, 14-Feb-2024.) Avoid ax-rep 5206. (Revised by GG, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑀 = (EndoFMnd‘ℕ0) & ⊢ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ & ⊢ 𝐼 = (𝑥 ∈ ℕ0 ↦ (𝑥 mod 𝑁)) & ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝑛 ∈ (0..^𝑁) ↦ (𝑥 ∈ ℕ0 ↦ 𝑛)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐾 ∈ (0..^𝑁) → (𝐼 ∘ (𝐺‘𝐾)) = (𝐺‘𝐾)) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | smndex1gid 18870 | The composition of a constant function (𝐺‘𝐾) with another endofunction on ℕ0 results in (𝐺‘𝐾) itself. (Contributed by AV, 14-Feb-2024.) Avoid ax-rep 5206. (Revised by GG, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑀 = (EndoFMnd‘ℕ0) & ⊢ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ & ⊢ 𝐼 = (𝑥 ∈ ℕ0 ↦ (𝑥 mod 𝑁)) & ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝑛 ∈ (0..^𝑁) ↦ (𝑥 ∈ ℕ0 ↦ 𝑛)) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐹 ∈ (Base‘𝑀) ∧ 𝐾 ∈ (0..^𝑁)) → ((𝐺‘𝐾) ∘ 𝐹) = (𝐺‘𝐾)) | ||
| 2-Apr-2026 | smndex1gbas 18868 | The constant functions (𝐺‘𝐾) are endofunctions on ℕ0. (Contributed by AV, 12-Feb-2024.) Avoid ax-rep 5206 and shorten proof. (Revised by GG, 2-Apr-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑀 = (EndoFMnd‘ℕ0) & ⊢ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ & ⊢ 𝐼 = (𝑥 ∈ ℕ0 ↦ (𝑥 mod 𝑁)) & ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝑛 ∈ (0..^𝑁) ↦ (𝑥 ∈ ℕ0 ↦ 𝑛)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐾 ∈ (0..^𝑁) → (𝐺‘𝐾) ∈ (Base‘𝑀)) | ||
| 1-Apr-2026 | nowisdomv 30569 | One's wisdom on matters of the universe can be refuted on April Fool's day. (Contributed by Prof. Loof Lirpa, 1-Apr-2026.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ¬ 𝑊〈“ I 5”〉dom V | ||
| 28-Mar-2026 | copsex2gd 37505 | Implicit substitution inference for ordered pairs. (Contributed by NM, 28-May-1995.) Use a similar proof to copsex4g 5443 to reduce axiom usage. (Revised by SN, 1-Sep-2024.) Adapt copsex2g 5441 $p to deduction form. (Revised by BJ, 28-Mar-2026.) Do not use copsex2g 5441. (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ (𝑥 = 𝐴 ∧ 𝑦 = 𝐵)) → (𝜓 ↔ 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝑊)) → (∃𝑥∃𝑦(〈𝐴, 𝐵〉 = 〈𝑥, 𝑦〉 ∧ 𝜓) ↔ 𝜒)) | ||
| 28-Mar-2026 | cgsex2gd 37504 | Implicit substitution inference for general classes. (Contributed by NM, 26-Jul-1995.) Adapt cgsex2g 3478 to deduction form. (Revised by BJ, 28-Mar-2026.) Do not use cgsex2g 3478. (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ (𝑥 = 𝐴 ∧ 𝑦 = 𝐵)) → 𝜓) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝜓) → (𝜒 ↔ 𝜃)) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝑊)) → (∃𝑥∃𝑦(𝜓 ∧ 𝜒) ↔ 𝜃)) | ||
| 28-Mar-2026 | bj-alnnf2 37088 | If a proposition holds, then it holds for all values of a given variable if and only if it does not depend on that variable. (Contributed by BJ, 28-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜑 ↔ Ⅎ'𝑥𝜑)) | ||
| 28-Mar-2026 | bj-alnnf 37087 | In deduction-style proofs, it is equivalent to assert that the context holds for all values of a variable, or that is does not depend on that variable. (Contributed by BJ, 28-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) ↔ (𝜑 → Ⅎ'𝑥𝜑)) | ||
| 28-Mar-2026 | bj-alsyl 36939 | Syllogism under the universal quantifier, in the curried form appearing as Theorem *10.3 of [WhiteheadRussell] p. 145. See alsyl 1900 for the uncurried form. (Contributed by BJ, 28-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∀𝑥(𝜑 → 𝜓) → (∀𝑥(𝜓 → 𝜒) → ∀𝑥(𝜑 → 𝜒))) | ||
| 27-Mar-2026 | axnulALT2 35271 | Alternate proof of axnul 5234, proved from propositional calculus, ax-gen 1802, ax-4 1816, ax-6 1974, and ax-rep 5206. (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 27-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑥∀𝑦 ¬ 𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 | ||
| 26-Mar-2026 | axprALT2 35297 | Alternate proof of axpr 5363, proved from predicate calculus, ax-rep 5206, and ax-inf2 9560. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 26-Mar-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑧∀𝑤((𝑤 = 𝑥 ∨ 𝑤 = 𝑦) → 𝑤 ∈ 𝑧) | ||
| 21-Mar-2026 | bj-nnfbd0 37098 | If two formulas are equivalent, then nonfreeness of a variable in one of them is equivalent to nonfreeness in the other, deduction form. The antecedent of the conclusion is in the "strong necessity" modality of modal logic (see also bj-nnftht 37093) in order not to require sp 2195 (modal T). See bj-nnfbi 37097. (Contributed by BJ, 21-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜓 ↔ 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ ∀𝑥𝜑) → (Ⅎ'𝑥𝜓 ↔ Ⅎ'𝑥𝜒)) | ||
| 20-Mar-2026 | bj-bisimpr 36871 | Implication from equivalence with a conjunct. Its associated inference is simprbi 498. (Contributed by BJ, 20-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝜑 ↔ (𝜓 ∧ 𝜒)) → (𝜑 → 𝜒)) | ||
| 20-Mar-2026 | bj-bisimpl 36870 | Implication from equivalence with a conjunct. Its associated inference is simplbi 497. (Contributed by BJ, 20-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝜑 ↔ (𝜓 ∧ 𝜒)) → (𝜑 → 𝜓)) | ||
| 19-Mar-2026 | bj-almpig 36938 | A partially quantified form of mpi 20 similar to bj-almpi 36937. (Contributed by BJ, 19-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜒 → 𝜓)) & ⊢ ∀𝑥𝜒 ⇒ ⊢ ∀𝑥(𝜑 → 𝜓) | ||
| 19-Mar-2026 | bj-almpi 36937 | A quantified form of mpi 20. See also barbara 2667, bj-ala1i 36936, bj-almp 36929. (Contributed by BJ, 19-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∀𝑥(𝜑 → (𝜒 → 𝜓)) & ⊢ ∀𝑥𝜒 ⇒ ⊢ ∀𝑥(𝜑 → 𝜓) | ||
| 19-Mar-2026 | bj-alimii 36935 | Inference associated with alimi 1818. Double inference associated with alim 1817. The usual proof of an associated inference (here from alimi 1818 and ax-mp 5) has the same size and same number of steps. (Contributed by BJ, 19-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜓 → 𝜑) & ⊢ ∀𝑥𝜓 ⇒ ⊢ ∀𝑥𝜑 | ||
| 19-Mar-2026 | bj-almp 36929 | A quantified form of ax-mp 5. See also barbara 2667, bj-ala1i 36936, bj-almpi 36937. (Contributed by BJ, 19-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∀𝑥(𝜓 → 𝜑) & ⊢ ∀𝑥𝜓 ⇒ ⊢ ∀𝑥𝜑 | ||
| 17-Mar-2026 | bj-evalf 37439 | The evaluation at a class is a function from the universal class into the universal class. (Contributed by BJ, 17-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ Slot 𝐴:V⟶V | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | sin5tlem1 47343 | Lemma 1 for quintupled angle sine calculation, expanding triple-angle sine times double-angle cosine. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ ℂ → (((3 · 𝑁) − (4 · (𝑁↑3))) · (1 − (2 · (𝑁↑2)))) = (((8 · (𝑁↑5)) − (;10 · (𝑁↑3))) + (3 · 𝑁))) | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | cos3t 47342 | Triple-angle formula for cosine, in pure cosine form. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℂ → (cos‘(3 · 𝐴)) = ((4 · ((cos‘𝐴)↑3)) − (3 · (cos‘𝐴)))) | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | sin3t 47341 | Triple-angle formula for sine, in pure sine form. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℂ → (sin‘(3 · 𝐴)) = ((3 · (sin‘𝐴)) − (4 · ((sin‘𝐴)↑3)))) | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | esplyfvaln 33765 | The last elementary symmetric polynomial is the product of all variables. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑊 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (𝐼 mVar 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (𝐼eSymPoly𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (♯‘𝐼) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (mulGrp‘𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐸‘𝑁) = (𝑀 Σg 𝑉)) | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | esplyfval1 33764 | The first elementary symmetric polynomial is the sum of all variables. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑊 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (𝐼 mVar 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (𝐼eSymPoly𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐸‘1) = (𝑊 Σg 𝑉)) | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | mplmonprod 33745 | Finite product of monomials. Here the function 𝐺 maps a bag of variables to the corresponding monomial. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑃 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝐴⟶𝐷) & ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (mulGrp‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝑦 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ (𝑧 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ if(𝑧 = 𝑦, 1 , 0 ))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑀 Σg (𝐺 ∘ 𝐹)) = (𝐺‘(𝑖 ∈ 𝐼 ↦ (ℂfld Σg (𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ↦ ((𝐹‘𝑥)‘𝑖)))))) | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | mplgsum 33744 | Finite commutative sums of polynomials are taken componentwise. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑃 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝐴⟶𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑃 Σg 𝐹) = (𝑦 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ (𝑅 Σg (𝑘 ∈ 𝐴 ↦ ((𝐹‘𝑘)‘𝑦))))) | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | psrmonprod 33743 | Finite product of bags of variables in a power series. Here the function 𝐺 maps a bag of variables to the corresponding monomial. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (𝐼 mPwSer 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝐴⟶𝐷) & ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (mulGrp‘𝑆) & ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝑦 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ (𝑧 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ if(𝑧 = 𝑦, 1 , 0 ))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑀 Σg (𝐺 ∘ 𝐹)) = (𝐺‘(𝑖 ∈ 𝐼 ↦ (ℂfld Σg (𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ↦ ((𝐹‘𝑥)‘𝑖)))))) | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | psrmonmul2 33742 | The product of two power series monomials adds the exponent vectors together. Here, the function 𝐺 is a monomial builder, which maps a bag of variables with the monic monomial with only those variables. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (𝐼 mPwSer 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐷) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝑦 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ (𝑧 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ if(𝑧 = 𝑦, 1 , 0 ))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐺‘𝑋) · (𝐺‘𝑌)) = (𝐺‘(𝑋 ∘f + 𝑌))) | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | psrmonmul 33741 | The product of two power series monomials adds the exponent vectors together. For example, the product of (𝑥↑2)(𝑦↑2) with (𝑦↑1)(𝑧↑3) is (𝑥↑2)(𝑦↑3)(𝑧↑3), where the exponent vectors 〈2, 2, 0〉 and 〈0, 1, 3〉 are added to give 〈2, 3, 3〉. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (𝐼 mPwSer 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐷) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐷) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑦 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ if(𝑦 = 𝑋, 1 , 0 )) · (𝑦 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ if(𝑦 = 𝑌, 1 , 0 ))) = (𝑦 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ if(𝑦 = (𝑋 ∘f + 𝑌), 1 , 0 ))) | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | psrmon 33740 | A monomial is a power series. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (𝐼 mPwSer 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐷) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑦 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ if(𝑦 = 𝑋, 1 , 0 )) ∈ 𝐵) | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | psrgsum 33739 | Finite commutative sums of power series are taken componentwise. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (𝐼 mPwSer 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝐴⟶𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑆 Σg 𝐹) = (𝑦 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ (𝑅 Σg (𝑘 ∈ 𝐴 ↦ ((𝐹‘𝑘)‘𝑦))))) | ||
| 16-Mar-2026 | suppgsumssiun 33160 | The support of a function defined as a group sum is a subset of the indexed union of the supports. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 16-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑍 = (0g‘𝑀) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀 ∈ Mnd) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴) ∧ 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵) → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ↦ (𝑀 Σg (𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ 𝐶))) supp 𝑍) ⊆ ∪ 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ((𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ↦ 𝐶) supp 𝑍)) | ||
| 15-Mar-2026 | goldrasin 47352 | Alternative trigonometric formula for the golden ratio. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 15-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐹 = (2 · (cos‘(π / 5))) ⇒ ⊢ 𝐹 = (2 · (sin‘(π · (3 / ;10)))) | ||
| 15-Mar-2026 | goldrarr 47351 | The golden ratio is a real value. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 15-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐹 = (2 · (cos‘(π / 5))) ⇒ ⊢ 𝐹 ∈ ℝ | ||
| 14-Mar-2026 | bj-axreprepsep 37435 |
Strong axiom of replacement (universal closure of ax-rep 5206) from the
axioms of separation and replacement as written in the theorem's
hypotheses.
The statement does not require a nonempty universe; most of the proof does not either, except for the use of 19.8a 2193, which could be removed by reworking the proof, since it is applied in a subexpression bound by the variable it introduces. Proof modifications should not introduce steps relying on a nonempty universe, like alrimiv 1934. (Contributed by BJ, 14-Mar-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ∀𝑥∃𝑠∀𝑦(𝑦 ∈ 𝑠 ↔ (𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 ∧ ∃𝑧𝜑)) & ⊢ ∀𝑠(∀𝑦 ∈ 𝑠 ∃!𝑧𝜑 → ∃𝑡∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑡 ↔ ∃𝑦 ∈ 𝑠 𝜑)) ⇒ ⊢ ∀𝑥(∀𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 ∃*𝑧𝜑 → ∃𝑡∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑡 ↔ ∃𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 𝜑)) | ||
| 14-Mar-2026 | bj-axseprep 37434 |
Axiom of separation (universal closure of ax-sep 5225) from a weak form of
the axiom of replacement requiring that the functional relation in it be
a (total) function and the weak emptyset axiom (existence of an empty
set provided existence of a set), as written in the theorem's
hypotheses.
This result shows that the weak emptyset axiom is not only the result of a cheap way to avoid an axiom redundancy (in this case, the existence axiom extru 1982) by adding it as an antecedent, but also permits to prove nontrivial results that hold in nonnecessarily nonempty universes. This proof is by cases so is not intuitionistic. The statement does not require a nonempty universe; most of the proof does not either, and the parts that do (e.g., near sb8ef 2363 and sbequ12r 2264 and eueq2 3658) could be reworked to avoid it. Proof modifications should not introduce steps relying on a nonempty universe, like alrimiv 1934. (Contributed by BJ, 14-Mar-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥⊤ → ∃𝑦∀𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 ⊥) & ⊢ ∀𝑥(∀𝑧 ∈ 𝑥 ∃!𝑡𝜓 → ∃𝑦∀𝑡(𝑡 ∈ 𝑦 ↔ ∃𝑧 ∈ 𝑥 𝜓)) & ⊢ (𝜓 ↔ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑡 = 𝑧) ∨ (¬ 𝜑 ∧ 𝑡 = 𝑎))) ⇒ ⊢ ∀𝑥∃𝑦∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 ↔ (𝑧 ∈ 𝑥 ∧ 𝜑)) | ||
| 14-Mar-2026 | bj-rep 37433 | Version of the axiom of replacement requiring the functional relation in the axiom to be a (total) function from ax-rep 5206 (in the form of axrep6 5215). (Contributed by BJ, 14-Mar-2026.) The proof proves the statement without the DV condition on 𝑥, 𝜑, but the DV condition is added to this statement to show that this weaker version is sufficient. (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ∀𝑥(∀𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 ∃!𝑧𝜑 → ∃𝑡∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑡 ↔ ∃𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 𝜑)) | ||
| 14-Mar-2026 | bj-cbvaew 36991 | Exixtentially quantifying over a non-occurring variable is independent from the variable, under a weaker condition than in bj-cbvexvv 36987. (Contributed by BJ, 14-Mar-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ((∀𝑥𝜑 → ∀𝑦⊥) → (∃𝑦𝜓 → ∃𝑥𝜓)) | ||
| 14-Mar-2026 | bj-cbveaw 36990 | Universally quantifying over a non-occurring variable is independent from the variable, under a weaker condition than in bj-cbvalvv 36986. (Contributed by BJ, 14-Mar-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ((∃𝑥⊤ → ∃𝑦𝜑) → (∀𝑦𝜓 → ∀𝑥𝜓)) | ||
| 14-Mar-2026 | bj-cbvew 36989 | Existentially quantifying over a non-occurring variable is independent from the variable, under a weaker condition than in bj-cbvexvv 36987. If ⊤ is substituted for 𝜑, then the statement reads: "existentially quantifying over a non-occurring variable is independent from the variable as soon as that result is true for the True truth constant. The label "cbvew" means "'change bound variable' theorem, 'exists' quantifier, weak version". (Contributed by BJ, 14-Mar-2026.) This proof is intuitionistic. (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ((∃𝑥⊤ → ∃𝑦𝜑) → (∃𝑥𝜓 → ∃𝑦𝜓)) | ||
| 14-Mar-2026 | bj-cbvaw 36988 | Universally quantifying over a non-occurring variable is independent from the variable, under a weaker condition than in bj-cbvalvv 36986. If ⊥ is substituted for 𝜑, then the statement reads: "universally quantifying over a non-occurring variable is independent from the variable as soon as that result is true for the False truth constant". The label "cbvaw" means "'change bound variable' theorem, 'all' quantifier, weak version". (Contributed by BJ, 14-Mar-2026.) This proof is not intuitionistic (it uses ja 187); an intuitionistically valid statement is obtained by expressing the antecedent as a disjunction (classically equivalent through imor 859). (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ((∀𝑥𝜑 → ∀𝑦⊥) → (∀𝑥𝜓 → ∀𝑦𝜓)) | ||
| 14-Mar-2026 | bj-exextruan 36985 |
An equivalent expression for existential quantification over a
non-occurring variable proved over ax-1 6--
ax-5 1917. The forward
implication can be seen as a strengthening of ax-5 1917
(a conjunct is
added to the consequent of the implication). The reverse implication
can be strengthened when ax-6 1974 is posited (which implies that models
are non-empty), see 19.8v 1990. See bj-alextruim 36984 for a dual statement.
An approximate meaning is: the existential quantification of a proposition over a non-occurring variable holds if and only if the proposition holds and the universe is nonempty. (Contributed by BJ, 14-Mar-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥𝜑 ↔ (∃𝑥⊤ ∧ 𝜑)) | ||
| 14-Mar-2026 | bj-alextruim 36984 |
An equivalent expression for universal quantification over a
non-occurring variable proved over ax-1 6--
ax-5 1917. The forward
implication can be strengthened when ax-6 1974
is posited (which implies
that models are non-empty), see spvw 1988. The reverse implication can be
seen as a strengthening of ax-5 1917 (since the antecedent of the
implication is weakened). See bj-exextruan 36985 for a dual statement.
An approximate meaning is: the universal quantification of a proposition over a non-occurring variable holds if and only if the proposition holds in nonempty universes. (Contributed by BJ, 14-Mar-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (∀𝑥𝜑 ↔ (∃𝑥⊤ → 𝜑)) | ||
| 14-Mar-2026 | bj-exexalal 36924 | A lemma for changing bound variables. Only the forward implication is intuitionistic. (Contributed by BJ, 14-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((∃𝑥𝜑 → ∃𝑦𝜓) ↔ (∀𝑦 ¬ 𝜓 → ∀𝑥 ¬ 𝜑)) | ||
| 11-Mar-2026 | axprglem 5372 | Lemma for axprg 5373. (Contributed by GG, 11-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑥 = 𝐴 → ∃𝑧∀𝑤((𝑤 = 𝐴 ∨ 𝑤 = 𝐵) → 𝑤 ∈ 𝑧)) | ||
| 8-Mar-2026 | bj-axnul 37432 |
Over the base theory ax-1 6-- ax-5 1917, the axiom of separation implies
the weak emptyset axiom.
By "weak emptyset axiom", we mean the axiom asserting existence of an empty set (which can be called "the" empty set when the axiom of extensionality ax-ext 2712 is posited) provided existence of a set (the True truth constant existentially quantified over a fresh variable, extru 1982). This is the conclusion of bj-axnul 37432. Note that the weak emptyset axiom implies ⊢ (∃𝑥⊤ → ∃𝑦⊤) without DV conditions hence also the same statement as the weak emptyset axiom without DV conditions on 𝑥, but only on 𝑦, 𝑧. By "axiom of separation", we mean the universal closure of ax-sep 5225, simulated here by its instance with ⊥ substituted for 𝜑 (and with the variable used to assert existence in the weak emptyset axiom substituted for the containing set) as the hypothesis of bj-axnul 37432. In particular, the axiom of existence extru 1982 and the axiom of separation together imply the emptyset axiom (and conversely, the emptyset axiom implies the axiom of existence). Note: this theorem does not require a disjointness condition on 𝑦, 𝑧, although both axioms should be stated with all variables disjoint. This proof only uses an instance of the axiom of separation with a bounded formula, so is valid in a constructive setting (see the CZF section in the "Intuitionistic Logic Explorer" iset.mm). (Contributed by BJ, 8-Mar-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ∀𝑥∃𝑦∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 ↔ (𝑧 ∈ 𝑥 ∧ ⊥)) ⇒ ⊢ (∃𝑥⊤ → ∃𝑦∀𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 ⊥) | ||
| 8-Mar-2026 | bj-cbvexvv 36987 | Existentially quantifying over a non-occurring variable is independent of that variable, over ax-1 6-- ax-5 1917 and the existence axiom extru 1982. See bj-cbvew 36989 for a strengthening. (Contributed by BJ, 8-Mar-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥𝜑 → (∃𝑦𝜓 → ∃𝑥𝜓)) | ||
| 8-Mar-2026 | bj-cbvalvv 36986 | Universally quantifying over a non-occurring variable is independent of that variable, over ax-1 6-- ax-5 1917 and the existence axiom extru 1982. See bj-cbvaw 36988 for a strengthening. (Contributed by BJ, 8-Mar-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜓 → ∀𝑦𝜓)) | ||
| 8-Mar-2026 | bj-spvew 36983 | Version of 19.8v 1990 and 19.9v 1991 proved from ax-1 6-- ax-5 1917. The antecedent can for instance be proved with the existence axiom extru 1982. (Contributed by BJ, 8-Mar-2026.) This could also be proved from bj-spvw 36982 using duality, but that proof would not be intuitionistic, contrary to the present one. (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥𝜑 → (𝜓 ↔ ∃𝑥𝜓)) | ||
| 8-Mar-2026 | bj-spvw 36982 | Version of spvw 1988 and 19.3v 1989 proved from ax-1 6-- ax-5 1917. The antecedent can for instance be proved with the existence axiom extru 1982. (Contributed by BJ, 8-Mar-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥𝜑 → (𝜓 ↔ ∀𝑥𝜓)) | ||
| 8-Mar-2026 | bj-axdd2ALT 36967 | Alternate proof of bj-axdd2 36910 (this should replace bj-axdd2 36910 when bj-exalimi 36963 is moved to the main section). (Contributed by BJ, 8-Mar-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥𝜑 → (∀𝑥𝜓 → ∃𝑥𝜓)) | ||
| 6-Mar-2026 | opex 5410 | An ordered pair of classes is a set. Exercise 7 of [TakeutiZaring] p. 16. (Contributed by NM, 18-Aug-1993.) (Revised by Mario Carneiro, 26-Apr-2015.) Avoid ax-nul 5235. (Revised by GG, 6-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ 〈𝐴, 𝐵〉 ∈ V | ||
| 6-Mar-2026 | snexg 5376 | A singleton built on a set is a set. Special case of snex 5375 which is intuitionistically valid. (Contributed by NM, 7-Aug-1994.) (Revised by Mario Carneiro, 19-May-2013.) Extract from snex 5375 and shorten proof. (Revised by BJ, 15-Jan-2025.) (Proof shortened by GG, 6-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → {𝐴} ∈ V) | ||
| 6-Mar-2026 | snex 5375 | A singleton is a set. Theorem 7.12 of [Quine] p. 51, proved using Extensionality, Separation and Pairing. See also snexALT 5319. (Contributed by NM, 7-Aug-1994.) (Revised by Mario Carneiro, 19-May-2013.) Avoid ax-nul 5235 and shorten proof. (Revised by GG, 6-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ {𝐴} ∈ V | ||
| 6-Mar-2026 | prex 5374 | The Axiom of Pairing using class variables. Theorem 7.13 of [Quine] p. 51. By virtue of its definition, an unordered pair remains a set (even though no longer a pair) even when its components are proper classes (see prprc 4706), so we can dispense with hypotheses requiring them to be sets. (Contributed by NM, 15-Jul-1993.) Avoid ax-nul 5235 and shorten proof. (Revised by GG, 6-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ {𝐴, 𝐵} ∈ V | ||
| 6-Mar-2026 | axprg 5373 | Derive The Axiom of Pairing with class variables. (Contributed by GG, 6-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑧∀𝑤((𝑤 = 𝐴 ∨ 𝑤 = 𝐵) → 𝑤 ∈ 𝑧) | ||
| 5-Mar-2026 | mh-setindnd 36772 | A version of mh-setind 36771 with no distinct variable conditions. (Contributed by Matthew House, 5-Mar-2026.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (∀𝑦(∀𝑥(𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 → 𝜑) → ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → ∀𝑦𝜑)) → 𝜑) | ||
| 4-Mar-2026 | regsfromunir1 36775 | Derivation of ax-regs 35314 from unir1 9735. (Contributed by Matthew House, 4-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On) = V ⇒ ⊢ (∃𝑥𝜑 → ∃𝑦(∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → 𝜑) ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑧 → 𝜑)))) | ||
| 4-Mar-2026 | regsfromsetind 36774 | Derivation of ax-regs 35314 from mh-setind 36771. (Contributed by Matthew House, 4-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∀𝑦(∀𝑥(𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ 𝜑) → ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → ¬ 𝜑)) → ¬ 𝜑) ⇒ ⊢ (∃𝑥𝜑 → ∃𝑦(∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → 𝜑) ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑧 → 𝜑)))) | ||
| 4-Mar-2026 | regsfromregtco 36773 | Derivation of ax-regs 35314 from ax-reg 9504 + ax-tco 36707. (Contributed by Matthew House, 4-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑦 𝑦 ∈ 𝑤 → ∃𝑦(𝑦 ∈ 𝑤 ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ 𝑧 ∈ 𝑤))) & ⊢ ∃𝑢(𝑣 ∈ 𝑢 ∧ ∀𝑡(𝑡 ∈ 𝑢 → ∀𝑠(𝑠 ∈ 𝑡 → 𝑠 ∈ 𝑢))) ⇒ ⊢ (∃𝑥𝜑 → ∃𝑦(∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → 𝜑) ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑧 → 𝜑)))) | ||
| 4-Mar-2026 | mh-setind 36771 | Principle of set induction setind 9666, written with primitive symbols. (Contributed by Matthew House, 4-Mar-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∀𝑦(∀𝑥(𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 → 𝜑) → ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → 𝜑)) → 𝜑) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | eln0s2 28374 | A non-negative surreal integer is a surreal ordinal with a finite birthday. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℕ0s ↔ (𝐴 ∈ Ons ∧ ( bday ‘𝐴) ∈ ω)) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | peano2n0sd 28348 | Peano postulate: the successor of a non-negative surreal integer is a non-negative surreal integer. Deduction form. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℕ0s) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 +s 1s ) ∈ ℕ0s) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | divs1d 28222 | A surreal divided by one is itself. Deduction version. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 /su 1s ) = 𝐴) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | rightnod 27899 | An element of a right set is a surreal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ( R ‘𝐵)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | rightoldd 27898 | An element of a right set is an element of the old set. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ( R ‘𝐵)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ( O ‘( bday ‘𝐵))) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | leftnod 27897 | An element of a left set is a surreal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ( L ‘𝐵)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | leftoldd 27896 | An element of a left set is an element of the old set. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ( L ‘𝐵)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ( O ‘( bday ‘𝐵))) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | rightno 27895 | An element of a right set is a surreal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ( R ‘𝐵) → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | leftno 27894 | An element of a left set is a surreal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ( L ‘𝐵) → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | rightold 27893 | An element of a right set is an element of the old set. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ( R ‘𝐵) → 𝐴 ∈ ( O ‘( bday ‘𝐵))) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | leftold 27892 | An element of a left set is an element of the old set. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ( L ‘𝐵) → 𝐴 ∈ ( O ‘( bday ‘𝐵))) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | oldmaded 27886 | An element of an old set is an element of a made set. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ( O ‘𝐵)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ( M ‘𝐵)) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | oldmade 27885 | An element of an old set is an element of a made set. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ( O ‘𝐵) → 𝐴 ∈ ( M ‘𝐵)) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | newnod 27865 | An element of a new set is a surreal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ( N ‘𝐵)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | oldnod 27864 | An element of an old set is a surreal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ( O ‘𝐵)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | madenod 27863 | An element of a made set is a surreal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ( M ‘𝐵)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | newno 27862 | An element of a new set is a surreal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ( N ‘𝐵) → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | oldno 27861 | An element of an old set is a surreal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ( O ‘𝐵) → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | madeno 27860 | An element of a made set is a surreal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ( M ‘𝐵) → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | nulsgtsd 27795 | The empty set is greater than any set of surreals. Deduction version. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ⊆ No ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 <<s ∅) | ||
| 27-Feb-2026 | nulsltsd 27794 | The empty set is less-than any set of surreals. Deduction version. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 27-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ⊆ No ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ∅ <<s 𝐴) | ||
| 26-Feb-2026 | dfz12s2 28505 | The set of dyadic fractions is the same as the old set of ω. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 26-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ℤs[1/2] = ( O ‘ω) | ||
| 26-Feb-2026 | bdayfin 28504 | A surreal has a finite birthday iff it is a dyadic fraction. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 26-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ No → (𝐴 ∈ ℤs[1/2] ↔ ( bday ‘𝐴) ∈ ω)) | ||
| 26-Feb-2026 | bdayfinlem 28503 | Lemma for bdayfin 28504. Handle the non-negative case. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 26-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ No ∧ 0s ≤s 𝐴 ∧ ( bday ‘𝐴) ∈ ω) → 𝐴 ∈ ℤs[1/2]) | ||
| 26-Feb-2026 | bdayfinbnd 28486 | Given a non-negative integer and a non-negative surreal of lesser or equal birthday, show that the surreal can be expressed as a dyadic fraction with an upper bound on the integer and exponent. This proof follows the proof from Mizar at https://mizar.uwb.edu.pl/version/current/html/surrealn.html. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 26-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ( bday ‘𝑍) ⊆ ( bday ‘𝑁)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 0s ≤s 𝑍) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑍 = 𝑁 ∨ ∃𝑥 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑦 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑝 ∈ ℕ0s (𝑍 = (𝑥 +s (𝑦 /su (2s↑s𝑝))) ∧ 𝑦 <s (2s↑s𝑝) ∧ (𝑥 +s 𝑝) <s 𝑁))) | ||
| 26-Feb-2026 | bdayfinbndlem2 28485 | Lemma for bdayfinbnd 28486. Conduct the induction. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 26-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s → ∀𝑧 ∈ No ((( bday ‘𝑧) ⊆ ( bday ‘𝑁) ∧ 0s ≤s 𝑧) → (𝑧 = 𝑁 ∨ ∃𝑥 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑦 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑝 ∈ ℕ0s (𝑧 = (𝑥 +s (𝑦 /su (2s↑s𝑝))) ∧ 𝑦 <s (2s↑s𝑝) ∧ (𝑥 +s 𝑝) <s 𝑁)))) | ||
| 26-Feb-2026 | bdayfinbndlem1 28484 | Lemma for bdayfinbnd 28486. Show the first half of the inductive step. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 26-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑧 ∈ No ((( bday ‘𝑧) ⊆ ( bday ‘𝑁) ∧ 0s ≤s 𝑧) → (𝑧 = 𝑁 ∨ ∃𝑥 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑦 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑝 ∈ ℕ0s (𝑧 = (𝑥 +s (𝑦 /su (2s↑s𝑝))) ∧ 𝑦 <s (2s↑s𝑝) ∧ (𝑥 +s 𝑝) <s 𝑁)))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑤 ∈ No ((( bday ‘𝑤) ⊆ ( bday ‘(𝑁 +s 1s )) ∧ 0s ≤s 𝑤) → (𝑤 = (𝑁 +s 1s ) ∨ ∃𝑎 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑏 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑞 ∈ ℕ0s (𝑤 = (𝑎 +s (𝑏 /su (2s↑s𝑞))) ∧ 𝑏 <s (2s↑s𝑞) ∧ (𝑎 +s 𝑞) <s (𝑁 +s 1s ))))) | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | dfpeters2 39348 |
Alternate definition of PetErs in fully modular form.
This expands the Ers 𝑛 predicate into: (i) a typedness module ( Rels × CoMembErs ), (ii) an equivalence module for the coset relation ≀ (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛)) ∈ EqvRels, (iii) the corresponding quotient-carrier (domain quotient) equation dom ≀ (...) / ≀ (...) = 𝑛. This is the equivalence-side counterpart of the modular decomposition dfpetparts2 39346 on the partition side. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ PetErs = ((( Rels × CoMembErs ) ∩ {〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 ∣ ≀ (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛)) ∈ EqvRels }) ∩ {〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 ∣ (dom ≀ (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛)) / ≀ (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛))) = 𝑛}) | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | dfpet2parts2 39347 |
Grade stability applied to the decomposed PetParts
modules.
Pet2Parts is obtained by applying the grade-stability operator SucMap ShiftStable (see df-shiftstable 38856) to the modular intersection from dfpetparts2 39346. This makes the two orthogonal stability axes explicit: (E) semantic stability / equilibrium: BlockLiftFix, (G) grade stability: SucMap ShiftStable, assembled on top of typedness and disjoint-span base modules. This is the principled "extra level" that does not arise for Disjs: disjoint relations already bundle their internal map/carrier consistency via QMap and ElDisjs (see dfdisjs6 39316 / dfdisjs7 39317), while the present construction has an additional external grading axis imposed by the canonical successor map SucMap. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 20-Feb-2026.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Pet2Parts = ( SucMap ShiftStable ((( Rels × MembParts ) ∩ {〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 ∣ (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛)) ∈ Disjs }) ∩ BlockLiftFix )) | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | dfpetparts2 39346 |
Alternate definition of PetParts as typedness +
disjoint-span +
block-lift equilibrium.
This theorem is the key modularization step. It decomposes PetParts into the intersection of three orthogonal modules: (T) typedness: 〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 ∈ ( Rels × MembParts ), (D) disjoint-span: (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛)) ∈ Disjs, (E) semantic equilibrium: 〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 ∈ BlockLiftFix, i.e. the carrier 𝑛 is a fixpoint of the induced block-generation operator. Conceptually, (D) provides the disjointness/quotient discipline for the lifted span, while (E) prevents hidden carrier drift (refinement or coarsening of what counts as a block) by enforcing the fixpoint equation. The point of this theorem is that these constraints can be imposed and reused independently by later constructions, while their intersection recovers the intended Parts-based notion. This mirrors the internal packaging of Disjs (see dfdisjs6 39316 / dfdisjs7 39317): for disjoint relations, the "map layer + carrier layer" decomposition is internal via QMap and ElDisjs; for PetParts, the carrier 𝑛 is an external parameter, so the additional carrier stability must be factored explicitly as BlockLiftFix. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 20-Feb-2026.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ PetParts = ((( Rels × MembParts ) ∩ {〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 ∣ (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛)) ∈ Disjs }) ∩ BlockLiftFix ) | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | df-peters 39343 |
Define the class of equivalence-side general partition-equivalence
spans.
〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 ∈ PetErs means: (1) 𝑟 is a set-relation (𝑟 ∈ Rels), and (2) 𝑛 is a carrier recognized on the equivalence side of membership (𝑛 ∈ CoMembErs), and (3) the coset relation of the lifted span, ≀ (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛)), is an equivalence relation on its natural quotient with carrier 𝑛 (i.e. ≀ (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛)) Ers 𝑛). This packages the equivalence-view of the same lifted construction that underlies PetParts. It is designed to be parallel to PetParts so later proofs can freely choose the partition side (Parts) or the equivalence side (Ers) without rebuilding the bridge each time; the identification is provided by petseq 39350 (using typesafepets 39349 and mpets 39330). The explicit typing (𝑟 ∈ Rels ∧ 𝑛 ∈ CoMembErs ) is included for the same reason as in df-petparts 39342: to make typedness a reusable module. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 19-Feb-2026.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ PetErs = {〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 ∣ ((𝑟 ∈ Rels ∧ 𝑛 ∈ CoMembErs ) ∧ ≀ (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛)) Ers 𝑛)} | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | df-petparts 39342 |
Define the class of partition-side general partition-equivalence spans.
〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 ∈ PetParts means: (1) 𝑟 is a set-relation (𝑟 ∈ Rels), and (2) 𝑛 is a membership block-carrier (𝑛 ∈ MembParts), and (3) the block-lift span (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛)) is a generalized partition on its natural quotient-carrier 𝑛 (i.e. (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛)) Parts 𝑛). This is the horizontal feasibility base object on the partition side, expressed in the type-safe Parts language. The explicit typing (𝑟 ∈ Rels ∧ 𝑛 ∈ MembParts ) is included at the definition level so later modular refinements can treat typedness as a first-class component (e.g. intersecting a typedness module with disjointness and equilibrium modules) without repeatedly restating it. In particular, it lets decompositions such as dfpetparts2 39346 be written as clean intersections whose first conjunct is exactly the typedness module ( Rels × MembParts ). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 19-Feb-2026.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ PetParts = {〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 ∣ ((𝑟 ∈ Rels ∧ 𝑛 ∈ MembParts ) ∧ (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑛)) Parts 𝑛)} | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | bdayfinbndcbv 28483 | Lemma for bdayfinbnd 28486. Change some bound variables. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑧 ∈ No ((( bday ‘𝑧) ⊆ ( bday ‘𝑁) ∧ 0s ≤s 𝑧) → (𝑧 = 𝑁 ∨ ∃𝑥 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑦 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑝 ∈ ℕ0s (𝑧 = (𝑥 +s (𝑦 /su (2s↑s𝑝))) ∧ 𝑦 <s (2s↑s𝑝) ∧ (𝑥 +s 𝑝) <s 𝑁)))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑤 ∈ No ((( bday ‘𝑤) ⊆ ( bday ‘𝑁) ∧ 0s ≤s 𝑤) → (𝑤 = 𝑁 ∨ ∃𝑎 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑏 ∈ ℕ0s ∃𝑞 ∈ ℕ0s (𝑤 = (𝑎 +s (𝑏 /su (2s↑s𝑞))) ∧ 𝑏 <s (2s↑s𝑞) ∧ (𝑎 +s 𝑞) <s 𝑁)))) | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | bdaypw2bnd 28482 | Birthday bounding rule for non-negative dyadic rationals. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑃 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 <s (2s↑s𝑃)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 +s 𝑃) <s 𝑁) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( bday ‘(𝑋 +s (𝑌 /su (2s↑s𝑃)))) ⊆ ( bday ‘𝑁)) | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | onlesd 28287 | Less-than or equal is the same as non-strict birthday comparison over surreal ordinals. Deduction version. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Ons) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ Ons) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 ≤s 𝐵 ↔ ( bday ‘𝐴) ⊆ ( bday ‘𝐵))) | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | onltsd 28286 | Less-than is the same as birthday comparison over surreal ordinals. Deduction version. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Ons) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ Ons) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 <s 𝐵 ↔ ( bday ‘𝐴) ∈ ( bday ‘𝐵))) | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | onles 28285 | Less-than or equal is the same as non-strict birthday comparison over surreal ordinals. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ Ons ∧ 𝐵 ∈ Ons) → (𝐴 ≤s 𝐵 ↔ ( bday ‘𝐴) ⊆ ( bday ‘𝐵))) | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | lestri3d 27748 | Trichotomy law for surreal less-than or equal. Deduction version. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 = 𝐵 ↔ (𝐴 ≤s 𝐵 ∧ 𝐵 ≤s 𝐴))) | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | lesloed 27747 | Surreal less-than or equal in terms of less-than. Deduction version. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 ≤s 𝐵 ↔ (𝐴 <s 𝐵 ∨ 𝐴 = 𝐵))) | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | ltsnled 27746 | Surreal less-than in terms of less-than or equal. Deduction version. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 <s 𝐵 ↔ ¬ 𝐵 ≤s 𝐴)) | ||
| 25-Feb-2026 | lesnltd 27745 | Surreal less-than or equal in terms of less-than. Deduction version. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 25-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 ≤s 𝐵 ↔ ¬ 𝐵 <s 𝐴)) | ||
| 24-Feb-2026 | addsge01d 28033 | A surreal is less-than or equal to itself plus a non-negative surreal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 24-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( 0s ≤s 𝐵 ↔ 𝐴 ≤s (𝐴 +s 𝐵))) | ||
| 24-Feb-2026 | funcnvmpt 6944 | Condition for a function in maps-to notation to be single-rooted. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 28-Feb-2017.) (Proof shortened by Peter Mazsa, 24-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥𝜑 & ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥𝐴 & ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥𝐹 & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ↦ 𝐵) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴) → 𝐵 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (Fun ◡𝐹 ↔ ∀𝑦∃*𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝑦 = 𝐵)) | ||
| 24-Feb-2026 | bian1d 585 | Adding a superfluous conjunct in a biconditional. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 26-Feb-2017.) (Proof shortened by Hongxiu Chen, 29-Jun-2025.) (Proof shortened by Peter Mazsa, 24-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜓 ↔ (𝜒 ∧ 𝜃))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝜒 ∧ 𝜓) ↔ (𝜒 ∧ 𝜃))) | ||
| 23-Feb-2026 | pw2ltdivmuls2d 28474 | Surreal less-than relationship between division and multiplication for powers of two. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 23-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 /su (2s↑s𝑁)) <s 𝐵 ↔ 𝐴 <s (𝐵 ·s (2s↑s𝑁)))) | ||
| 23-Feb-2026 | n0lts1e0 28385 | A non-negative surreal integer is less than one iff it is zero. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 23-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℕ0s → (𝐴 <s 1s ↔ 𝐴 = 0s )) | ||
| 23-Feb-2026 | cutminmax 27953 | If the left set of 𝑋 has a maximum and the right set of 𝑋 has a minimum, then 𝑋 is equal to the cut of the maximum and the minimum. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 23-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐿 ∈ ( L ‘𝑋)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥 ∈ ( L ‘𝑋)𝑥 ≤s 𝐿) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ ( R ‘𝑋)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑦 ∈ ( R ‘𝑋)𝑅 ≤s 𝑦) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 = ({𝐿} |s {𝑅})) | ||
| 23-Feb-2026 | sltsbday 27934 | Birthday comparison rule for surreals. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 23-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 = (𝐿 |s 𝑅)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐿 <<s {𝐵}) & ⊢ (𝜑 → {𝐵} <<s 𝑅) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( bday ‘𝐴) ⊆ ( bday ‘𝐵)) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | dfblockliftmap 38834 | Alternate definition of the block lift map. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 29-Jan-2026.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 BlockLiftMap 𝐴) = (𝑚 ∈ dom (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) ↦ [𝑚](𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴))) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | df-blockliftmap 38833 |
Define the block lift map. Given a relation 𝑅 and a carrier/set
𝐴, we form the block relation (𝑅 ⋉
◡ E ) (i.e., "follow
both 𝑅 and element"), restricted to
𝐴
(or, equivalently, "follow
both 𝑅 and elements-of-A", cf. xrnres2 38800). Then map each domain
element 𝑚 to its coset [𝑚] under that restricted
block relation.
For 𝑚 in the domain, which requires (𝑚 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ 𝑚 ≠ ∅ ∧ [𝑚]𝑅 ≠ ∅) (cf. eldmxrncnvepres 38808), the fiber has the product form [𝑚](𝑅 ⋉ ◡ E ) = ([𝑚]𝑅 × 𝑚), so the block relation lifts a block 𝑚 to the rectangular grid "external labels × internal members", see dfblockliftmap2 38835. Contrast: while the adjoined lift, via (𝑅 ∪ ◡ E ), attaches neighbors and members in a single relation (see dfadjliftmap2 38831), the block lift labels each internal member by each external neighbor. For the general case and a two-stage construction (first block lift, then adjoin membership), see the comments to df-adjliftmap 38829. For the equilibrium condition, see df-blockliftfix 38855. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 24-Jan-2026.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 BlockLiftMap 𝐴) = QMap (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | dfadjliftmap 38830 | Alternate (expanded) definition of the adjoined lift map. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 28-Jan-2026.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 AdjLiftMap 𝐴) = (𝑚 ∈ dom ((𝑅 ∪ ◡ E ) ↾ 𝐴) ↦ [𝑚]((𝑅 ∪ ◡ E ) ↾ 𝐴)) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | df-adjliftmap 38829 |
Define the adjoined lift map. Given a relation 𝑅 and a carrier/set
𝐴, we form the adjoined relation (𝑅 ∪ ◡ E ) (i.e., "follow
𝑅 or follow elements"),
restricted to 𝐴, and map each domain
element 𝑚 to its coset [𝑚] under that restricted
adjoined
relation, see its expanded version dfadjliftmap 38830. Thus, for 𝑚 in
its domain, we have (𝑚 ∪ [𝑚]𝑅), see dfadjliftmap2 38831.
Its key special case is successor: for 𝑅 = I and 𝐴 = dom I, or 𝐴 = V, the adjoined relation is ( I ∪ ◡ E ), and the coset becomes [𝑚]( I ∪ ◡ E ) = (𝑚 ∪ {𝑚}). So ( I AdjLiftMap dom I ) or ( I AdjLiftMap V) (see dfsucmap2 38838 and dfsucmap3 38837) are exactly the successor map 𝑚 ↦ suc 𝑚 (cf. dfsucmap4 38839), which is a prerequisite for accepting the adjoining lift as the right generalization of successor. A maximally generic form would be "( R F LiftMap A )" defined as (𝑚 ∈ dom ((𝑅𝐹◡ E ) ↾ 𝐴) ↦ [𝑚]((𝑅𝐹◡ E ) ↾ 𝐴)) where 𝐹 is an object-level binary operator on relations (used via df-ov 7366). However, ∪ and ⋉ are introduced in set.mm as class constructors (e.g. df-un 3895), not as an object-level binary function symbol 𝐹 that can be passed as a parameter. To make the generic 𝐹-pattern literally usable, we would need to reify union and ⋉ as function-objects, which is additional infrastructure. To avoid introducing operator-as-function objects solely to support 𝐹, we define: AdjLiftMap directly using df-un 3895, and BlockLiftMap directly using the existing ⋉ constructor dfxrn2 38759, so we treat any "generic 𝐹-LiftMap" as optional future generalization, not a dependency. We prefer to avoid defining too many concepts. For this reason, we will not introduce a named "adjoining relation", a named carrier "adjoining lift" "( R AdjLift A )", in place of ran (𝑅 AdjLiftMap 𝐴), which is (dom ((𝑅 ∪ ◡ E ) ↾ 𝐴) / ((𝑅 ∪ ◡ E ) ↾ 𝐴)), cf. dfqs2 8647, or the equilibrium condition "AdjLiftFix" , in place of {〈𝑟, 𝑎〉 ∣ (dom ((𝑅 ∪ ◡ E ) ↾ 𝐴) / ((𝑅 ∪ ◡ E ) ↾ 𝐴)) = 𝑎} (cf. its analog df-blockliftfix 38855). These are definable by simple expansions and/or domain-quotient theorems when needed. A "two-stage" construction is obtained by first forming the block relation (𝑅 ⋉ ◡ E ) and then adjoining elements as "BlockAdj" . Combined, it uses the relation ((𝑅 ⋉ ◡ E ) ∪ ◡ E ), which for 𝑚 in its domain (𝐴 ∖ {∅}) gives (𝑚 ∪ [𝑚](𝑅 ⋉ ◡ E )), yielding "BlockAdjLiftMap" (cf. blockadjliftmap 38832) and "BlockAdjLiftFix". We only introduce these if a downstream theorem actually requires them. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 24-Jan-2026.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 AdjLiftMap 𝐴) = QMap ((𝑅 ∪ ◡ E ) ↾ 𝐴) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | z12bday 28502 | A dyadic fraction has a finite birthday. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 20-Aug-2025.) (Proof shortened by Scott Fenton, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℤs[1/2] → ( bday ‘𝐴) ∈ ω) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | z12bdaylem 28501 | Lemma for z12bday 28502. Handle the non-negative case. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℤs[1/2] ∧ 0s ≤s 𝐴) → ( bday ‘𝐴) ∈ ω) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | z12bdaylem2 28488 | Lemma for z12bday 28502. Show the first half of the equality. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑃 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((2s ·s 𝑀) +s 1s ) <s (2s↑s𝑃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( bday ‘(𝑁 +s (((2s ·s 𝑀) +s 1s ) /su (2s↑s𝑃)))) ⊆ ( bday ‘((𝑁 +s 𝑃) +s 1s ))) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | z12bdaylem1 28487 | Lemma for z12bday 28502. Prove an inequality for birthday ordering. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑃 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((2s ·s 𝑀) +s 1s ) <s (2s↑s𝑃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑁 +s (((2s ·s 𝑀) +s 1s ) /su (2s↑s𝑃))) ≠ (𝑁 +s 𝑃)) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | bdaypw2n0bnd 28481 | Upper bound for the birthday of a proper fraction of a power of two. This is actually a strict equality when 𝐴 is odd, but we do not need this for the rest of our development. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℕ0s ∧ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s ∧ 𝐴 <s (2s↑s𝑁)) → ( bday ‘(𝐴 /su (2s↑s𝑁))) ⊆ suc ( bday ‘𝑁)) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | onsbnd2 28299 | The surreals of a given birthday are bounded below by the negative of that ordinal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ Ons ∧ 𝐵 ∈ ( M ‘( bday ‘𝐴))) → ( -us ‘𝐴) ≤s 𝐵) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | onsbnd 28298 | The surreals of a given birthday are bounded above by that ordinal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ Ons ∧ 𝐵 ∈ ( M ‘( bday ‘𝐴))) → 𝐵 ≤s 𝐴) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | addonbday 28296 | The birthday of the sum of two ordinals is the natural sum of their birthdays. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ Ons ∧ 𝐵 ∈ Ons) → ( bday ‘(𝐴 +s 𝐵)) = (( bday ‘𝐴) +no ( bday ‘𝐵))) | ||
| 22-Feb-2026 | ons2ind 28292 | Double induction schema for surreal ordinals. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 22-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑥 = 𝑥𝑂 → (𝜑 ↔ 𝜓)) & ⊢ (𝑦 = 𝑦𝑂 → (𝜓 ↔ 𝜒)) & ⊢ (𝑥 = 𝑥𝑂 → (𝜃 ↔ 𝜒)) & ⊢ (𝑥 = 𝐴 → (𝜑 ↔ 𝜏)) & ⊢ (𝑦 = 𝐵 → (𝜏 ↔ 𝜂)) & ⊢ ((𝑥 ∈ Ons ∧ 𝑦 ∈ Ons) → ((∀𝑥𝑂 ∈ Ons ∀𝑦𝑂 ∈ Ons ((𝑥𝑂 <s 𝑥 ∧ 𝑦𝑂 <s 𝑦) → 𝜒) ∧ ∀𝑥𝑂 ∈ Ons (𝑥𝑂 <s 𝑥 → 𝜓) ∧ ∀𝑦𝑂 ∈ Ons (𝑦𝑂 <s 𝑦 → 𝜃)) → 𝜑)) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ Ons ∧ 𝐵 ∈ Ons) → 𝜂) | ||
| 21-Feb-2026 | elz12si 28490 | Inference form of membership in the dyadic fractions. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 21-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℤs ∧ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) → (𝐴 /su (2s↑s𝑁)) ∈ ℤs[1/2]) | ||
| 21-Feb-2026 | bdaypw2n0bndlem 28480 | Lemma for bdaypw2n0bnd 28481. Prove the case with a successor. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 21-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℕ0s ∧ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s ∧ 𝐴 <s (2s↑s(𝑁 +s 1s ))) → ( bday ‘(𝐴 /su (2s↑s(𝑁 +s 1s )))) ⊆ suc ( bday ‘(𝑁 +s 1s ))) | ||
| 21-Feb-2026 | pw2divsidd 28473 | Identity law for division over powers of two. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 21-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((2s↑s𝑁) /su (2s↑s𝑁)) = 1s ) | ||
| 21-Feb-2026 | pw2divs0d 28472 | Division into zero is zero for a power of two. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 21-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( 0s /su (2s↑s𝑁)) = 0s ) | ||
| 21-Feb-2026 | zcuts0 28425 | Either the left or right set of a surreal integer is empty. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 21-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℤs → (( L ‘𝐴) = ∅ ∨ ( R ‘𝐴) = ∅)) | ||
| 21-Feb-2026 | negright 28076 | The right set of the negative of a surreal is the set of negatives of its left set. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 21-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ No → ( R ‘( -us ‘𝐴)) = ( -us “ ( L ‘𝐴))) | ||
| 21-Feb-2026 | negleft 28075 | The left set of the negative of a surreal is the set of negatives of its right set. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 21-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ No → ( L ‘( -us ‘𝐴)) = ( -us “ ( R ‘𝐴))) | ||
| 20-Feb-2026 | df-blockliftfix 38855 |
Define the equilibrium / fixed-point condition for "block carriers".
Start with a candidate block-family 𝑎 (a set whose elements you intend to treat as blocks). Combine it with a relation 𝑟 by forming the block-lift span 𝑇 = (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑎)). For a block 𝑢 ∈ 𝑎, the fiber [𝑢]𝑇 is the set of all outputs produced from "external targets" of 𝑟 together with "internal members" of 𝑢; in other words, 𝑇 is the mechanism that generates new blocks from old ones. Now apply the standard quotient construction (dom 𝑇 / 𝑇). This produces the family of all T-blocks (the cosets [𝑥]𝑇 of witnesses 𝑥 in the domain of 𝑇). In general, this operation can change your carrier: starting from 𝑎, it may generate a different block-family (dom 𝑇 / 𝑇). The equation (dom (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑎)) / (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑎))) = 𝑎 says exactly: if you generate blocks from 𝑎 using the lift determined by 𝑟 (cf. df-blockliftmap 38833), you get back the same 𝑎. So 𝑎 is stable under the block-generation operator induced by 𝑟. This is why it is a genuine fixpoint/equilibrium condition: one application of the "make-the-blocks" operator causes no carrier drift, i.e. no hidden refinement/coarsening of what counts as a block. Here, the quotient (dom 𝑇 / 𝑇) is the standard carrier of 𝑇 -blocks; see dfqs2 8647 for the quotient-as-range viewpoint. This is an untyped equilibrium predicate on pairs 〈𝑟, 𝑎〉. No hypothesis 𝑟 ∈ Rels is built into the definition, because the fixpoint equation depends only on those ordered pairs 〈𝑥, 𝑦〉 that belong to 𝑟 and hence can witness an atomic instance 𝑥𝑟𝑦; extra non-ordered-pair "junk" elements in 𝑟 are ignored automatically by the relational membership predicate. When later work needs 𝑟 to be relation-typed (e.g. to intersect with ( Rels × V)-style typedness modules, or to apply Rels-based infrastructure uniformly), the additional typing constraint 𝑟 ∈ Rels should be imposed locally as a separate conjunct (rather than being baked into this equilibrium module). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 25-Jan-2026.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 20-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ BlockLiftFix = {〈𝑟, 𝑎〉 ∣ (dom (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑎)) / (𝑟 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝑎))) = 𝑎} | ||
| 20-Feb-2026 | n0ssoldg 28370 | The non-negative surreal integers are a subset of the old set of ω. To avoid the axiom of infinity, we include it as an antecedent. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 20-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (ω ∈ V → ℕ0s ⊆ ( O ‘ω)) | ||
| 20-Feb-2026 | infinf 10487 | Equivalence between two infiniteness criteria for sets. (Contributed by David Moews, 1-May-2017.) (Proof shortened by Scott Fenton, 20-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝐵 → (¬ 𝐴 ∈ Fin ↔ ω ≼ 𝐴)) | ||
| 20-Feb-2026 | infinfg 10486 | Equivalence between two infiniteness criteria for sets. To avoid the axiom of infinity, we include it as a hypothesis. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 20-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((ω ∈ V ∧ 𝐴 ∈ 𝐵) → (¬ 𝐴 ∈ Fin ↔ ω ≼ 𝐴)) | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | pets2eq 39351 | Grade-stable generalized partition-equivalence identification. After applying the same grade-stability operator (SucMap ShiftStable) to both sides, the grade-stable pet classes still coincide. Confirms that the grade/tower infrastructure is orthogonal to the partition-vs-equivalence viewpoint: stability is preserved under the PetParts = PetErs identification. This is the level at which we can freely work on whichever side is more convenient (Parts for block discipline, Ers for equivalence reasoning), without changing the stable notion of "pet". (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 19-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Pet2Parts = Pet2Ers | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | petseq 39350 |
Generalized partition-equivalence identification.
The partition-side scheme PetParts and the equivalence-side scheme PetErs define the same class of spans (pairs 〈𝑟, 𝑛〉). This plays the same organizational role for lifted spans that mpets 39330 plays for carriers: mpets 39330 identifies MembParts with CoMembErs at the membership-carrier level, while petseq 39350 identifies the corresponding span-level predicates built from Parts and Ers. Unlike the earlier broad pets 39340, the bridge used here is the type-safe span theorem typesafepets 39349, which restricts to membership block-carriers. Since typedness (𝑟 ∈ Rels and the appropriate carrier condition) is now built directly into PetParts and PetErs, this theorem can be used downstream without repeatedly re-establishing basic typing premises. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 19-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ PetParts = PetErs | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | typesafepets 39349 | Type-safe pets 39340 scheme. On a membership block-carrier 𝐴 ∈ MembParts, the lifted span (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) yields a generalized partition of 𝐴 iff its coset relation yields an equivalence relation on the same carrier 𝐴. This is the type-safe replacement for the earlier broad pets 39340: it explicitly restricts to carriers where 𝐴 is already known to be a block-family (by MembParts). That removes the standard type-safety objection ("are you equating a quotient-carrier of blocks with raw witnesses?") by construction. It is the key bridge used to identify the partition-side and equivalence-side pet classes (petseq 39350), in complete parallel with the membership bridge mpets 39330. This theorem is intentionally not the definition of PetParts; it is the bridge used by petseq 39350 after typedness is enforced by the "Pet*" definitions. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 19-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ MembParts ∧ 𝑅 ∈ 𝑉) → ((𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) Parts 𝐴 ↔ ≀ (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) Ers 𝐴)) | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | df-pet2ers 39345 | Define the class of grade- and blocklift-stable equivalence-side general partition-equivalence spans. The equivalence-side analogue of Pet2Parts: stability of PetErs under one-step grade shift along SucMap. Ensures that the equivalence-side formulation supports the same tower/grade infrastructure as the partition-side formulation. SucMap ShiftStable is the grade axis and does not change the equivalence-vs-partition viewpoint (reinforced by pets2eq 39351). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 19-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Pet2Ers = ( SucMap ShiftStable PetErs ) | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | df-pet2parts 39344 | Define the class of grade- and blocklift-stable partition-side general partition-equivalence spans. It consists of those 〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 ∈ PetParts such that 〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 remains in PetParts after shifting one grade along SucMap (via ShiftStable). Concretely: 〈𝑟, 𝑛〉 ∈ PetParts and there exists a predecessor 𝑚 with suc 𝑚 = 𝑛 such that 〈𝑟, 𝑚〉 ∈ PetParts (encoded by SucMap ∘ PetParts inside ShiftStable). I.e., it introduces the external (tower/grade) stability axis. This is the "4th level" for pet 39339 (see dfpet2parts2 39347): beyond (i) carrier membership partition, (ii) disjointness, and (iii) semantic equilibrium, we require (iv) stability under a canonical grade shift. PetParts already enforces disjointness and the quotient-carrier equation for the lifted span (hence semantic equilibrium via dfpetparts2 39346). Pet2Parts adds the external grade (tower) stability axis via df-shiftstable 38856 with SucMap. This (iv) is why we need explicit second-level Pet2Parts, while Disjs typically does not: Disjs already packages its own internal two-step consistency (carrier + map) by dfdisjs6 39316 / dfdisjs7 39317, whereas pet 39339 has an additional grade axis that must be imposed separately. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 19-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Pet2Parts = ( SucMap ShiftStable PetParts ) | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | shiftstableeq2 38857 | Equality theorem for shift-stability of two classes. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 19-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐹 = 𝐺 → (𝑆 ShiftStable 𝐹) = (𝑆 ShiftStable 𝐺)) | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | ecqmap2 38824 | Fiber of QMap equals singleton quotient: a conceptual bridge between "map fibers" and quotients. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 19-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ dom 𝑅 → [𝐴] QMap 𝑅 = ({𝐴} / 𝑅)) | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | bj-dfsbc 36999 | Proof of df-sbc 3731 when taking bj-df-sb 36997 as definition. (Contributed by BJ, 19-Feb-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ {𝑥 ∣ 𝜑} ↔ [𝐴 / 𝑥]𝜑) | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | bj-sbcex 36998 | Proof of sbcex 3740 when taking bj-df-sb 36997 as definition. (Contributed by BJ, 19-Feb-2026.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ([𝐴 / 𝑥]𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ V) | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | bj-df-sb 36997 | Proposed definition to replace df-sb 2074 and df-sbc 3731. Proof is therefore unimportant. Contrary to df-sb 2074, this definition makes a substituted formula false when one substitutes a non-existent object for a variable: this is better suited to the "Levy-style" treatment of classes as virtual objects adopted by set.mm. That difference is unimportant since as soon as ax6ev 1976 is posited, all variables "exist". (Contributed by BJ, 19-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ([𝐴 / 𝑥]𝜑 ↔ ∃𝑦(𝑦 = 𝐴 ∧ ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → 𝜑))) | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | renod 28510 | A surreal real is a surreal number. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 19-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝs) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | reno 28509 | A surreal real is a surreal number. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 19-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℝs → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | oldfib 28394 | The old set of an ordinal is finite iff the ordinal is finite. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 19-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ On → (𝐴 ∈ ω ↔ ( O ‘𝐴) ∈ Fin)) | ||
| 19-Feb-2026 | ordfin 9147 | A generalization of onfin 9146 to include the class of all ordinals. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 19-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (Ord 𝐴 → (𝐴 ∈ Fin ↔ 𝐴 ∈ ω)) | ||
| 18-Feb-2026 | suceldisj 39192 | Disjointness of successor enforces element-carrier separation: If 𝐵 is the successor of 𝐴 and 𝐵 is element-disjoint as a family, then no element of 𝐴 can itself be a member of 𝐴 (equivalently, every 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 has empty intersection with the carrier 𝐴). Provides a clean bridge between "disjoint family at the next grade" and "no block contains a block of the same family" at the previous grade: MembPart alone does not enforce this, see dfmembpart2 39247 (it gives disjoint blocks and excludes the empty block, but does not prevent 𝑢 ∈ 𝑚 from also being a member of the carrier 𝑚). This lemma is used to justify when grade-stability (via successor-shift) supplies the extra separation axioms needed in roof/root-style carrier reasoning. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 18-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ ElDisj 𝐵 ∧ suc 𝐴 = 𝐵) → ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 (𝑥 ∩ 𝐴) = ∅) | ||
| 18-Feb-2026 | wl-eujustlem1 37966 | Version of cbvexvw 2044 with references to ax-6 1974 listed as antecedents. (Contributed by Wolf Lammen, 18-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑥 = 𝑦 → (𝜑 ↔ 𝜓)) ⇒ ⊢ ((∀𝑦∃𝑥 𝑥 = 𝑦 ∧ ∀𝑥∃𝑦 𝑥 = 𝑦) → (∃𝑥𝜑 ↔ ∃𝑦𝜓)) | ||
| 18-Feb-2026 | noinfepregs 35321 | There are no infinite descending ∈-chains, proven using ax-regs 35314. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 18-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑥 ∈ ω (𝐹‘suc 𝑥) ∉ (𝐹‘𝑥) | ||
| 18-Feb-2026 | noinfepfnregs 35320 | There are no infinite descending ∈-chains, proven using ax-regs 35314. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 18-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐹 Fn ω → ∃𝑥 ∈ ω (𝐹‘suc 𝑥) ∉ (𝐹‘𝑥)) | ||
| 18-Feb-2026 | fineqvinfep 35313 | A counterexample demonstrating that tz9.1 9648 does not hold when all sets are finite and an infinite descending ∈-chain exists. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 18-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐴 = {(𝐹‘∅)} ⇒ ⊢ ((Fin = V ∧ 𝐹:ω–1-1→V ∧ ∀𝑥 ∈ ω (𝐹‘suc 𝑥) ∈ (𝐹‘𝑥)) → ¬ ∃𝑦(𝐴 ⊆ 𝑦 ∧ Tr 𝑦)) | ||
| 18-Feb-2026 | 1reno 28514 | Surreal one is a surreal real. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 18-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 1s ∈ ℝs | ||
| 16-Feb-2026 | dfdisjs7 39317 | Alternate definition of the class of disjoints (via carrier disjointness + unique representatives). Ideology-free normal form of dfdisjs6 39316: "blocks cover their elements" (∃*) and "each block has a unique generator" (∃!), expressed entirely at the quotient-carrier level. Same class as dfdisjs6 39316, but presented in fully expanded ∃* / ∃! form over the quotient-carrier (dom 𝑟 / 𝑟). Makes explicit (a) element-disjointness of the quotient-carrier and (b) unique representative existence for each block. These are exactly the two conditions that rule out type-confusions (blocks vs witnesses) and ensure canonical decomposition. This is the form that best supports analogy arguments with df-petparts 39342 and with successor-style uniqueness patterns. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 16-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Disjs = {𝑟 ∈ Rels ∣ (∀𝑥∃*𝑢 ∈ (dom 𝑟 / 𝑟)𝑥 ∈ 𝑢 ∧ ∀𝑢 ∈ (dom 𝑟 / 𝑟)∃!𝑡 ∈ dom 𝑟 𝑢 = [𝑡]𝑟)} | ||
| 16-Feb-2026 | dfdisjs6 39316 | Alternate definition of the class of disjoints (via quotient-map stability). Disjs is the class of relations 𝑟 whose quotient-map QMap 𝑟 is again disjoint and whose induced quotient-carrier is element-disjoint. This is the definitional "stability-by-decomposition" packaging of disjointness: it builds Disjs from two internal layers (i) a carrier-layer constraint and (ii) a map-layer closure constraint. This is deliberately different from "u R x" style definitions: it makes the carrier of blocks and the uniqueness-of-representatives discipline first-class and reusable (via QMap) rather than implicit. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 16-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Disjs = {𝑟 ∈ Rels ∣ (ran QMap 𝑟 ∈ ElDisjs ∧ QMap 𝑟 ∈ Disjs )} | ||
| 16-Feb-2026 | eldisjs7 39315 |
Elementhood in the class of disjoints. 𝑅 ∈ Disjs iff:
𝑅 ∈ Rels, and every 𝑥 belongs to at most one block 𝑢 in the quotient-carrier (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅) (element-disjointness at the carrier), and every block 𝑢 in the quotient-carrier has a unique representative 𝑡 ∈ dom 𝑅 such that 𝑢 = [𝑡]𝑅. Provides the "fully expanded" quantifier characterization of the same decomposition as eldisjs6 39314, but without explicitly mentioning QMap. This is the "E*/E!"" view that is closest in spirit to suc11reg 9538-style injectivity and to the "unique generator per block" narrative. It is also the right contrast-point to older one-line criteria like dfdisjs4 39170 (the "u R x" style), because it makes the carrier and representation discipline explicit and type-safe. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 16-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ Disjs ↔ (𝑅 ∈ Rels ∧ (∀𝑥∃*𝑢 ∈ (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅)𝑥 ∈ 𝑢 ∧ ∀𝑢 ∈ (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅)∃!𝑡 ∈ dom 𝑅 𝑢 = [𝑡]𝑅))) | ||
| 16-Feb-2026 | eldisjs6 39314 |
Elementhood in the class of disjoints. A relation 𝑅 is in Disjs
iff:
it is relation-typed, and its quotient-map QMap 𝑅 is itself disjoint, and its quotient-carrier ran QMap 𝑅 = (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅) lies in ElDisjs (element-disjoint carriers). This is the central "stability-by-decomposition" theorem for Disjs: it explains why Disjs is internally well-behaved without adding an external stability clause. It is the exact template that PetParts imitates: for pet 39339, the analogue of "map layer" is the disjointness of the lifted span, the analogue of "carrier layer" is the block-lift fixpoint (BlockLiftFix), and then adds external grade stability (SucMap ShiftStable) which Disjs does not need. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 16-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ Disjs ↔ (𝑅 ∈ Rels ∧ (ran QMap 𝑅 ∈ ElDisjs ∧ QMap 𝑅 ∈ Disjs ))) | ||
| 16-Feb-2026 | rnqmapeleldisjsim 39236 | Element-disjointness of the quotient carrier forces coset disjointness. Supplies the "cosets don't overlap unless equal" direction, but expressed via ran QMap 𝑅 (the quotient carrier) and ElDisjs. This is the structural reason Disjs needs a "carrier disjointness" level distinct from the "unique representatives" level. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 16-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑅 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ ran QMap 𝑅 ∈ ElDisjs ∧ (𝐴 ∈ dom 𝑅 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ dom 𝑅)) → (([𝐴]𝑅 ∩ [𝐵]𝑅) ≠ ∅ → [𝐴]𝑅 = [𝐵]𝑅)) | ||
| 16-Feb-2026 | qmapeldisjsbi 39235 | Injectivity of coset map from QMap being disjoint (biconditional form). Convenience version of qmapeldisjsim 39234. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 16-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑅 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ QMap 𝑅 ∈ Disjs ∧ (𝐴 ∈ dom 𝑅 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ dom 𝑅)) → ([𝐴]𝑅 = [𝐵]𝑅 ↔ 𝐴 = 𝐵)) | ||
| 16-Feb-2026 | qmapeldisjsim 39234 | Injectivity of coset map from QMap being disjoint (implication form): under the Disjs condition on QMap 𝑅, the coset assignment is injective on dom 𝑅. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 16-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑅 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ QMap 𝑅 ∈ Disjs ∧ (𝐴 ∈ dom 𝑅 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ dom 𝑅)) → ([𝐴]𝑅 = [𝐵]𝑅 → 𝐴 = 𝐵)) | ||
| 16-Feb-2026 | disjimeceqbi2 39181 | Injectivity of the block constructor under disjointness. suc11reg 9538 analogue: under disjointness, equal blocks force equal generators (on dom 𝑅). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 16-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( Disj 𝑅 → ((𝐴 ∈ dom 𝑅 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ dom 𝑅) → ([𝐴]𝑅 = [𝐵]𝑅 ↔ 𝐴 = 𝐵))) | ||
| 16-Feb-2026 | disjimeceqim2 39179 | Disj implies injectivity (pairwise form). The same content as disjimeceqim 39178 but packaged for direct use with explicit hypotheses (𝐴 ∈ dom 𝑅 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ dom 𝑅). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 16-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( Disj 𝑅 → ((𝐴 ∈ dom 𝑅 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ dom 𝑅) → ([𝐴]𝑅 = [𝐵]𝑅 → 𝐴 = 𝐵))) | ||
| 16-Feb-2026 | falseral0 4449 | A false statement can only be true for elements of an empty set. (Contributed by AV, 30-Oct-2020.) (Proof shortened by TM, 16-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((∀𝑥 ¬ 𝜑 ∧ ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝜑) → 𝐴 = ∅) | ||
| 16-Feb-2026 | r19.3rzv 4438 | Restricted quantification of wff not containing quantified variable. (Contributed by NM, 10-Mar-1997.) Avoid ax-12 2189. (Revised by TM, 16-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ≠ ∅ → (𝜑 ↔ ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝜑)) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | eldisjsim5 39313 | Disjs is closed under QMap. If a relation is "disjoint-structured" (Disjs), then its canonical block map is also "disjoint-structured". This is the second "structure level" in Disjs: it expresses that the property is stable under passing to the canonical block map, a theme that mirrors Pet-grade stability at a different axis. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ Disjs → QMap 𝑅 ∈ Disjs ) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | eldisjsim4 39312 | Disjs implies element-disjoint range of QMap. Same as eldisjsim3 39311 but expressed using the block-map range ran QMap 𝑅 (often the more modular expression). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ Disjs → ran QMap 𝑅 ∈ ElDisjs ) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | vieta 33771 | Vieta's Formulas: Coefficients of a monic polynomial 𝐹 expressed as a product of linear polynomials of the form 𝑋 − 𝑍 can be expressed in terms of elementary symmetric polynomials. The formulas appear in Chapter 6 of [Lang], p. 190. Theorem vieta1 26303 is a special case for the complex numbers, for the case 𝐾 = 1. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑊 = (Poly1‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ − = (-g‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (mulGrp‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐼 eval 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (𝐼eSymPoly𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (invg‘𝑅) & ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑋 = (var1‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (algSc‘𝑊) & ⊢ ↑ = (.g‘(mulGrp‘𝑅)) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (♯‘𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ IDomn) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍:𝐼⟶𝐵) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑀 Σg (𝑛 ∈ 𝐼 ↦ (𝑋 − (𝐴‘(𝑍‘𝑛))))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (0...𝐻)) & ⊢ 𝐶 = (coe1‘𝐹) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐶‘(𝐻 − 𝐾)) = ((𝐾 ↑ (𝑁‘ 1 )) · ((𝑄‘(𝐸‘𝐾))‘𝑍))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | vietalem 33770 | Lemma for vieta 33771: induction step. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑊 = (Poly1‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ − = (-g‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (mulGrp‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐼 eval 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (𝐼eSymPoly𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (invg‘𝑅) & ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑋 = (var1‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (algSc‘𝑊) & ⊢ ↑ = (.g‘(mulGrp‘𝑅)) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (♯‘𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ IDomn) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍:𝐼⟶𝐵) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑀 Σg (𝑛 ∈ 𝐼 ↦ (𝑋 − (𝐴‘(𝑍‘𝑛))))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (0...𝐻)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (𝐼 ∖ {𝑌}) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑧 ∈ (𝐵 ↑m 𝐽)∀𝑘 ∈ (0...(♯‘𝐽))((coe1‘(𝑀 Σg (𝑛 ∈ 𝐽 ↦ (𝑋 − (𝐴‘(𝑧‘𝑛))))))‘((♯‘𝐽) − 𝑘)) = ((𝑘 ↑ (𝑁‘ 1 )) · (((𝐽 eval 𝑅)‘((𝐽eSymPoly𝑅)‘𝑘))‘𝑧))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((deg1‘𝑅)‘(𝑀 Σg (𝑛 ∈ 𝐽 ↦ (𝑋 − (𝐴‘((𝑍 ↾ 𝐽)‘𝑛)))))) = (♯‘𝐽)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((coe1‘𝐹)‘𝐾) = (((𝐻 − 𝐾) ↑ (𝑁‘ 1 )) · ((𝑄‘(𝐸‘(𝐻 − 𝐾)))‘𝑍))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | vietadeg1 33769 | The degree of a product of 𝐻 of linear polynomials of the form 𝑋 − 𝑍 is 𝐻. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑊 = (Poly1‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ − = (-g‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (mulGrp‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐼 eval 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (𝐼eSymPoly𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (invg‘𝑅) & ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑋 = (var1‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (algSc‘𝑊) & ⊢ ↑ = (.g‘(mulGrp‘𝑅)) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (♯‘𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ IDomn) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍:𝐼⟶𝐵) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑀 Σg (𝑛 ∈ 𝐼 ↦ (𝑋 − (𝐴‘(𝑍‘𝑛))))) & ⊢ 𝐷 = (deg1‘𝑅) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐷‘𝐹) = 𝐻) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | esplyfvn 33768 | Express the last elementary symmetric polynomial, evaluated at a given set of points 𝑍, in terms of the last elementary symmetric polynomial with one less variable. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝑅) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐼 eval 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑂 = (𝐽 eval 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (𝐼eSymPoly𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝐽eSymPoly𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (♯‘𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐾 = (♯‘𝐽) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (𝐼 ∖ {𝑌}) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍:𝐼⟶𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑄‘(𝐸‘𝐻))‘𝑍) = ((𝑍‘𝑌) · ((𝑂‘(𝐹‘𝐾))‘(𝑍 ↾ 𝐽)))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | esplyindfv 33767 | A recursive formula for the elementary symmetric polynomials, evaluated at a given set of points 𝑍. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (𝐼 ∖ {𝑌}) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (𝐽eSymPoly𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (0...(♯‘𝐽))) & ⊢ 𝐶 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐽) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ 𝐹 = ((𝐼eSymPoly𝑅)‘(𝐾 + 1)) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐼 eval 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑂 = (𝐽 eval 𝑅) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍:𝐼⟶𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑄‘𝐹)‘𝑍) = (((𝑍‘𝑌) · ((𝑂‘(𝐸‘𝐾))‘(𝑍 ↾ 𝐽))) + ((𝑂‘(𝐸‘(𝐾 + 1)))‘(𝑍 ↾ 𝐽)))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | esplyfval0 33755 | The 0-th elementary symmetric polynomial is the constant 1. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ 𝑈 = (1r‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐼eSymPoly𝑅)‘0) = 𝑈) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | evlextv 33733 | Evaluating a variable-extended polynomial is the same as evaluating the polynomial in the original set of variables (in both cases, the additionial variable is ignored). (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐼 eval 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑂 = (𝐽 eval 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (𝐼 ∖ {𝑌}) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐽 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (𝐼extendVars𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑀) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴:𝐼⟶𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑄‘((𝐸‘𝑌)‘𝐹))‘𝐴) = ((𝑂‘𝐹)‘(𝐴 ↾ 𝐽))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | evlvarval 33732 | Polynomial evaluation builder for a variable. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐼 eval 𝑆) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑆) & ⊢ 𝐾 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ ∙ = (.r‘𝑃) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑍) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑆 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝐾 ↑m 𝐼)) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (𝐼 mVar 𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐼) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑉‘𝑋) ∈ 𝐵 ∧ ((𝑄‘(𝑉‘𝑋))‘𝐴) = (𝐴‘𝑋))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | evlscaval 33731 | Polynomial evaluation for scalars. See evlsscaval 22109. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐼 eval 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑊 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (algSc‘𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐿:𝐼⟶𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑄‘(𝐴‘𝑋))‘𝐿) = 𝑋) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | gsummoncoe1fz 33688 | A coefficient of the polynomial represented as a sum of scaled monomials is the coefficient of the corresponding scaled monomial. See gsummoncoe1fzo 33687. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑃 = (Poly1‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑋 = (var1‘𝑅) & ⊢ ↑ = (.g‘(mulGrp‘𝑃)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ 𝐾 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ ∗ = ( ·𝑠 ‘𝑃) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑘 ∈ (0...𝐷)𝐴 ∈ 𝐾) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐿 ∈ (0...𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝑘 = 𝐿 → 𝐴 = 𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((coe1‘(𝑃 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (0...𝐷) ↦ (𝐴 ∗ (𝑘 ↑ 𝑋)))))‘𝐿) = 𝐶) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | ply1coedeg 33679 | Decompose a univariate polynomial 𝐾 as a sum of powers, up to its degree 𝐷. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑃 = (Poly1‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑋 = (var1‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ · = ( ·𝑠 ‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (mulGrp‘𝑃) & ⊢ ↑ = (.g‘𝑀) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (coe1‘𝐾) & ⊢ 𝐷 = ((deg1‘𝑅)‘𝐾) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 = (𝑃 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (0...𝐷) ↦ ((𝐴‘𝑘) · (𝑘 ↑ 𝑋))))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | deg1prod 33673 | Degree of a product of polynomials. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = (deg1‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Poly1‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (mulGrp‘𝑃) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑃) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ IDomn) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝐴⟶(𝐵 ∖ { 0 })) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐷‘(𝑀 Σg 𝐹)) = Σ𝑘 ∈ 𝐴 (𝐷‘(𝐹‘𝑘))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | assaassrd 33646 | Right-associative property of an associative algebra, deduction version. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑉 = (Base‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (Scalar‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐹) & ⊢ · = ( ·𝑠 ‘𝑊) & ⊢ × = (.r‘𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑊 ∈ AssAlg) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 × (𝐴 · 𝑌)) = (𝐴 · (𝑋 × 𝑌))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | assaassd 33645 | Left-associative property of an associative algebra, deduction version. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑉 = (Base‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (Scalar‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐹) & ⊢ · = ( ·𝑠 ‘𝑊) & ⊢ × = (.r‘𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑊 ∈ AssAlg) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 · 𝑋) × 𝑌) = (𝐴 · (𝑋 × 𝑌))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | domnprodeq0 33364 | A product over a domain is zero exactly when one of the factors is zero. Generalization of domneq0 20687 for any number of factors. See also domnprodn0 33363. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑀 = (mulGrp‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ IDomn) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝐴⟶𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑀 Σg 𝐹) = 0 ↔ 0 ∈ ran 𝐹)) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | ringm1expp1 33322 | Ring exponentiation of minus one: Adding one to the exponent is the same as taking the additive inverse. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (invg‘𝑅) & ⊢ ↑ = (.g‘(mulGrp‘𝑅)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ ℕ0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐾 + 1) ↑ (𝑁‘ 1 )) = (𝑁‘(𝐾 ↑ (𝑁‘ 1 )))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | ringrngd 33317 | A unital ring is a non-unital ring, deduction version. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Rng) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | gsummulsubdishift2s 33159 | Distribute a subtraction over an indexed sum, shift one of the resulting sums, and regroup terms. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝑅) & ⊢ − = (-g‘𝑅) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑖 ∈ (0...𝑁)) → 𝑉 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝑖 = 0 → 𝑉 = 𝐺) & ⊢ (𝑖 = 𝑁 → 𝑉 = 𝐻) & ⊢ (𝑖 = 𝑘 → 𝑉 = 𝑃) & ⊢ (𝑖 = (𝑘 + 1) → 𝑉 = 𝑄) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 = ((𝐺 · 𝐴) − (𝐻 · 𝐶))) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑘 ∈ (0..^𝑁)) → 𝐹 = ((𝑄 · 𝐴) − (𝑃 · 𝐶))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑅 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (0...𝑁) ↦ 𝑃)) · (𝐴 − 𝐶)) = ((𝑅 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (0..^𝑁) ↦ 𝐹)) + 𝐸)) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | gsummulsubdishift1s 33158 | Distribute a subtraction over an indexed sum, shift one of the resulting sums, and regroup terms. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝑅) & ⊢ − = (-g‘𝑅) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑖 ∈ (0...𝑁)) → 𝑉 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝑖 = 0 → 𝑉 = 𝐺) & ⊢ (𝑖 = 𝑁 → 𝑉 = 𝐻) & ⊢ (𝑖 = 𝑘 → 𝑉 = 𝑃) & ⊢ (𝑖 = (𝑘 + 1) → 𝑉 = 𝑄) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 = ((𝐻 · 𝐴) − (𝐺 · 𝐶))) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑘 ∈ (0..^𝑁)) → 𝐹 = ((𝑃 · 𝐴) − (𝑄 · 𝐶))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑅 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (0...𝑁) ↦ 𝑃)) · (𝐴 − 𝐶)) = ((𝑅 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (0..^𝑁) ↦ 𝐹)) + 𝐸)) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | gsummulsubdishift2 33157 | Distribute a subtraction over an indexed sum, shift one of the resulting sums, and regroup terms. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝑅) & ⊢ − = (-g‘𝑅) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷:(0...𝑁)⟶𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 = (((𝐷‘0) · 𝐴) − ((𝐷‘𝑁) · 𝐶))) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑘 ∈ (0..^𝑁)) → 𝐹 = (((𝐷‘(𝑘 + 1)) · 𝐴) − ((𝐷‘𝑘) · 𝐶))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑅 Σg 𝐷) · (𝐴 − 𝐶)) = ((𝑅 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (0..^𝑁) ↦ 𝐹)) + 𝐸)) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | gsummulsubdishift1 33156 | Distribute a subtraction over an indexed sum, shift one of the resulting sums, and regroup terms. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝑅) & ⊢ − = (-g‘𝑅) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷:(0...𝑁)⟶𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 = (((𝐷‘𝑁) · 𝐴) − ((𝐷‘0) · 𝐶))) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑘 ∈ (0..^𝑁)) → 𝐹 = (((𝐷‘𝑘) · 𝐴) − ((𝐷‘(𝑘 + 1)) · 𝐶))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑅 Σg 𝐷) · (𝐴 − 𝐶)) = ((𝑅 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (0..^𝑁) ↦ 𝐹)) + 𝐸)) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | gsummptfzsplitla 33147 | Split a group sum expressed as mapping with a finite set of sequential integers as domain into two parts, extracting a singleton from the left. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ CMnd) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘𝑀)) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑘 ∈ (𝑀...𝑁)) → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑘 = 𝑀) → 𝑌 = 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (𝑀...𝑁) ↦ 𝑌)) = (𝑋 + (𝐺 Σg (𝑘 ∈ ((𝑀 + 1)...𝑁) ↦ 𝑌)))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | gsummptfzsplitra 33146 | Split a group sum expressed as mapping with a finite set of sequential integers as domain into two parts, extracting a singleton from the right. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ CMnd) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘𝑀)) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑘 ∈ (𝑀...𝑁)) → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑘 = 𝑁) → 𝑌 = 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (𝑀...𝑁) ↦ 𝑌)) = ((𝐺 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (𝑀..^𝑁) ↦ 𝑌)) + 𝑋)) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | gsummptp1 33145 | Reindex a zero-based sum as a one-base sum. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ CMnd) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑙 ∈ (1...𝑁)) → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (((𝜑 ∧ 𝑘 ∈ (0..^𝑁)) ∧ 𝑙 = (𝑘 + 1)) → 𝑌 = 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑅 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (0..^𝑁) ↦ 𝑋)) = (𝑅 Σg (𝑙 ∈ (1...𝑁) ↦ 𝑌))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | gsummptrev 33144 | Revert ordering in a group sum. See also gsumwrev 19339. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑀) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀 ∈ CMnd) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑘 ∈ (0...𝑁)) → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (((𝜑 ∧ 𝑙 ∈ (0...𝑁)) ∧ 𝑘 = (𝑁 − 𝑙)) → 𝑋 = 𝑌) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑀 Σg (𝑘 ∈ (0...𝑁) ↦ 𝑋)) = (𝑀 Σg (𝑙 ∈ (0...𝑁) ↦ 𝑌))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | gsummptfsres 33142 | Extend a finitely supported group sum by padding outside with zeroes. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ CMnd) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 ∈ (𝐴 ∖ 𝑆)) → 𝑌 = 0 ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ↦ 𝑌) finSupp 0 ) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴) → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑆 ⊆ 𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 Σg (𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ↦ 𝑌)) = (𝐺 Σg (𝑥 ∈ 𝑆 ↦ 𝑌))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | ablcomd 33133 | An abelian group operation is commutative, deduction version. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ Abel) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 + 𝑌) = (𝑌 + 𝑋)) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | grpinvinvd 33127 | Double inverse law for groups. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (invg‘𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ Grp) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑁‘(𝑁‘𝑋)) = 𝑋) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | indsn 32949 | The indicator function of a singleton. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑂 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝑋 ∈ 𝑂) → ((𝟭‘𝑂)‘{𝑋}) = (𝑥 ∈ 𝑂 ↦ if(𝑥 = 𝑋, 1, 0))) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | nn0mnfxrd 32850 | Nonnegative integers or minus infinity are extended real numbers. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (ℕ0 ∪ {-∞})) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ*) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | fresunsn 32724 | Recover the original function from a point-added function. See also funresdfunsn 7140 and fsnunres 7139. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐹 Fn 𝐴 ∧ 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ (𝐹‘𝑋) = 𝑌) → ((𝐹 ↾ (𝐴 ∖ {𝑋})) ∪ {〈𝑋, 𝑌〉}) = 𝐹) | ||
| 15-Feb-2026 | dfmo 2544 | Simplify definition df-mo 2543 by removing its provable hypothesis. (Contributed by Wolf Lammen, 15-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∃*𝑥𝜑 ↔ ∃𝑦∀𝑥(𝜑 → 𝑥 = 𝑦)) | ||
| 14-Feb-2026 | dmqmap 38827 | QMap preserves the domain. Confirms that QMap is defined exactly on the points where cosets [𝑥]𝑅 make sense (those in dom 𝑅). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 14-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ 𝑉 → dom QMap 𝑅 = dom 𝑅) | ||
| 14-Feb-2026 | ecqmap 38823 | QMap fibers are singletons of blocks. Makes QMap behave like a "block constructor function" on dom 𝑅. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 14-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ dom 𝑅 → [𝐴] QMap 𝑅 = {[𝐴]𝑅}) | ||
| 14-Feb-2026 | dfqmap3 38822 | Alternate definition of the quotient map: QMap as ordered-pair class abstraction. Gives the raw set-builder characterization for extensional proofs, Rel proofs (relqmap 38826), and composition/intersection manipulations. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 14-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ QMap 𝑅 = {〈𝑥, 𝑦〉 ∣ (𝑥 ∈ dom 𝑅 ∧ 𝑦 = [𝑥]𝑅)} | ||
| 14-Feb-2026 | dfqmap2 38821 | Alternate definition of the quotient map: QMap in image-of-singleton form. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 14-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ QMap 𝑅 = (𝑥 ∈ dom 𝑅 ↦ (𝑅 “ {𝑥})) | ||
| 12-Feb-2026 | disjqmap 39201 | Disjointness of QMap equals unique generation of the quotient carrier. The cleaned, carrier-respecting version of disjqmap2 39200. This is the statement "each equivalence class has a unique representative" for the general coset carrier (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ 𝑉 → ( Disj QMap 𝑅 ↔ ∀𝑢 ∈ (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅)∃!𝑡 ∈ dom 𝑅 𝑢 = [𝑡]𝑅)) | ||
| 12-Feb-2026 | disjqmap2 39200 | Disjointness of QMap equals ∃*-generation. Pairs with disjqmap 39201 and raldmqseu 38739 to move between ∃* and ∃! depending on context. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ 𝑉 → ( Disj QMap 𝑅 ↔ ∀𝑢∃*𝑡 ∈ dom 𝑅 𝑢 = [𝑡]𝑅)) | ||
| 12-Feb-2026 | qmapeldisjs 39199 | When 𝑅 is a set (e.g., when it is an element of the class of relations df-rels 38814), the quotient map element of the class of disjoint relations and the disjoint relation predicate for quotient maps are the same. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ 𝑉 → ( QMap 𝑅 ∈ Disjs ↔ Disj QMap 𝑅)) | ||
| 12-Feb-2026 | rnqmap 38828 | The range of the quotient map is the quotient carrier. It lets us replace quotient-carrier reasoning by map/range reasoning (and conversely) via df-qmap 38820 and dfqs2 8647. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ran QMap 𝑅 = (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅) | ||
| 12-Feb-2026 | relqmap 38826 | Quotient map is a relation. Guarantees that QMap can be composed, restricted, and used in other relation infrastructure (e.g., membership in Disjs, Rels-based typing). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Rel QMap 𝑅 | ||
| 12-Feb-2026 | qmapex 38825 | Quotient map exists if 𝑅 exists. Type-safety: ensures QMap is a set under the standard "relation sethood" hypothesis. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ 𝑉 → QMap 𝑅 ∈ V) | ||
| 12-Feb-2026 | df-qmap 38820 |
Define the quotient map (coset map), see also dfqmap2 38821 and dfqmap3 38822.
QMap 𝑅 is the "send a generator /
domain element to its 𝑅
-coset" map: it maps each 𝑥 ∈ dom 𝑅 to the block [𝑥]𝑅.
Makes the quotient operation /
structurally explicit as the range
of a canonical map (see dfqs2 8647, rnqmap 38828). This is crucial for
(i) modular "two-layer" characterizations (map layer + carrier layer) such as dfdisjs6 39316 / dfdisjs7 39317, (ii) transport of properties between a relation and its induced quotient-carrier (e.g. "elements are blocks" via rnqmap 38828), and (iii) expressing stability/invariance constraints as ordinary conditions on a graph (e.g. ran QMap 𝑟 ∈ ElDisjs, QMap 𝑟 ∈ Disjs). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ QMap 𝑅 = (𝑥 ∈ dom 𝑅 ↦ [𝑥]𝑅) | ||
| 11-Feb-2026 | nfale2 42708 | An inner existential quantifier's variable is bound. (Contributed by SN, 11-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥∀𝑦∃𝑥𝜑 | ||
| 11-Feb-2026 | nfe2 42707 | An inner existential quantifier's variable is bound. (Contributed by SN, 11-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥∃𝑦∃𝑥𝜑 | ||
| 11-Feb-2026 | nfalh 42706 | Version of nfal 2332 with an 'h' hypothesis, avoiding ax-12 2189. (Contributed by SN, 11-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝜑) ⇒ ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥∀𝑦𝜑 | ||
| 11-Feb-2026 | eldisjsim3 39311 | Disjs implies element-disjoint quotient carrier. Exports the carrier-disjointness property in the ElDisjs packaging. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 11-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ Disjs → (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅) ∈ ElDisjs ) | ||
| 11-Feb-2026 | disjsssrels 39310 | The class of disjoint relations is a subclass of the class of relations. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 11-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Disjs ⊆ Rels | ||
| 11-Feb-2026 | eldisjsim2 39309 | An element of the class of disjoint relations is an element of the class of relations. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 11-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ Disjs → 𝑅 ∈ Rels ) | ||
| 11-Feb-2026 | eldisjsim1 39308 | An element of the class of disjoint relations is disjoint. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 11-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ Disjs → Disj 𝑅) | ||
| 11-Feb-2026 | nfexa2 2188 | An inner universal quantifier's variable is bound. (Contributed by SN, 11-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥∃𝑦∀𝑥𝜑 | ||
| 11-Feb-2026 | nfexhe 2187 | Version of nfex 2333 with the existential dual to the 'h' hypothesis, avoiding ax-12 2189. (Contributed by SN, 11-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥𝜑 → 𝜑) ⇒ ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥∃𝑦𝜑 | ||
| 10-Feb-2026 | eldisjdmqsim 39191 | Shared output implies equal cosets (under ElDisj of quotient): if 𝑢 and 𝑣 both relate to the same 𝑥, then their cosets intersect, hence must coincide under quotient ElDisj. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 10-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (( ElDisj (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅) ∧ 𝑅 ∈ Rels ) → ((𝑢𝑅𝑥 ∧ 𝑣𝑅𝑥) → [𝑢]𝑅 = [𝑣]𝑅)) | ||
| 10-Feb-2026 | eldisjdmqsim2 39190 | ElDisj of quotient implies coset-disjointness (domain form). Converts element-disjointness of the quotient carrier into a usable "cosets don't overlap unless equal" rule. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 10-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (( ElDisj (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅) ∧ 𝑅 ∈ Rels ) → ((𝑢 ∈ dom 𝑅 ∧ 𝑣 ∈ dom 𝑅) → (([𝑢]𝑅 ∩ [𝑣]𝑅) ≠ ∅ → [𝑢]𝑅 = [𝑣]𝑅))) | ||
| 10-Feb-2026 | enssdom 8920 | Equinumerosity implies dominance. (Contributed by NM, 31-Mar-1998.) (Proof shortened by TM, 10-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ≈ ⊆ ≼ | ||
| 10-Feb-2026 | f1oi 6812 | A restriction of the identity relation is a one-to-one onto function. (Contributed by NM, 30-Apr-1998.) (Proof shortened by Andrew Salmon, 22-Oct-2011.) Avoid ax-12 2189. (Revised by TM, 10-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( I ↾ 𝐴):𝐴–1-1-onto→𝐴 | ||
| 9-Feb-2026 | rsp3eq 38741 | From a restricted universal statement over 𝐴, specialize to an arbitrary element class, cf. rsp3 38740. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 9-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥𝐴 & ⊢ Ⅎ𝑦𝐴 & ⊢ Ⅎ𝑦𝜑 & ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥𝜓 & ⊢ (𝑥 = 𝑦 → (𝜑 ↔ 𝜓)) ⇒ ⊢ (∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝜑 → ((𝑦 = 𝐵 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝐴) → 𝜓)) | ||
| 9-Feb-2026 | rsp3 38740 | From a restricted universal statement over 𝐴, specialize to an arbitrary element 𝑦 ∈ 𝐴, cf. rsp 3228. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 9-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥𝐴 & ⊢ Ⅎ𝑦𝐴 & ⊢ Ⅎ𝑦𝜑 & ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥𝜓 & ⊢ (𝑥 = 𝑦 → (𝜑 ↔ 𝜓)) ⇒ ⊢ (∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝜑 → (𝑦 ∈ 𝐴 → 𝜓)) | ||
| 6-Feb-2026 | eldisjim3 39189 | ElDisj elimination (two chosen elements). Standard specialization lemma: from ElDisj 𝐴 infer the disjointness condition for two specific elements. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 6-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( ElDisj 𝐴 → ((𝐵 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ 𝐶 ∈ 𝐴) → ((𝐵 ∩ 𝐶) ≠ ∅ → 𝐵 = 𝐶))) | ||
| 6-Feb-2026 | raldmqseu 38739 | Equivalence between "exactly one" on the quotient carrier and "at most one" globally. Provides a type-safe way to talk about unique representatives either as ∃! on the intended carrier or as a global ∃* statement. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 6-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ 𝑉 → (∀𝑢 ∈ (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅)∃!𝑡 ∈ dom 𝑅 𝑢 = [𝑡]𝑅 ↔ ∀𝑢∃*𝑡 ∈ dom 𝑅 𝑢 = [𝑡]𝑅)) | ||
| 6-Feb-2026 | raldmqsmo 38737 | On the quotient carrier, "at most one" and "exactly one" coincide for coset witnesses. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 6-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∀𝑢 ∈ (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅)∃*𝑡 ∈ dom 𝑅 𝑢 = [𝑡]𝑅 ↔ ∀𝑢 ∈ (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅)∃!𝑡 ∈ dom 𝑅 𝑢 = [𝑡]𝑅) | ||
| 5-Feb-2026 | disjimeldisjdmqs 39307 | Disj implies element-disjoint quotient carrier. Supplies the carrier-disjointness half of the Disjs pattern: under Disj 𝑅, the coset family is element-disjoint. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 5-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( Disj 𝑅 → ElDisj (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅)) | ||
| 5-Feb-2026 | disjimdmqseq 39183 | Disjointness implies unique-generation of quotient blocks. Converts existence-quotient comprehension (see df-qs 8646) into a uniqueness-comprehension under disjointness; rewrites (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅) carriers as exactly the class of blocks with a unique representative. This is the "unique generator per block" content in a carrier-normal form. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 5-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( Disj 𝑅 → (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅) = {𝑡 ∣ ∃!𝑢 ∈ dom 𝑅 𝑡 = [𝑢]𝑅}) | ||
| 5-Feb-2026 | disjimrmoeqec 39182 | Under Disj, every block has a unique generator (∃* form). If 𝑡 is a block in the quotient sense, then there is a uniquely determined 𝑢 in dom 𝑅 such that 𝑡 = [𝑢]𝑅. This is the existence+uniqueness engine behind Disjs and QMap characterizations: it is the "representative theorem" from which the ∃! forms are obtained. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 5-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( Disj 𝑅 → ∃*𝑢 ∈ dom 𝑅 𝑡 = [𝑢]𝑅) | ||
| 5-Feb-2026 | dfsb 2075 | Simplify definition df-sb 2074 by removing its provable hypothesis. (Contributed by Wolf Lammen, 5-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ([𝑡 / 𝑥]𝜑 ↔ ∀𝑦(𝑦 = 𝑡 → ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → 𝜑))) | ||
| 4-Feb-2026 | ss2rabd 4010 | Subclass of a restricted class abstraction (deduction form). Saves ax-10 2152, ax-11 2168, ax-12 2189 over using ss2rab 4007 and sylibr 235. (Contributed by SN, 4-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 (𝜓 → 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → {𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∣ 𝜓} ⊆ {𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∣ 𝜒}) | ||
| 4-Feb-2026 | sbt 2077 | A substitution into a theorem yields a theorem. See sbtALT 2080 for a shorter proof requiring more axioms. See chvar 2403 and chvarv 2404 for versions using implicit substitution. (Contributed by NM, 21-Jan-2004.) (Proof shortened by Andrew Salmon, 25-May-2011.) (Proof shortened by Wolf Lammen, 20-Jul-2018.) Revise df-sb 2074. (Revised by Steven Nguyen, 6-Jul-2023.) Revise df-sb 2074 again. (Revised by Wolf Lammen, 4-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝜑 ⇒ ⊢ [𝑡 / 𝑥]𝜑 | ||
| 4-Feb-2026 | sbtlem 2076 | In the case of sbt 2077, the hypothesis in df-sb 2074 is derivable from propositional axioms and ax-gen 1802 alone. The essential proof step is presented in this lemma. (Contributed by Wolf Lammen, 4-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝜑 ⇒ ⊢ ∀𝑦(𝑦 = 𝑡 → ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → 𝜑)) | ||
| 4-Feb-2026 | df-sb 2074 |
Define proper substitution. For our notation, we use [𝑡 / 𝑥]𝜑
to mean "the wff that results from the proper substitution of 𝑡 for
𝑥 in the wff 𝜑". That is, 𝑡
properly replaces 𝑥.
For example, [𝑡 / 𝑥]𝑧 ∈ 𝑥 is the same as 𝑧 ∈ 𝑡 (when 𝑥
and 𝑧 are distinct), as shown in elsb2 2136.
Our notation was introduced in Haskell B. Curry's Foundations of Mathematical Logic (1977), p. 316 and is frequently used in textbooks of lambda calculus and combinatory logic. This notation improves the common but ambiguous notation, "𝜑(𝑡) is the wff that results when 𝑡 is properly substituted for 𝑥 in 𝜑(𝑥)". For example, if the original 𝜑(𝑥) is 𝑥 = 𝑡, then 𝜑(𝑡) is 𝑡 = 𝑡, from which we obtain that 𝜑(𝑥) is 𝑥 = 𝑥. So what exactly does 𝜑(𝑥) mean? Curry's notation solves this problem. A very similar notation, namely (𝑦 ∣ 𝑥)𝜑, was introduced in Bourbaki's Set Theory (Chapter 1, Description of Formal Mathematic, 1953). In most books, proper substitution has a somewhat complicated recursive definition with multiple cases based on the occurrences of free and bound variables in the wff. Instead, we use a single formula that is exactly equivalent and gives us a direct definition. We later prove that our definition has the properties we expect of proper substitution (see Theorems sbequ 2094, sbcom2 2183 and sbid2v 2517). Note that our definition is valid even when 𝑥 and 𝑡 are replaced with the same variable, as sbid 2267 shows. We achieve this by applying twice Tarski's definition sb6 2096 which is valid for disjoint variables, and introducing a dummy variable 𝑦 which isolates 𝑥 from 𝑡, as in dfsb7 2290 with respect to sb5 2287. We can also achieve this by having 𝑥 free in the first conjunct and bound in the second, as the alternate definition dfsb1 2489 shows. Another version that mixes free and bound variables is dfsb3 2502. When 𝑥 and 𝑡 are distinct, we can express proper substitution with the simpler expressions of sb5 2287 and sb6 2096. Note that the occurrences of a given variable in the definiens are either all bound (𝑥, 𝑦) or all free (𝑡). Also note that the definiens uses only primitive symbols. This double level definition will make several proofs using it appear as doubled. Alternately, one could often first prove as a lemma the same theorem with a disjoint variable condition on the substitute and the substituted variables, and then prove the original theorem by applying this lemma twice in a row. The hypothesis asserts that the definition is independent of the particular choice of the dummy variable 𝑦. Without this hypothesis, sbjust 2072 would be derivable from propositional axioms alone: one could apply the definiens for [𝑡 / 𝑥]𝜑 twice, using different dummy variables 𝑦 and 𝑧, and then invoke bitr3i 278 to establish their equivalence. This would jeopardize the independence of axioms, as demonstrated in an analoguous situation involving df-ss 3907 to prove ax-8 2121 (see in-ax8 36459). Prefer dfsb 2075 unless you can prove the hypothesis from fewer axioms in special cases, see sbt 2077. (Contributed by NM, 10-May-1993.) Revised from the original definition dfsb1 2489. (Revised by BJ, 22-Dec-2020.) Add the justification hypothesis. (Revised by Wolf Lammen, 4-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∀𝑦(𝑦 = 𝑡 → ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → 𝜑)) ↔ ∀𝑧(𝑧 = 𝑡 → ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑧 → 𝜑))) ⇒ ⊢ ([𝑡 / 𝑥]𝜑 ↔ ∀𝑦(𝑦 = 𝑡 → ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → 𝜑))) | ||
| 3-Feb-2026 | disjimeceqbi 39180 | Disj gives biconditional injectivity (domain-wise). Strengthens injectivity to an iff. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 3-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( Disj 𝑅 → ∀𝑢 ∈ dom 𝑅∀𝑣 ∈ dom 𝑅([𝑢]𝑅 = [𝑣]𝑅 ↔ 𝑢 = 𝑣)) | ||
| 3-Feb-2026 | disjimeceqim 39178 | Disj implies coset-equality injectivity (domain-wise). Extracts the practical consequence of Disj: the map 𝑢 ↦ [𝑢]𝑅 is injective on dom 𝑅. This is exactly the "canonicity" property used repeatedly when turning ∃* into ∃! and when reasoning about uniqueness of representatives. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 3-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( Disj 𝑅 → ∀𝑢 ∈ dom 𝑅∀𝑣 ∈ dom 𝑅([𝑢]𝑅 = [𝑣]𝑅 → 𝑢 = 𝑣)) | ||
| 3-Feb-2026 | dfdisjALTV5a 39177 | Alternate definition of the disjoint relation predicate. Disj 𝑅 means: different domain generators have disjoint cosets (unless the generators are equal), plus Rel 𝑅 for relation-typedness. This is the characterization that makes canonicity/uniqueness arguments modular. It is the starting point for the entire "Disj ↔ unique representative per block" pipeline that feeds into Disjs, see dfdisjs7 39317. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 3-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( Disj 𝑅 ↔ (∀𝑢 ∈ dom 𝑅∀𝑣 ∈ dom 𝑅(([𝑢]𝑅 ∩ [𝑣]𝑅) ≠ ∅ → 𝑢 = 𝑣) ∧ Rel 𝑅)) | ||
| 2-Feb-2026 | ralrnmo 38735 | On the range, "at most one" becomes "exactly one". (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 27-Sep-2018.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 2-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∀𝑥 ∈ ran 𝑅∃*𝑢 𝑢𝑅𝑥 ↔ ∀𝑥 ∈ ran 𝑅∃!𝑢 𝑢𝑅𝑥) | ||
| 2-Feb-2026 | ralmo 38734 | "At most one" can be restricted to the range. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 2-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∀𝑥∃*𝑢 𝑢𝑅𝑥 ↔ ∀𝑥 ∈ ran 𝑅∃*𝑢 𝑢𝑅𝑥) | ||
| 2-Feb-2026 | mptelee 28988 | A condition for a mapping to be an element of a Euclidean space. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 7-Jun-2013.) (Proof shortened by SN, 2-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ ℕ → ((𝑘 ∈ (1...𝑁) ↦ (𝐴𝐹𝐵)) ∈ (𝔼‘𝑁) ↔ ∀𝑘 ∈ (1...𝑁)(𝐴𝐹𝐵) ∈ ℝ)) | ||
| 2-Feb-2026 | moabex 5404 | "At most one" existence implies a class abstraction exists. (Contributed by NM, 30-Dec-1996.) Avoid axioms. (Revised by SN, 2-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∃*𝑥𝜑 → {𝑥 ∣ 𝜑} ∈ V) | ||
| 2-Feb-2026 | iunss 4981 | Subset theorem for an indexed union. (Contributed by NM, 13-Sep-2003.) (Proof shortened by Andrew Salmon, 25-Jul-2011.) Avoid ax-10 2152, ax-12 2189. (Revised by SN, 2-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∪ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝐵 ⊆ 𝐶 ↔ ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝐵 ⊆ 𝐶) | ||
| 2-Feb-2026 | iunssf 4979 | Subset theorem for an indexed union. (Contributed by Glauco Siliprandi, 3-Mar-2021.) Avoid ax-10 2152. (Revised by SN, 2-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ Ⅎ𝑥𝐶 ⇒ ⊢ (∪ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝐵 ⊆ 𝐶 ↔ ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝐵 ⊆ 𝐶) | ||
| 1-Feb-2026 | xp0 5725 | The Cartesian product with the empty set is empty. Part of Theorem 3.13(ii) of [Monk1] p. 37. (Contributed by NM, 12-Apr-2004.) Avoid axioms. (Revised by TM, 1-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 × ∅) = ∅ | ||
| 1-Feb-2026 | uni0 4873 | The union of the empty set is the empty set. Theorem 8.7 of [Quine] p. 54. (Contributed by NM, 16-Sep-1993.) Remove use of ax-nul 5235. (Revised by Eric Schmidt, 4-Apr-2007.) Avoid ax-11 2168. (Revised by TM, 1-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∪ ∅ = ∅ | ||
| 1-Feb-2026 | rabss2 4015 | Subclass law for restricted abstraction. (Contributed by NM, 18-Dec-2004.) (Proof shortened by Andrew Salmon, 26-Jun-2011.) Avoid axioms. (Revised by TM, 1-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ⊆ 𝐵 → {𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∣ 𝜑} ⊆ {𝑥 ∈ 𝐵 ∣ 𝜑}) | ||
| 1-Feb-2026 | ss2rabdv 4013 | Deduction of restricted abstraction subclass from implication. (Contributed by NM, 30-May-2006.) Avoid axioms. (Revised by TM, 1-Feb-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴) → (𝜓 → 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → {𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∣ 𝜓} ⊆ {𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∣ 𝜒}) | ||
| 31-Jan-2026 | cnv0 6097 | The converse of the empty set. (Contributed by NM, 6-Apr-1998.) Remove dependency on ax-sep 5225, ax-nul 5235, ax-pr 5369. (Revised by KP, 25-Oct-2021.) Avoid ax-12 2189. (Revised by TM, 31-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ◡∅ = ∅ | ||
| 30-Jan-2026 | chnsuslle 47333 | Length of a subsequence is bounded by the length of original chain. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 30-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑊 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ ( < Chain (0..^(♯‘𝑊)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → < Po 𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (♯‘(𝑊 ∘ 𝐼)) ≤ (♯‘𝑊)) | ||
| 30-Jan-2026 | dfsuccl4 38848 | Alternate definition that incorporates the most desirable properties of the successor class. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 30-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ Suc = {𝑛 ∣ ∃!𝑚 ∈ 𝑛 (𝑚 ⊆ 𝑛 ∧ suc 𝑚 = 𝑛)} | ||
| 30-Jan-2026 | dfsuccl3 38847 | Alternate definition of the class of all successors. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 30-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ Suc = {𝑛 ∣ ∃!𝑚 suc 𝑚 = 𝑛} | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | nthrucw 47338 | Some number sets form a chain of proper subsets. This is rephrasing nthruc 16217 as a statement about chains; the hypothesis sets the ordering relation to be "is a proper subset". The theorem talks about singleton 1, natural numbers, natural-or-zero numbers, integers, rational numbers, algebraic reals (the definition includes complex numbers as algebraic so intersection is taken), real numbers and complex numbers, which are proper subsets in order. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ < = {〈𝑥, 𝑦〉 ∣ 𝑥 ⊊ 𝑦} ⇒ ⊢ 〈“{1}ℕℕ0ℤℚ(𝔸 ∩ ℝ)ℝℂ”〉 ∈ ( < Chain V) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | chner 47337 | Any two elements are equivalent in a chain constructed on an equivalence relation. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∼ Er 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ( ∼ Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐽 ∈ (0..^(♯‘𝐶))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ (0..^(♯‘𝐶))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐶‘𝐼) ∼ (𝐶‘𝐽)) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | chnerlem3 47336 | Lemma for chner 47337- trichotomy of integers within the word's domain. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∼ Er 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ( ∼ Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐽 ∈ (0..^(♯‘𝐶))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ (0..^(♯‘𝐶))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐼 ∈ (0..^𝐽) ∨ 𝐽 ∈ (0..^𝐼) ∨ 𝐼 = 𝐽)) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | chnerlem2 47335 | Lemma for chner 47337 where the I-th element comes before the J-th. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∼ Er 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ( ∼ Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐽 ∈ (0..^(♯‘𝐶))) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝐼 ∈ (0..^𝐽)) → (𝐶‘𝐼) ∼ (𝐶‘𝐽)) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | chnerlem1 47334 | In a chain constructed on an equivalence relation, the last element is equivalent to any. This theorem is a translation of chnub 18586 to equivalence relations. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∼ Er 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ( ∼ Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐽 ∈ (0..^(♯‘𝐶))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐶‘𝐽) ∼ (lastS‘𝐶)) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | dfsuccl2 38844 | Alternate definition of the class of all successors. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ Suc = {𝑛 ∣ ∃𝑚 suc 𝑚 = 𝑛} | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | dfblockliftmap2 38835 | Alternate definition of the block lift map. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 BlockLiftMap 𝐴) = (𝑚 ∈ (𝐴 ∩ (dom 𝑅 ∖ {∅})) ↦ ([𝑚]𝑅 × 𝑚)) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | dmxrncnvepres2 38807 | Domain of the range product with restricted converse epsilon relation. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ dom (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) = (𝐴 ∩ (dom 𝑅 ∖ {∅})) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | frgr2wwlkeu 30422 | For two different vertices in a friendship graph, there is exactly one third vertex being the middle vertex of a (simple) path/walk of length 2 between the two vertices. (Contributed by Alexander van der Vekens, 18-Feb-2018.) (Revised by AV, 12-May-2021.) (Proof shortened by AV, 4-Jan-2022.) (Revised by Ender Ting, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐺 ∈ FriendGraph ∧ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝑉) ∧ 𝐴 ≠ 𝐵) → ∃!𝑐 ∈ 𝑉 〈“𝐴𝑐𝐵”〉 ∈ (𝐴(2 WWalksNOn 𝐺)𝐵)) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | usgr2wspthon 30061 | A simple path of length 2 between two vertices corresponds to two adjacent edges in a simple graph. (Contributed by Alexander van der Vekens, 9-Mar-2018.) (Revised by AV, 17-May-2021.) (Revised by Ender Ting, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐺 ∈ USGraph ∧ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉)) → (𝑇 ∈ (𝐴(2 WSPathsNOn 𝐺)𝐶) ↔ ∃𝑏 ∈ 𝑉 ((𝑇 = 〈“𝐴𝑏𝐶”〉 ∧ 𝐴 ≠ 𝐶) ∧ ({𝐴, 𝑏} ∈ 𝐸 ∧ {𝑏, 𝐶} ∈ 𝐸)))) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | usgr2wspthons3 30060 | A simple path of length 2 between two vertices represented as length 3 string corresponds to two adjacent edges in a simple graph. (Contributed by Alexander van der Vekens, 8-Mar-2018.) (Revised by AV, 17-May-2021.) (Proof shortened by AV, 16-Mar-2022.) (Revised by Ender Ting, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐺 ∈ USGraph ∧ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉)) → (〈“𝐴𝐵𝐶”〉 ∈ (𝐴(2 WSPathsNOn 𝐺)𝐶) ↔ (𝐴 ≠ 𝐶 ∧ {𝐴, 𝐵} ∈ 𝐸 ∧ {𝐵, 𝐶} ∈ 𝐸))) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | wpthswwlks2on 30057 | For two different vertices, a walk of length 2 between these vertices is a simple path of length 2 between these vertices in a simple graph. (Contributed by Alexander van der Vekens, 2-Mar-2018.) (Revised by AV, 16-Mar-2022.) (Revised by Ender Ting, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐺 ∈ USGraph ∧ 𝐴 ≠ 𝐵) → (𝐴(2 WSPathsNOn 𝐺)𝐵) = (𝐴(2 WWalksNOn 𝐺)𝐵)) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | elwspths2onw 30056 | A simple path of length 2 between two vertices (in a simple pseudograph) as length 3 string. This theorem avoids the Axiom of Choice for its proof, at the cost of requiring a simple graph; the more general version is elwspths2on 30055. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐺 ∈ USPGraph ∧ 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) → (𝑊 ∈ (𝐴(2 WSPathsNOn 𝐺)𝐶) ↔ ∃𝑏 ∈ 𝑉 (𝑊 = 〈“𝐴𝑏𝐶”〉 ∧ 〈“𝐴𝑏𝐶”〉 ∈ (𝐴(2 WSPathsNOn 𝐺)𝐶)))) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | usgrwwlks2on 30051 | A walk of length 2 between two vertices as word in a simple graph. This theorem is analogous to umgrwwlks2on 30052 except it talks about simple graphs and therefore does not require the Axiom of Choice for its proof. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐺 ∈ USGraph ∧ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉)) → (〈“𝐴𝐵𝐶”〉 ∈ (𝐴(2 WWalksNOn 𝐺)𝐶) ↔ ({𝐴, 𝐵} ∈ 𝐸 ∧ {𝐵, 𝐶} ∈ 𝐸))) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | elreno2 28512 | Alternate characterization of the surreal reals. Theorem 4.4(b) of [Gonshor] p. 39. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℝs ↔ (𝐴 ∈ No ∧ (∃𝑛 ∈ ℕs (( -us ‘𝑛) <s 𝐴 ∧ 𝐴 <s 𝑛) ∧ ∀𝑥𝑂 ∈ (( L ‘𝐴) ∪ ( R ‘𝐴))∃𝑛 ∈ ℕs ( 1s /su 𝑛) ≤s (abss‘(𝐴 -s 𝑥𝑂))))) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | abssubs 28267 | Swapping order of surreal subtraction doesn't change the absolute value. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ No ∧ 𝐵 ∈ No ) → (abss‘(𝐴 -s 𝐵)) = (abss‘(𝐵 -s 𝐴))) | ||
| 29-Jan-2026 | lesubsd 28113 | Swap subtrahends in a surreal inequality. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 29-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ No ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 ≤s (𝐵 -s 𝐶) ↔ 𝐶 ≤s (𝐵 -s 𝐴))) | ||
| 28-Jan-2026 | dfsucmap4 38839 | Alternate definition of the successor map. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 28-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ SucMap = (𝑚 ∈ V ↦ suc 𝑚) | ||
| 28-Jan-2026 | dfsucmap2 38838 | Alternate definition of the successor map. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 28-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ SucMap = ( I AdjLiftMap dom I ) | ||
| 28-Jan-2026 | dfsucmap3 38837 | Alternate definition of the successor map. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 28-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ SucMap = ( I AdjLiftMap V) | ||
| 28-Jan-2026 | blockadjliftmap 38832 | A "two-stage" construction is obtained by first forming the block relation (𝑅 ⋉ ◡ E ) and then adjoining elements as "BlockAdj". Combined, it uses the relation ((𝑅 ⋉ ◡ E ) ∪ ◡ E ). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 28-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑅 ⋉ ◡ E ) AdjLiftMap 𝐴) = {〈𝑚, 𝑛〉 ∣ (𝑚 ∈ (𝐴 ∖ {∅}) ∧ 𝑛 = (𝑚 ∪ ([𝑚]𝑅 × 𝑚)))} | ||
| 28-Jan-2026 | dfadjliftmap2 38831 | Alternate definition of the adjoined lift map. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 28-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 AdjLiftMap 𝐴) = (𝑚 ∈ (𝐴 ∩ (dom 𝑅 ∪ (V ∖ {∅}))) ↦ (𝑚 ∪ [𝑚]𝑅)) | ||
| 28-Jan-2026 | ecuncnvepres 38769 | The restricted union with converse epsilon relation coset of 𝐵. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 28-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐵 ∈ 𝐴 → [𝐵]((𝑅 ∪ ◡ E ) ↾ 𝐴) = (𝐵 ∪ [𝐵]𝑅)) | ||
| 28-Jan-2026 | ecunres 38768 | The restricted union coset of 𝐵. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 28-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐵 ∈ 𝑉 → [𝐵]((𝑅 ∪ 𝑆) ↾ 𝐴) = ([𝐵](𝑅 ↾ 𝐴) ∪ [𝐵](𝑆 ↾ 𝐴))) | ||
| 28-Jan-2026 | ecun 38767 | The union coset of 𝐴. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 28-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → [𝐴](𝑅 ∪ 𝑆) = ([𝐴]𝑅 ∪ [𝐴]𝑆)) | ||
| 28-Jan-2026 | dmxrnuncnvepres 38766 | Domain of the combined relation of two special relations, see blockadjliftmap 38832. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 28-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ dom (((𝑅 ⋉ ◡ E ) ∪ ◡ E ) ↾ 𝐴) = (𝐴 ∖ {∅}) | ||
| 28-Jan-2026 | dmuncnvepres 38765 | Domain of the union with the converse epsilon, restricted. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 28-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ dom ((𝑅 ∪ ◡ E ) ↾ 𝐴) = (𝐴 ∩ (dom 𝑅 ∪ (V ∖ {∅}))) | ||
| 28-Jan-2026 | dmcnvepres 38764 | Domain of the restricted converse epsilon relation. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 28-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ dom (◡ E ↾ 𝐴) = (𝐴 ∖ {∅}) | ||
| 28-Jan-2026 | sps3wwlks2on 30050 | A length 3 string which represents a walk of length 2 between two vertices. Concerns simple pseudographs, in contrast to s3wwlks2on 30049 and does not require the Axiom of Choice for its proof. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 28-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐺 ∈ USPGraph ∧ 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) → (〈“𝐴𝐵𝐶”〉 ∈ (𝐴(2 WWalksNOn 𝐺)𝐶) ↔ ∃𝑓(𝑓(Walks‘𝐺)〈“𝐴𝐵𝐶”〉 ∧ (♯‘𝑓) = 2))) | ||
| 27-Jan-2026 | sucpre 38871 | suc is a right-inverse of pre on Suc. This theorem states the partial inverse relation in the direction we most often need. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 27-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ Suc → suc pre 𝑁 = 𝑁) | ||
| 27-Jan-2026 | eupre 38868 | Unique predecessor exists on the successor class. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 27-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ 𝑉 → (𝑁 ∈ Suc ↔ ∃!𝑚 𝑚 SucMap 𝑁)) | ||
| 27-Jan-2026 | dfpre 38850 | Alternate definition of the successor-predecessor. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 27-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ pre 𝑁 = (℩𝑚𝑚 ∈ Pred( SucMap , V, 𝑁)) | ||
| 27-Jan-2026 | df-pre 38849 |
Define the term-level successor-predecessor. It is the unique 𝑚
with suc 𝑚 = 𝑁 when such an 𝑚 exists; otherwise pre 𝑁 is
the
arbitrary default chosen by ℩. See its
alternate definitions
dfpre 38850, dfpre2 38851, dfpre3 38852 and dfpre4 38854.
Our definition is a special case of the widely recognised general 𝑅 -predecessor class df-pred 6259 (the class of all elements 𝑚 of 𝐴 such that 𝑚𝑅𝑁, dfpred3g 6271, cf. also df-bnj14 34879) in several respects. Its most abstract property as a specialisation is that it has a unique existing value by default. This is in contrast to the general version. The uniqueness (conditional on existence) is implied by the property of this specific instance of the general case involving the successor map df-sucmap 38836 in place of 𝑅, so that 𝑚 SucMap 𝑁, cf. sucmapleftuniq 38864, which originates from suc11reg 9538. Existence ∃𝑚𝑚 SucMap 𝑁 holds exactly on 𝑁 ∈ ran SucMap, cf. elrng 5840. Note that dom SucMap = V (see dmsucmap 38842), so the equivalent definition dfpre 38850 uses (℩𝑚𝑚 ∈ Pred( SucMap , V, 𝑁)). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 27-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ pre 𝑁 = (℩𝑚𝑚 ∈ Pred( SucMap , dom SucMap , 𝑁)) | ||
| 26-Jan-2026 | dfpre4 38854 | Alternate definition of the predecessor of the 𝑁 set. The ◡ SucMap is just the "PreMap"; we did not define it because we do not expect to use it extensively in future (cf. the comments of df-sucmap 38836). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 26-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ 𝑉 → pre 𝑁 = (℩𝑚𝑚 ∈ [𝑁]◡ SucMap )) | ||
| 26-Jan-2026 | dfpred4 38853 | Alternate definition of the predecessor class when 𝑁 is a set. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 26-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ 𝑉 → Pred(𝑅, 𝐴, 𝑁) = [𝑁]◡(𝑅 ↾ 𝐴)) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | df-shiftstable 38856 |
Define shift-stability, a general "procedure" pattern for "the
one-step
backward shift/transport of 𝐹 along 𝑆", and then ∩ 𝐹
enforces "and it already holds here".
Let 𝐹 be a relation encoding a property that depends on a "level" coordinate (for example, a feasibility condition indexed by a carrier, a grade, or a stage in a construction). Let 𝑆 be a shift relation between levels (for example, the successor map SucMap, or any other grading step). The composed relation (𝑆 ∘ 𝐹) transports 𝐹 one step along the shift: 𝑟(𝑆 ∘ 𝐹)𝑛 means there exists a predecessor level 𝑚 such that 𝑟𝐹𝑚 and 𝑚𝑆𝑛 (e.g., 𝑚 SucMap 𝑛). We do not introduce a separate notation for "Shift" because it is simply the standard relational composition df-co 5634. The intersection ((𝑆 ∘ 𝐹) ∩ 𝐹) is the locally shift-stable fragment of 𝐹: it consists exactly of those points where the property holds at some immediate predecessor that shifts to 𝑛 and also holds at level 𝑛. In other words, it isolates the part of 𝐹 that is already compatible with one-step tower coherence. This definition packages a common construction pattern used throughout the development: "constrain by one-step stability under a chosen shift, then additionally constrain by 𝐹". Iterating the operator (𝑋 ↦ ((𝑆 ∘ 𝑋) ∩ 𝑋) corresponds to multi-step/tower coherence; the one-step definition here is the economical kernel from which such "tower" readings can be developed when needed. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑆 ShiftStable 𝐹) = ((𝑆 ∘ 𝐹) ∩ 𝐹) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | df-succl 38843 | Define Suc as the class of all successors, i.e. the range of the successor map: 𝑛 ∈ Suc iff ∃𝑚suc 𝑚 = 𝑛 (see dfsuccl2 38844). By injectivity of suc (suc11reg 9538), every 𝑛 ∈ Suc has at most one predecessor, which is exactly what pre 𝑛 (df-pre 38849) names. Cf. dfsuccl3 38847 and dfsuccl4 38848. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ Suc = ran SucMap | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | df-sucmap 38836 |
Define the successor map, directly as the graph of the successor
operation, using only elementary set theory (ordered-pair class
abstraction). This avoids committing to any particular construction of
the successor function/class from other operators (e.g. a
union/composition presentation), while remaining provably equivalent to
those presentations (cf. dfsucmap2 38838 and dfsucmap3 38837 vs. df-succf 36105 and
dfsuccf2 36176). For maximum mappy shape, see dfsucmap4 38839.
We also treat the successor relation as the default shift relation for grading/tower arguments (cf. df-shiftstable 38856). Because it is used pervasively in shift-lift infrastructure, we adopt the short name SucMap rather than the fully systematic "SucAdjLiftMap". You may also define the predecessor relation as the converse graph "PreMap" as ◡ SucMap, which reverses successor edges ( cf. cnvopab 6094) and sends each successor to its (unique) predecessor when it exists. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ SucMap = {〈𝑚, 𝑛〉 ∣ suc 𝑚 = 𝑛} | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | ecxrncnvep2 38784 | The (𝑅 ⋉ ◡ E )-coset of a set is the Cartesian product of its 𝑅-coset and the set. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → [𝐴](𝑅 ⋉ ◡ E ) = ([𝐴]𝑅 × 𝐴)) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | omprcomonb 35308 | The class of all finite ordinals is a proper class iff all ordinal sets are finite. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (¬ ω ∈ V ↔ ω = On) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | fineqvomonb 35307 | All sets are finite iff all ordinal sets are finite. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (Fin = V ↔ ω = On) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | r1omfv 35298 | Value of the cumulative hierarchy of sets function at ω. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅1‘ω) = ∪ (𝑅1 “ ω) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | r12 35283 | Value of the cumulative hierarchy of sets function at 2o. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅1‘2o) = 2o | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | xoromon 35277 | ω is either an ordinal set or the proper class of all ordinal sets, but not both. This is a stronger version of omon 7825. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (ω ∈ On ⊻ ω = On) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | esplyind 33766 | A recursive formula for the elementary symmetric polynomials. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑊 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (𝐼 mVar 𝑅) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝑊) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ 𝐺 = ((𝐼extendVars𝑅)‘𝑌) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (𝐼 ∖ {𝑌}) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (𝐽eSymPoly𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (1...(♯‘𝐼))) & ⊢ 𝐶 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐽) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐼eSymPoly𝑅)‘𝐾) = (((𝑉‘𝑌) · (𝐺‘(𝐸‘(𝐾 − 1)))) + (𝐺‘(𝐸‘𝐾)))) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | esplyfval3 33763 | Alternate expression for the value of the 𝐾-th elementary symmetric polynomial. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐼eSymPoly𝑅)‘𝐾) = (𝑓 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ if((ran 𝑓 ⊆ {0, 1} ∧ (♯‘(𝑓 supp 0)) = 𝐾), 1 , 0 ))) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | esplyfval2 33756 | When 𝐾 is out-of-bounds, the 𝐾-th elementary symmetric polynomial is zero. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (ℕ0 ∖ (0...(♯‘𝐼)))) & ⊢ 𝑍 = (0g‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐼eSymPoly𝑅)‘𝐾) = 𝑍) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | mplmulmvr 33730 | Multiply a polynomial 𝐹 with a variable 𝑋 (i.e. with a monic monomial). (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑃 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑋 = ((𝐼 mVar 𝑅)‘𝑌) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑃) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ 𝐴 = ((𝟭‘𝐼)‘{𝑌}) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑀) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 · 𝐹) = (𝑏 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ if((𝑏‘𝑌) = 0, 0 , (𝐹‘(𝑏 ∘f − 𝐴))))) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | mvrvalind 33729 | Value of the generating elements of the power series structure, expressed using the indicator function. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑉 = (𝐼 mVar 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ (◡ℎ “ ℕ) ∈ Fin} & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ 𝑌) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐴 = ((𝟭‘𝐼)‘{𝑋}) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑉‘𝑋)‘𝐹) = if(𝐹 = 𝐴, 1 , 0 )) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | extvfvalf 33728 | The "variable extension" function maps polynomials with variables indexed in 𝐽 to polynomials with variables indexed in 𝐼. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (𝐼 ∖ {𝐴}) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐽 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (Base‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐼extendVars𝑅)‘𝐴):𝑀⟶𝑁) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | extvfvcl 33727 | Closure for the "variable extension" function evaluated for converting a given polynomial 𝐹 by adding a variable with index 𝐴. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (𝐼 ∖ {𝐴}) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐽 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑀) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (Base‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (((𝐼extendVars𝑅)‘𝐴)‘𝐹) ∈ 𝑁) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | extvfvvcl 33726 | Closure for the "variable extension" function evaluated for converting a given polynomial 𝐹 by adding a variable with index 𝐴. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (𝐼 ∖ {𝐴}) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐽 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑀) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐷) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((((𝐼extendVars𝑅)‘𝐴)‘𝐹)‘𝑋) ∈ 𝐵) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | extvfvv 33725 | The "variable extension" function evaluated for converting a given polynomial 𝐹 by adding a variable with index 𝐴. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (𝐼 ∖ {𝐴}) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐽 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑀) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐷) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((((𝐼extendVars𝑅)‘𝐴)‘𝐹)‘𝑋) = if((𝑋‘𝐴) = 0, (𝐹‘(𝑋 ↾ 𝐽)), 0 )) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | extvfv 33724 | The "variable extension" function evaluated for converting a given polynomial 𝐹 by adding a variable with index 𝐴. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (𝐼 ∖ {𝐴}) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐽 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑀) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (((𝐼extendVars𝑅)‘𝐴)‘𝐹) = (𝑥 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ if((𝑥‘𝐴) = 0, (𝐹‘(𝑥 ↾ 𝐽)), 0 ))) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | extvfval 33723 | The "variable extension" function evaluated for adding a variable with index 𝐴. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (𝐼 ∖ {𝐴}) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐽 mPoly 𝑅)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐼extendVars𝑅)‘𝐴) = (𝑓 ∈ 𝑀 ↦ (𝑥 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ if((𝑥‘𝐴) = 0, (𝑓‘(𝑥 ↾ 𝐽)), 0 )))) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | extvval 33722 | Value of the "variable extension" function. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (𝐼 ∖ {𝑎}) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐽 mPoly 𝑅)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐼extendVars𝑅) = (𝑎 ∈ 𝐼 ↦ (𝑓 ∈ 𝑀 ↦ (𝑥 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ if((𝑥‘𝑎) = 0, (𝑓‘(𝑥 ↾ (𝐼 ∖ {𝑎}))), 0 ))))) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | nn0diffz0 32893 | Upper set of the nonnegative integers. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ ℕ0 → (ℕ0 ∖ (0...𝑁)) = (ℤ≥‘(𝑁 + 1))) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | rnressnsn 32776 | The range of a restriction to a singleton is a singleton. See dmressnsn 5982. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((Fun 𝐹 ∧ 𝐴 ∈ dom 𝐹) → ran (𝐹 ↾ {𝐴}) = {(𝐹‘𝐴)}) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | partfun2 32775 | Rewrite a function defined by parts, using a mapping and an if construct, into a union of functions on disjoint domains. See also partfun 6639 and ifmpt2v 7465. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∣ 𝜑} ⇒ ⊢ (𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ↦ if(𝜑, 𝐵, 𝐶)) = ((𝑥 ∈ 𝐷 ↦ 𝐵) ∪ (𝑥 ∈ (𝐴 ∖ 𝐷) ↦ 𝐶)) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | indconst1 12170 | Indicator of the whole set. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑂 ∈ 𝑉 → ((𝟭‘𝑂)‘𝑂) = (𝑂 × {1})) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | indconst0 12169 | Indicator of the empty set. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑂 ∈ 𝑉 → ((𝟭‘𝑂)‘∅) = (𝑂 × {0})) | ||
| 25-Jan-2026 | tz6.12-2 6821 | Function value when 𝐹 is not a function. Theorem 6.12(2) of [TakeutiZaring] p. 27. (Contributed by NM, 30-Apr-2004.) (Proof shortened by Mario Carneiro, 31-Aug-2015.) Avoid ax-10 2152, ax-11 2168, ax-12 2189. (Revised by TM, 25-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (¬ ∃!𝑥 𝐴𝐹𝑥 → (𝐹‘𝐴) = ∅) | ||
| 24-Jan-2026 | r1omhfb 35300 | The class of all hereditarily finite sets is the only class with the property that all sets are members of it iff they are finite and all of their elements are members of it. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 24-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐻 = ∪ (𝑅1 “ ω) ↔ ∀𝑥(𝑥 ∈ 𝐻 ↔ (𝑥 ∈ Fin ∧ ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 𝑦 ∈ 𝐻))) | ||
| 24-Jan-2026 | trssfir1om 35299 | If every element in a transitive class is finite, then every element is also hereditarily finite. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 24-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((Tr 𝐴 ∧ 𝐴 ⊆ Fin) → 𝐴 ⊆ ∪ (𝑅1 “ ω)) | ||
| 24-Jan-2026 | r11 35282 | Value of the cumulative hierarchy of sets function at 1o. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 24-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅1‘1o) = 1o | ||
| 24-Jan-2026 | rnco 6210 | The range of the composition of two classes. (Contributed by NM, 12-Dec-2006.) (Proof shortened by Peter Mazsa, 2-Oct-2022.) Avoid ax-11 2168. (Revised by TM, 24-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ran (𝐴 ∘ 𝐵) = ran (𝐴 ↾ ran 𝐵) | ||
| 24-Jan-2026 | dm0rn0 5873 | An empty domain is equivalent to an empty range. (Contributed by NM, 21-May-1998.) Avoid ax-10 2152, ax-11 2168, ax-12 2189. (Revised by TM, 24-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (dom 𝐴 = ∅ ↔ ran 𝐴 = ∅) | ||
| 24-Jan-2026 | eqabcbw 2814 | Version of eqabcb 2880 using implicit substitution, which requires fewer axioms. (Contributed by TM, 24-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑥 = 𝑦 → (𝜑 ↔ 𝜓)) ⇒ ⊢ ({𝑥 ∣ 𝜑} = 𝐴 ↔ ∀𝑦(𝜓 ↔ 𝑦 ∈ 𝐴)) | ||
| 24-Jan-2026 | excomw 2053 | Weak version of excom 2173 and biconditional form of excomimw 2051. Uses only Tarski's FOL axiom schemes. (Contributed by TM, 24-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑥 = 𝑤 → (𝜑 ↔ 𝜓)) & ⊢ (𝑦 = 𝑧 → (𝜑 ↔ 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (∃𝑥∃𝑦𝜑 ↔ ∃𝑦∃𝑥𝜑) | ||
| 22-Jan-2026 | chnsubseq 47332 | An order-preserving subsequence of an ordered chain is itself a chain. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 22-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑊 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ ( < Chain (0..^(♯‘𝑊)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → < Po 𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑊 ∘ 𝐼) ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴)) | ||
| 22-Jan-2026 | chnsubseqwl 47331 | A subsequence of a chain has the same length as its indexing sequence. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 22-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑊 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ ( < Chain (0..^(♯‘𝑊)))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (♯‘(𝑊 ∘ 𝐼)) = (♯‘𝐼)) | ||
| 22-Jan-2026 | chnsubseqword 47330 | A subsequence of a chain is a word. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 22-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑊 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ ( < Chain (0..^(♯‘𝑊)))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑊 ∘ 𝐼) ∈ Word 𝐴) | ||
| 22-Jan-2026 | r1filim 35292 | A finite set appears in the cumulative hierarchy prior to a limit ordinal iff all of its elements appear in the cumulative hierarchy prior to that limit ordinal. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 22-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ Fin ∧ Lim 𝐵) → (𝐴 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ 𝐵) ↔ ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝑥 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ 𝐵))) | ||
| 22-Jan-2026 | rankfilimb 35290 | The rank of a finite well-founded set is less than a limit ordinal iff the ranks of all of its elements are less than that limit ordinal. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 22-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ Fin ∧ 𝐴 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On) ∧ Lim 𝐵) → ((rank‘𝐴) ∈ 𝐵 ↔ ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 (rank‘𝑥) ∈ 𝐵)) | ||
| 21-Jan-2026 | r1omhfbregs 35325 | The class of all hereditarily finite sets is the only class with the property that all sets are members of it iff they are finite and all of their elements are members of it. This version of r1omhfb 35300 replaces setinds2 9670 with setinds2regs 35319 and trssfir1om 35299 with trssfir1omregs 35324. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 21-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐻 = ∪ (𝑅1 “ ω) ↔ ∀𝑥(𝑥 ∈ 𝐻 ↔ (𝑥 ∈ Fin ∧ ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 𝑦 ∈ 𝐻))) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | trssfir1omregs 35324 | If every element in a transitive class is finite, then every element is also hereditarily finite. This version of trssfir1om 35299 replaces setinds2 9670 with setinds2regs 35319. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((Tr 𝐴 ∧ 𝐴 ⊆ Fin) → 𝐴 ⊆ ∪ (𝑅1 “ ω)) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | df-extv 33721 | Define the "variable extension" function. The function ((𝐼extendVars𝑅)‘𝐴) converts polynomials with variables indexed by (𝐼 ∖ {𝐴}) into polynomials indexed by 𝐼, and therefore maps elements of ((𝐼 ∖ {𝐴}) mPoly 𝑅) onto (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅). (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ extendVars = (𝑖 ∈ V, 𝑟 ∈ V ↦ (𝑎 ∈ 𝑖 ↦ (𝑓 ∈ (Base‘((𝑖 ∖ {𝑎}) mPoly 𝑟)) ↦ (𝑥 ∈ {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝑖) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} ↦ if((𝑥‘𝑎) = 0, (𝑓‘(𝑥 ↾ (𝑖 ∖ {𝑎}))), (0g‘𝑟)))))) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chnfibg 18600 | Given a partial order, the set of chains is finite iff the alphabet is finite. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( < Po 𝐴 → (𝐴 ∈ Fin ↔ ( < Chain 𝐴) ∈ Fin)) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chninf 18599 | There is an infinite number of chains for any infinite alphabet and any relation. For instance, all the singletons of alphabet characters match. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∉ Fin → ( < Chain 𝐴) ∉ Fin) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chnfi 18598 | There is a finite number of chains over finite domain, as long as the relation orders it. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ Fin ∧ < Po 𝐴) → ( < Chain 𝐴) ∈ Fin) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chnpolfz 18597 | Provided that chain's relation is a partial order, the chain length is restricted to a specific integer range. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → < Po 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Fin) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (♯‘𝐵) ∈ (0...(♯‘𝐴))) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chnpolleha 18596 | A chain under relation which orders the alphabet has at most alphabet's size elements in it. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → < Po 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (♯‘𝐵) ≤ (♯‘𝐴)) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chnpoadomd 18595 | A chain under relation which orders the alphabet cannot have more elements than the alphabet itself. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → < Po 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (0..^(♯‘𝐵)) ≼ 𝐴) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chnpof1 18594 | A chain under relation which orders the alphabet is a one-to-one function from its domain to alphabet. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → < Po 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵:(0..^(♯‘𝐵))–1-1→𝐴) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chnf 18593 | A chain is a zero-based finite sequence with a recoverable upper limit. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐵 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴) → 𝐵:(0..^(♯‘𝐵))⟶𝐴) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chnrev 18591 | Reverse of a chain is chain under the converse relation and same domain. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐵 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴) → (reverse‘𝐵) ∈ (◡ < Chain 𝐴)) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chnccat 18590 | Concatenate two chains. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑇 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑈 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑇 = ∅ ∨ 𝑈 = ∅ ∨ (lastS‘𝑇) < (𝑈‘0))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑇 ++ 𝑈) ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴)) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chnrdss 18581 | Subset theorem for chains. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (( < ⊆ 𝑅 ∧ 𝐴 ⊆ 𝐵) → ( < Chain 𝐴) ⊆ (𝑅 Chain 𝐵)) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chndss 18580 | Chains with an alphabet are also chains with any superset alphabet. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ⊆ 𝐵 → ( < Chain 𝐴) ⊆ ( < Chain 𝐵)) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | chnrss 18579 | Chains under a relation are also chains under any superset relation. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( < ⊆ 𝑅 → ( < Chain 𝐴) ⊆ (𝑅 Chain 𝐴)) | ||
| 20-Jan-2026 | nfchnd 18575 | Bound-variable hypothesis builder for chain collection constructor. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 20-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → Ⅎ𝑥 < ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → Ⅎ𝑥𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → Ⅎ𝑥( < Chain 𝐴)) | ||
| 19-Jan-2026 | r1omhf 35294 | A set is hereditarily finite iff it is finite and all of its elements are hereditarily finite. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 19-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ ω) ↔ (𝐴 ∈ Fin ∧ ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝑥 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ ω))) | ||
| 19-Jan-2026 | r1filimi 35291 | If all elements in a finite set appear in the cumulative hierarchy prior to a limit ordinal, then that set also appears in the cumulative hierarchy prior to the limit ordinal. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 19-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ Fin ∧ ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝑥 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ 𝐵) ∧ Lim 𝐵) → 𝐴 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ 𝐵)) | ||
| 19-Jan-2026 | rankfilimbi 35289 | If all elements in a finite well-founded set have a rank less than a limit ordinal, then the rank of that set is also less than the limit ordinal. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 19-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (((𝐴 ∈ Fin ∧ 𝐴 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On)) ∧ (∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 (rank‘𝑥) ∈ 𝐵 ∧ Lim 𝐵)) → (rank‘𝐴) ∈ 𝐵) | ||
| 19-Jan-2026 | rankval4b 35288 | The rank of a set is the supremum of the successors of the ranks of its members. Exercise 9.1 of [Jech] p. 72. Also a special case of Theorem 7V(b) of [Enderton] p. 204. This variant of rankval4 9789 does not use Regularity, and so requires the assumption that 𝐴 is in the range of 𝑅1. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 19-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On) → (rank‘𝐴) = ∪ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 suc (rank‘𝑥)) | ||
| 19-Jan-2026 | rankval2b 35287 | Value of an alternate definition of the rank function. Definition of [BellMachover] p. 478. This variant of rankval2 9740 does not use Regularity, and so requires the assumption that 𝐴 is in the range of 𝑅1. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 19-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On) → (rank‘𝐴) = ∩ {𝑥 ∈ On ∣ 𝐴 ⊆ (𝑅1‘𝑥)}) | ||
| 19-Jan-2026 | r1wf 35284 | Each stage in the cumulative hierarchy is well-founded. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 19-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅1‘𝐴) ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | esplysply 33762 | The 𝐾-th elementary symmetric polynomial is symmetric. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (0...(♯‘𝐼))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐼eSymPoly𝑅)‘𝐾) ∈ (𝐼SymPoly𝑅)) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | esplyfv 33761 | Coefficient for the 𝐾-th elementary symmetric polynomial and a bag of variables 𝐹: the coefficient is 1 for the bags of exactly 𝐾 variables, having exponent at most 1. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (0...(♯‘𝐼))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝐷) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (((𝐼eSymPoly𝑅)‘𝐾)‘𝐹) = if((ran 𝐹 ⊆ {0, 1} ∧ (♯‘(𝐹 supp 0)) = 𝐾), 1 , 0 )) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | esplyfv1 33760 | Coefficient for the 𝐾-th elementary symmetric polynomial and a bag of variables 𝐹 where variables are not raised to a power. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (0...(♯‘𝐼))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝐷) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ 1 = (1r‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ran 𝐹 ⊆ {0, 1}) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (((𝐼eSymPoly𝑅)‘𝐾)‘𝐹) = if((♯‘(𝐹 supp 0)) = 𝐾, 1 , 0 )) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | esplymhp 33759 | The 𝐾-th elementary symmetric polynomial is homogeneous of degree 𝐾. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (𝐼 mHomP 𝑅) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐼eSymPoly𝑅)‘𝐾) ∈ (𝐻‘𝐾)) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | esplympl 33758 | Elementary symmetric polynomials are polynomials. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐼eSymPoly𝑅)‘𝐾) ∈ 𝑀) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | esplylem 33757 | Lemma for esplyfv 33761 and others. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ Fin) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ ℕ0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝟭‘𝐼) “ {𝑐 ∈ 𝒫 𝐼 ∣ (♯‘𝑐) = 𝐾}) ⊆ 𝐷) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | esplyfval 33754 | The 𝐾-th elementary polynomial for a given index 𝐼 of variables and base ring 𝑅. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ ℕ0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐼eSymPoly𝑅)‘𝐾) = ((ℤRHom‘𝑅) ∘ ((𝟭‘𝐷)‘((𝟭‘𝐼) “ {𝑐 ∈ 𝒫 𝐼 ∣ (♯‘𝑐) = 𝐾})))) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | esplyval 33753 | The elementary polynomials for a given index 𝐼 of variables and base ring 𝑅. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ 𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐼eSymPoly𝑅) = (𝑘 ∈ ℕ0 ↦ ((ℤRHom‘𝑅) ∘ ((𝟭‘𝐷)‘((𝟭‘𝐼) “ {𝑐 ∈ 𝒫 𝐼 ∣ (♯‘𝑐) = 𝑘}))))) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | issply 33752 | Conditions for being a symmetric polynomial. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (SymGrp‘𝐼) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ 𝐷 = {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑀) & ⊢ (((𝜑 ∧ 𝑝 ∈ 𝑃) ∧ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐷) → (𝐹‘(𝑥 ∘ 𝑝)) = (𝐹‘𝑥)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐼SymPoly𝑅)) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | df-esply 33749 | Define elementary symmetric polynomials. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ eSymPoly = (𝑖 ∈ V, 𝑟 ∈ V ↦ (𝑘 ∈ ℕ0 ↦ ((ℤRHom‘𝑟) ∘ ((𝟭‘{ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝑖) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0})‘((𝟭‘𝑖) “ {𝑐 ∈ 𝒫 𝑖 ∣ (♯‘𝑐) = 𝑘}))))) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | gsumind 33435 | The group sum of an indicator function of the set 𝐴 gives the size of 𝐴. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑂 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ⊆ 𝑂) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Fin) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (ℂfld Σg ((𝟭‘𝑂)‘𝐴)) = (♯‘𝐴)) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | indfsid 32955 | Conditions for a function to be an indicator function. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑂 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝑂⟶{0, 1}) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = ((𝟭‘𝑂)‘(𝐹 supp 0))) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | indfsd 32954 | The indicator function of a finite set has finite support. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑂 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ⊆ 𝑂) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Fin) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝟭‘𝑂)‘𝐴) finSupp 0) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | hashimaf1 32910 | Taking the image of a set by a one-to-one function does not affect size. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝐴–1-1→𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ⊆ 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (♯‘(𝐹 “ 𝐶)) = (♯‘𝐶)) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | pw2cut2 28479 | Cut expression for powers of two. Theorem 12 of [Conway] p. 12-13. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℤs ∧ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) → (𝐴 /su (2s↑s𝑁)) = ({((𝐴 -s 1s ) /su (2s↑s𝑁))} |s {((𝐴 +s 1s ) /su (2s↑s𝑁))})) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | pw2ltsdiv1d 28469 | Surreal less-than relationship for division by a power of two. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 <s 𝐵 ↔ (𝐴 /su (2s↑s𝑁)) <s (𝐵 /su (2s↑s𝑁)))) | ||
| 18-Jan-2026 | sltssnb 27786 | Surreal set less-than of two singletons. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 18-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ({𝐴} <<s {𝐵} ↔ 𝐴 <s 𝐵)) | ||
| 17-Jan-2026 | ex-chn2 18602 | Example: sequence <" ZZ NN QQ "> is a valid chain under the equinumerosity relation in universal domain. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 17-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 〈“ℤℕℚ”〉 ∈ ( ≈ Chain V) | ||
| 17-Jan-2026 | ex-chn1 18601 | Example: a doubleton of twos is a valid chain under the identity relation and domain of integers. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 17-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 〈“22”〉 ∈ ( I Chain ℤ) | ||
| 17-Jan-2026 | chnflenfi 18592 | There is a finite number of chains with fixed length over finite alphabet. Trivially holds for invalid lengths as there're no matching sequences. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 5-Jan-2025.) (Revised by Ender Ting, 17-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ Fin → {𝑎 ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴) ∣ (♯‘𝑎) = 𝑇} ∈ Fin) | ||
| 17-Jan-2026 | nulchn 18583 | Empty set is an increasing chain for every range and every relation. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 19-Nov-2024.) (Revised by Ender Ting, 17-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∅ ∈ ( < Chain 𝐴) | ||
| 17-Jan-2026 | chnexg 18582 | Chains with a set given for range form a set. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 21-Nov-2024.) (Revised by Ender Ting, 17-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → ( < Chain 𝐴) ∈ V) | ||
| 17-Jan-2026 | chneq12 18578 | Equality theorem for chains. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 17-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (( < = 𝑅 ∧ 𝐴 = 𝐵) → ( < Chain 𝐴) = (𝑅 Chain 𝐵)) | ||
| 17-Jan-2026 | chneq2 18577 | Equality theorem for chains. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 17-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 = 𝐵 → ( < Chain 𝐴) = ( < Chain 𝐵)) | ||
| 17-Jan-2026 | chneq1 18576 | Equality theorem for chains. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 17-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ( < = 𝑅 → ( < Chain 𝐴) = (𝑅 Chain 𝐴)) | ||
| 15-Jan-2026 | r1ssel 35295 | A set is a subset of the value of the cumulative hierarchy of sets function iff it is an element of the value at the successor. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 15-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐵 ∈ On → (𝐴 ⊆ (𝑅1‘𝐵) ↔ 𝐴 ∈ (𝑅1‘suc 𝐵))) | ||
| 15-Jan-2026 | fissorduni 35278 | The union (supremum) of a finite set of ordinals less than a nonzero ordinal class is an element of that ordinal class. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 15-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ Fin ∧ 𝐴 ⊆ 𝐵 ∧ (Ord 𝐵 ∧ 𝐵 ≠ ∅)) → ∪ 𝐴 ∈ 𝐵) | ||
| 15-Jan-2026 | splysubrg 33751 | The symmetric polynomials form a subring of the ring of polynomials. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (SymGrp‘𝐼) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (𝑑 ∈ 𝑃, 𝑓 ∈ 𝑀 ↦ (𝑥 ∈ {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} ↦ (𝑓‘(𝑥 ∘ 𝑑)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐼SymPoly𝑅) ∈ (SubRing‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅))) | ||
| 15-Jan-2026 | mplvrpmrhm 33738 | The action of permuting variables in a multivariate polynomial is a ring homomorphism. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (SymGrp‘𝐼) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (𝑑 ∈ 𝑃, 𝑓 ∈ 𝑀 ↦ (𝑥 ∈ {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} ↦ (𝑓‘(𝑥 ∘ 𝑑)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑓 ∈ 𝑀 ↦ (𝐷𝐴𝑓)) & ⊢ 𝑊 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑃) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑊 RingHom 𝑊)) | ||
| 15-Jan-2026 | cocnvf1o 32828 | Composing with the inverse of a bijection. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝐴⟶𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺:𝐴⟶𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐻:𝐴–1-1-onto→𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐹 = (𝐺 ∘ 𝐻) ↔ 𝐺 = (𝐹 ∘ ◡𝐻))) | ||
| 15-Jan-2026 | ofrco 32709 | Function relation between function compositions. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 Fn 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 Fn 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐻:𝐶⟶𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∘r 𝑅𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐹 ∘ 𝐻) ∘r 𝑅(𝐺 ∘ 𝐻)) | ||
| 15-Jan-2026 | fnfvor 32708 | Relation between two functions implies the same relation for the function value at a given 𝑋. See also fnfvof 7644. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 Fn 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 Fn 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∘r 𝑅𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐹‘𝑋)𝑅(𝐺‘𝑋)) | ||
| 15-Jan-2026 | elrabrd 32593 | Deduction version of elrab 3636, just like elrabd 3638, but backwards direction. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑥 = 𝐴 → (𝜓 ↔ 𝜒)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ {𝑥 ∈ 𝐵 ∣ 𝜓}) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝜒) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | preel 38874 | Predecessor is a subset of its successor. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ Suc → pre 𝑁 ∈ 𝑁) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | press 38873 | Predecessor is a subset of its successor. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ Suc → pre 𝑁 ⊆ 𝑁) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | presuc 38872 | pre is a left-inverse of suc. This theorem gives a clean rewrite rule that eliminates pre on explicit successors. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑀 ∈ 𝑉 → pre suc 𝑀 = 𝑀) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | preuniqval 38870 | Uniqueness/canonicity of pre. presucmap 38869 gives one witness; this theorem gives it is the only one. It turns any predecessor proof into an equality with pre 𝑁. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ ran SucMap → ∀𝑚(𝑚 SucMap 𝑁 → 𝑚 = pre 𝑁)) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | presucmap 38869 | pre is really a predecessor (when it should be). This correctness theorem for pre makes it usable in proofs without unfolding ℩. This theorem gives one witness; preuniqval 38870 gives it is the only one. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ ran SucMap → pre 𝑁 SucMap 𝑁) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | eupre2 38867 | Unique predecessor exists on the range of the successor map. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ 𝑉 → (𝑁 ∈ ran SucMap ↔ ∃!𝑚 𝑚 SucMap 𝑁)) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | preex 38866 | The successor-predecessor exists. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ pre 𝑁 ∈ V | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | exeupre 38865 | Whenever a predecessor exists, it exists alone. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ 𝑉 → (∃𝑚 𝑚 SucMap 𝑁 ↔ ∃!𝑚 𝑚 SucMap 𝑁)) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | dfpre3 38852 | Alternate definition of the successor-predecessor. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ 𝑉 → pre 𝑁 = (℩𝑚 suc 𝑚 = 𝑁)) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | dfpre2 38851 | Alternate definition of the successor-predecessor. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ 𝑉 → pre 𝑁 = (℩𝑚𝑚 SucMap 𝑁)) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | exeupre2 38846 | Whenever a predecessor exists, it exists alone. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑚 suc 𝑚 = 𝑁 ↔ ∃!𝑚 suc 𝑚 = 𝑁) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | mopre 38845 | There is at most one predecessor of 𝑁. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ∃*𝑚 suc 𝑚 = 𝑁 | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | fineqvnttrclse 35312 | A counterexample demonstrating that ttrclse 9646 does not hold when all sets are finite. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑅 = {〈𝑥, 𝑦〉 ∣ (𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ 𝑥 = suc 𝑦)} & ⊢ 𝐴 = ω ⇒ ⊢ (Fin = V → (𝑅 Se 𝐴 ∧ ¬ t++(𝑅 ↾ 𝐴) Se 𝐴)) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | fineqvnttrclselem3 35311 | Lemma for fineqvnttrclse 35312. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑅 = {〈𝑥, 𝑦〉 ∣ (𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ 𝑥 = suc 𝑦)} & ⊢ 𝐴 = ω & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑣 ∈ suc suc 𝑁 ↦ ∪ {𝑑 ∈ On ∣ (𝑣 +o 𝑑) = 𝐵}) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐵 ∈ (ω ∖ 1o) ∧ 𝑁 ∈ 𝐵) → ∀𝑎 ∈ suc 𝑁(𝐹‘𝑎)𝑅(𝐹‘suc 𝑎)) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | fineqvnttrclselem2 35310 | Lemma for fineqvnttrclse 35312. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑣 ∈ suc suc 𝑁 ↦ ∪ {𝑑 ∈ On ∣ (𝑣 +o 𝑑) = 𝐵}) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐵 ∈ (ω ∖ 1o) ∧ 𝑁 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ 𝐴 ∈ suc suc 𝑁) → (𝐴 +o (𝐹‘𝐴)) = 𝐵) | ||
| 12-Jan-2026 | fineqvnttrclselem1 35309 | Lemma for fineqvnttrclse 35312. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 12-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝐵 ∈ (ω ∖ 1o) → ∪ {𝑑 ∈ On ∣ (𝐴 +o 𝑑) = 𝐵} ∈ ω) | ||
| 11-Jan-2026 | splyval 33750 | The symmetric polynomials for a given index 𝐼 of variables and base ring 𝑅. These are the fixed points of the action 𝐴 which permutes variables. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 11-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (SymGrp‘𝐼) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (𝑑 ∈ 𝑃, 𝑓 ∈ 𝑀 ↦ (𝑥 ∈ {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} ↦ (𝑓‘(𝑥 ∘ 𝑑)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ 𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐼SymPoly𝑅) = (𝑀FixPts𝐴)) | ||
| 11-Jan-2026 | df-sply 33748 | Define symmetric polynomials. See splyval 33750 for a more readable expression. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 11-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ SymPoly = (𝑖 ∈ V, 𝑟 ∈ V ↦ ((Base‘(𝑖 mPoly 𝑟))FixPts(𝑑 ∈ (Base‘(SymGrp‘𝑖)), 𝑓 ∈ (Base‘(𝑖 mPoly 𝑟)) ↦ (𝑥 ∈ {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝑖) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} ↦ (𝑓‘(𝑥 ∘ 𝑑)))))) | ||
| 11-Jan-2026 | mplvrpmmhm 33737 | The action of permuting variables in a multivariate polynomial is a monoid homomorphism. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 11-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (SymGrp‘𝐼) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (𝑑 ∈ 𝑃, 𝑓 ∈ 𝑀 ↦ (𝑥 ∈ {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} ↦ (𝑓‘(𝑥 ∘ 𝑑)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑓 ∈ 𝑀 ↦ (𝐷𝐴𝑓)) & ⊢ 𝑊 = (𝐼 mPoly 𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑃) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑊 MndHom 𝑊)) | ||
| 11-Jan-2026 | mplvrpmlem 33734 | Lemma for mplvrpmga 33736 and others. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 11-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (SymGrp‘𝐼) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑃) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0}) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 ∘ 𝐷) ∈ {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0}) | ||
| 11-Jan-2026 | constcof 32720 | Composition with a constant function. See also fcoconst 7083. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 11-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝑋⟶𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐼 × {𝑌}) ∘ 𝐹) = (𝑋 × {𝑌})) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | finextalg 33889 | A finite field extension is algebraic. Proposition 1.1 of [Lang], p. 224. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸/FinExt𝐹) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸/AlgExt𝐹) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | bralgext 33888 | Express the fact that a field extension 𝐸 / 𝐹 is algebraic. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐸) & ⊢ 𝐶 = (Base‘𝐹) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐸/AlgExt𝐹 ↔ (𝐸/FldExt𝐹 ∧ (𝐸 IntgRing 𝐶) = 𝐵))) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | extdgfialg 33885 | A finite field extension 𝐸 / 𝐹 is algebraic. Part of the proof of Proposition 1.1 of [Lang], p. 224. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐸) & ⊢ 𝐷 = (dim‘((subringAlg ‘𝐸)‘𝐹)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 ∈ Field) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (SubDRing‘𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ ℕ0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐸 IntgRing 𝐹) = 𝐵) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | extdgfialglem2 33884 | Lemma for extdgfialg 33885. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐸) & ⊢ 𝐷 = (dim‘((subringAlg ‘𝐸)‘𝐹)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 ∈ Field) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (SubDRing‘𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ 𝑍 = (0g‘𝐸) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝐸) & ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝑛 ∈ (0...𝐷) ↦ (𝑛(.g‘(mulGrp‘((subringAlg ‘𝐸)‘𝐹)))𝑋)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴:(0...𝐷)⟶𝐹) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 finSupp 𝑍) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐸 Σg (𝐴 ∘f · 𝐺)) = 𝑍) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ≠ ((0...𝐷) × {𝑍})) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ (𝐸 IntgRing 𝐹)) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | extdgfialglem1 33883 | Lemma for extdgfialg 33885. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐸) & ⊢ 𝐷 = (dim‘((subringAlg ‘𝐸)‘𝐹)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 ∈ Field) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (SubDRing‘𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ 𝑍 = (0g‘𝐸) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝐸) & ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝑛 ∈ (0...𝐷) ↦ (𝑛(.g‘(mulGrp‘((subringAlg ‘𝐸)‘𝐹)))𝑋)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ∃𝑎 ∈ (𝐹 ↑m (0...𝐷))(𝑎 finSupp 𝑍 ∧ ((𝐸 Σg (𝑎 ∘f · 𝐺)) = 𝑍 ∧ 𝑎 ≠ ((0...𝐷) × {𝑍})))) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | finextfldext 33855 | A finite field extension is a field extension. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸/FinExt𝐹) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸/FldExt𝐹) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | srapwov 33780 | The "power" operation on a subring algebra. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐴 = ((subringAlg ‘𝑊)‘𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑊 ∈ Ring) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑆 ⊆ (Base‘𝑊)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (.g‘(mulGrp‘𝑊)) = (.g‘(mulGrp‘𝐴))) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | mplvrpmga 33736 | The action of permuting variables in a multivariate polynomial is a group action. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (SymGrp‘𝐼) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (𝑑 ∈ 𝑃, 𝑓 ∈ 𝑀 ↦ (𝑥 ∈ {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} ↦ (𝑓‘(𝑥 ∘ 𝑑)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝑆 GrpAct 𝑀)) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | mplvrpmfgalem 33735 | Permuting variables in a multivariate polynomial conserves finite support. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (SymGrp‘𝐼) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (Base‘(𝐼 mPoly 𝑅)) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (𝑑 ∈ 𝑃, 𝑓 ∈ 𝑀 ↦ (𝑥 ∈ {ℎ ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ ℎ finSupp 0} ↦ (𝑓‘(𝑥 ∘ 𝑑)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐼 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ 0 = (0g‘𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑀) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑄 ∈ 𝑃) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑄𝐴𝐹) finSupp 0 ) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | psrbasfsupp 33702 | Rewrite a finite support for nonnegative integers : For functions mapping a set 𝐼 to the nonnegative integers, having finite support can also be written as having a finite preimage of the positive integers. The latter expression is used for example in psrbas 21916, but with the former expression, theorems about finite support can be used more directly. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = {𝑓 ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ 𝑓 finSupp 0} ⇒ ⊢ 𝐷 = {𝑓 ∈ (ℕ0 ↑m 𝐼) ∣ (◡𝑓 “ ℕ) ∈ Fin} | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | evls1monply1 33669 | Subring evaluation of a scaled monomial. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝑆 evalSub1 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝐾 = (Base‘𝑆) & ⊢ 𝑊 = (Poly1‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝑈 = (𝑆 ↾s 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑋 = (var1‘𝑈) & ⊢ ↑ = (.g‘(mulGrp‘𝑊)) & ⊢ ∧ = (.g‘(mulGrp‘𝑆)) & ⊢ ∗ = ( ·𝑠 ‘𝑊) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑆 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ (SubRing‘𝑆)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐾) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑄‘(𝐴 ∗ (𝑁 ↑ 𝑋)))‘𝑌) = (𝐴 · (𝑁 ∧ 𝑌))) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | fcobijfs2 32821 | Composing finitely supported functions with a bijection yields a bijection between sets of finitely supported functions. See also fcobijfs 32820 and mapfien 9318. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺:𝑅–1-1-onto→𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ 𝑈) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑆 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑇 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑂 ∈ 𝑇) & ⊢ 𝑋 = {𝑔 ∈ (𝑇 ↑m 𝑆) ∣ 𝑔 finSupp 𝑂} & ⊢ 𝑌 = {ℎ ∈ (𝑇 ↑m 𝑅) ∣ ℎ finSupp 𝑂} ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑓 ∈ 𝑋 ↦ (𝑓 ∘ 𝐺)):𝑋–1-1-onto→𝑌) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | f1oeq3dd 32728 | Equality deduction for one-to-one onto functions. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝐶–1-1-onto→𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 = 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:𝐶–1-1-onto→𝐵) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | fconst7v 32719 | An alternative way to express a constant function. (Contributed by Glauco Siliprandi, 5-Feb-2022.) Removed hyphotheses as suggested by SN (Revised by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 Fn 𝐴) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴) → (𝐹‘𝑥) = 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = (𝐴 × {𝐵})) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | breq2dd 32703 | Equality deduction for a binary relation. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 = 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶𝑅𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶𝑅𝐵) | ||
| 10-Jan-2026 | breq1dd 32702 | Equality deduction for a binary relation. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 10-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 = 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴𝑅𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵𝑅𝐶) | ||
| 8-Jan-2026 | sucmapleftuniq 38864 | Left uniqueness of the successor mapping. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 8-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐿 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝑀 ∈ 𝑊 ∧ 𝑁 ∈ 𝑋) → ((𝐿 SucMap 𝑁 ∧ 𝑀 SucMap 𝑁) → 𝐿 = 𝑀)) | ||
| 7-Jan-2026 | sucmapsuc 38863 | A set is succeeded by its successor. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 7-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝑀 ∈ 𝑉 → 𝑀 SucMap suc 𝑀) | ||
| 7-Jan-2026 | dmsucmap 38842 | The domain of the successor map is the universe. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 7-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ dom SucMap = V | ||
| 7-Jan-2026 | relsucmap 38841 | The successor map is a relation. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 7-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ Rel SucMap | ||
| 6-Jan-2026 | brsucmap 38840 | Binary relation form of the successor map, general version. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 6-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑀 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝑁 ∈ 𝑊) → (𝑀 SucMap 𝑁 ↔ suc 𝑀 = 𝑁)) | ||
| 6-Jan-2026 | dfsuccf2 36176 | Alternate definition of Scott Fenton's version of Succ, cf. df-sucmap 38836. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 6-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ Succ = {〈𝑚, 𝑛〉 ∣ suc 𝑚 = 𝑛} | ||
| 1-Jan-2026 | rightge0 27838 | A surreal is non-negative iff all its right options are positive. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 1-Jan-2026.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 <<s 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 = (𝐴 |s 𝐵)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( 0s ≤s 𝑋 ↔ ∀𝑥𝑅 ∈ 𝐵 0s <s 𝑥𝑅)) | ||
| 31-Dec-2025 | tz9.1regs 35322 |
Every set has a transitive closure (the smallest transitive extension).
This version of tz9.1 9648 depends on ax-regs 35314 instead of ax-reg 9504 and
ax-inf2 9560. This suggests a possible answer to the
third question posed
in tz9.1 9648, namely that the missing property is that
countably infinite
classes must obey regularity. In ZF set theory we can prove this by
showing that countably infinite classes are sets and thus ax-reg 9504
applies to them directly, but in a finitist context it seems that an
axiom like ax-regs 35314 is required since countably infinite classes
are
proper classes.
A related candidate for the missing property is the non-existence of infinite descending ∈-chains, proven as noinfep 9579 using ax-reg 9504 and ax-inf2 9560 and as noinfepregs 35321 using ax-regs 35314. If all sets are finite, then the existence of such a chain implies there is a set which does not have a transitive closure, as shown in fineqvinfep 35313. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 31-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐴 ∈ V ⇒ ⊢ ∃𝑥(𝐴 ⊆ 𝑥 ∧ Tr 𝑥 ∧ ∀𝑦((𝐴 ⊆ 𝑦 ∧ Tr 𝑦) → 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑦)) | ||
| 31-Dec-2025 | setinds2regs 35319 | Principle of set induction (or E-induction). If a property passes from all elements of 𝑥 to 𝑥 itself, then it holds for all 𝑥. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 31-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝑥 = 𝑦 → (𝜑 ↔ 𝜓)) & ⊢ (∀𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 𝜓 → 𝜑) ⇒ ⊢ 𝜑 | ||
| 31-Dec-2025 | nelaneqOLD 9515 | Obsolete version of nelaneq 9514 as of 22-Apr-2026. (Proposed by BJ, 18-Jun-2022.) (Contributed by AV, 18-Jun-2022.) (Proof shortened by TM, 31-Dec-2025.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ¬ (𝐴 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ 𝐴 = 𝐵) | ||
| 31-Dec-2025 | zfregcl 9506 | The Axiom of Regularity with class variables. (Contributed by NM, 5-Aug-1994.) Replace sethood hypothesis with sethood antecedent. (Revised by BJ, 27-Apr-2021.) Avoid ax-10 2152 and ax-12 2189. (Revised by TM, 31-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → (∃𝑥 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 → ∃𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 ¬ 𝑦 ∈ 𝐴)) | ||
| 31-Dec-2025 | dmcosseq 5927 | Domain of a composition. (Contributed by NM, 28-May-1998.) (Proof shortened by Andrew Salmon, 27-Aug-2011.) Avoid ax-11 2168. (Revised by BTernaryTau, 23-Jun-2025.) Avoid ax-10 2152 and ax-12 2189. (Revised by TM, 31-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (ran 𝐵 ⊆ dom 𝐴 → dom (𝐴 ∘ 𝐵) = dom 𝐵) | ||
| 31-Dec-2025 | dmcoss 5924 | Domain of a composition. Theorem 21 of [Suppes] p. 63. (Contributed by NM, 19-Mar-1998.) (Proof shortened by Andrew Salmon, 27-Aug-2011.) Avoid ax-10 2152 and ax-12 2189. (Revised by TM, 31-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ dom (𝐴 ∘ 𝐵) ⊆ dom 𝐵 | ||
| 30-Dec-2025 | grlimedgnedg 48629 | In general, the image of an edge of a graph by a local isomprphism is not an edge of the other graph, proven by an example (see gpg5edgnedg 48628). This theorem proves that the analogon (((𝐺 ∈ USPGraph ∧ 𝐻 ∈ USPGraph) ∧ (𝐹 ∈ (𝐺 GraphLocIso 𝐻) ∧ 𝐾 ∈ 𝐼)) → (𝐹 “ 𝐾) ∈ 𝐸) of grimedgi 48434 for ordinarily isomorphic graphs does not hold in general. (Contributed by AV, 30-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑔 ∈ USGraph ∃ℎ ∈ USGraph ∃𝑓 ∈ (𝑔 GraphLocIso ℎ)∃𝑎 ∈ (Vtx‘𝑔)∃𝑏 ∈ (Vtx‘𝑔)({𝑎, 𝑏} ∈ (Edg‘𝑔) ∧ {(𝑓‘𝑎), (𝑓‘𝑏)} ∉ (Edg‘ℎ)) | ||
| 30-Dec-2025 | grimedgi 48434 | Graph isomorphisms map edges onto the corresponding edges. (Contributed by AV, 30-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐻) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐺 ∈ UHGraph ∧ 𝐻 ∈ UHGraph ∧ 𝐹 ∈ (𝐺 GraphIso 𝐻)) → (𝐾 ∈ 𝐼 → (𝐹 “ 𝐾) ∈ 𝐸)) | ||
| 30-Dec-2025 | fineqvr1ombregs 35326 | All sets are finite iff all sets are hereditarily finite. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 30-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (Fin = V ↔ ∪ (𝑅1 “ ω) = V) | ||
| 30-Dec-2025 | unir1regs 35323 | The cumulative hierarchy of sets covers the universe. This version of unir1 9735 replaces setind 9666 with setindregs 35318. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 30-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On) = V | ||
| 30-Dec-2025 | setindregs 35318 | Set (epsilon) induction. This version of setind 9666 replaces zfregs 9651 with axregszf 35317. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 30-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (∀𝑥(𝑥 ⊆ 𝐴 → 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴) → 𝐴 = V) | ||
| 30-Dec-2025 | axregszf 35317 | Derivation of zfregs 9651 using ax-regs 35314. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 30-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ≠ ∅ → ∃𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 (𝑥 ∩ 𝐴) = ∅) | ||
| 30-Dec-2025 | axregscl 35316 | A version of ax-regs 35314 with a class variable instead of a wff variable. Axiom D in Gödel, The Consistency of the Axiom of Choice and of the Generalized Continuum Hypothesis with the Axioms of Set Theory (1940), p. 6. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 30-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 → ∃𝑦(𝑦 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ 𝑧 ∈ 𝐴))) | ||
| 30-Dec-2025 | axreg 35315 | Derivation of ax-reg 9504 from ax-regs 35314 and Tarski's FOL axiom schemes. This demonstrates the sense in which ax-regs 35314 is a stronger version of ax-reg 9504. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 30-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑦 𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 → ∃𝑦(𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ 𝑧 ∈ 𝑥))) | ||
| 30-Dec-2025 | fineqvomon 35306 | If all sets are finite, then the class of all natural numbers equals the proper class of all ordinal numbers. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 30-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (Fin = V → ω = On) | ||
| 30-Dec-2025 | r1omfi 35293 | Hereditarily finite sets are finite sets. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 30-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ∪ (𝑅1 “ ω) ⊆ Fin | ||
| 30-Dec-2025 | r1elcl 35286 | Each set of the cumulative hierarchy is closed under membership. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 30-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ (𝑅1‘𝐵) ∧ 𝐶 ∈ 𝐴) → 𝐶 ∈ (𝑅1‘𝐵)) | ||
| 30-Dec-2025 | elwf 35285 | An element of a well-founded set is well-founded. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 30-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On) ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝐴) → 𝐵 ∈ ∪ (𝑅1 “ On)) | ||
| 29-Dec-2025 | gpg5edgnedg 48628 | Two consecutive (according to the numbering) inside vertices of the Petersen graph G(5,2) are not connected by an edge, but are connected by an edge in a 5-prism G(5,1). (Contributed by AV, 29-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ({〈1, 0〉, 〈1, 1〉} ∈ (Edg‘(5 gPetersenGr 1)) ∧ {〈1, 0〉, 〈1, 1〉} ∉ (Edg‘(5 gPetersenGr 2))) | ||
| 29-Dec-2025 | axregs 35327 | Derivation of ax-regs 35314 from the axioms of ZF set theory. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 29-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥𝜑 → ∃𝑦(∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → 𝜑) ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑧 → 𝜑)))) | ||
| 29-Dec-2025 | ax-regs 35314 | A strong version of the Axiom of Regularity. It states that if there exists a set with property 𝜑, then there must exist a set with property 𝜑 such that none of its elements have property 𝜑. This axiom can be derived from the axioms of ZF set theory as shown in axregs 35327, but this derivation relies on ax-inf2 9560 and is thus not possible in a finitist context. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 29-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (∃𝑥𝜑 → ∃𝑦(∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑦 → 𝜑) ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧 ∈ 𝑦 → ¬ ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝑧 → 𝜑)))) | ||
| 29-Dec-2025 | optocl 5719 | Implicit substitution of class for ordered pair. (Contributed by NM, 5-Mar-1995.) Shorten and reduce axiom usage. (Revised by TM, 29-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐷 = (𝐵 × 𝐶) & ⊢ (〈𝑥, 𝑦〉 = 𝐴 → (𝜑 ↔ 𝜓)) & ⊢ ((𝑥 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ 𝑦 ∈ 𝐶) → 𝜑) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝐷 → 𝜓) | ||
| 28-Dec-2025 | gpg5grlim 48591 | A local isomorphism between the two generalized Petersen graphs G(N,K) of order 10 (𝑁 = 5), which are the Petersen graph G(5,2) and the 5-prism G(5,1). (Contributed by AV, 28-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ( I ↾ ({0, 1} × (0..^5))) ∈ ((5 gPetersenGr 1) GraphLocIso (5 gPetersenGr 2)) | ||
| 28-Dec-2025 | clnbgr3stgrgrlim 48517 | If all (closed) neighborhoods of the vertices in two simple graphs with the same order induce a subgraph which is isomorphic to an 𝑁-star, then any bijection between the vertices is a local isomorphism between the two graphs. (Contributed by AV, 28-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0 & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑊 = (Vtx‘𝐻) ⇒ ⊢ (((𝐺 ∈ USGraph ∧ 𝐻 ∈ USGraph ∧ 𝐹:𝑉–1-1-onto→𝑊) ∧ ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝑉 (𝐺 ISubGr (𝐺 ClNeighbVtx 𝑥)) ≃𝑔𝑟 (StarGr‘𝑁) ∧ ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝑊 (𝐻 ISubGr (𝐻 ClNeighbVtx 𝑦)) ≃𝑔𝑟 (StarGr‘𝑁)) → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐺 GraphLocIso 𝐻)) | ||
| 28-Dec-2025 | grlimgredgex 48498 | Local isomorphisms between simple pseudographs map an edge onto an edge with an endpoint being the image of one of the endpoints of the first edge under the local isomorphism. (Contributed by AV, 28-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐻) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐻) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑋) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ 𝑌) & ⊢ (𝜑 → {𝐴, 𝐵} ∈ 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ USPGraph) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐻 ∈ USPGraph) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐺 GraphLocIso 𝐻)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ∃𝑣 ∈ 𝑉 {(𝐹‘𝐴), 𝑣} ∈ 𝐸) | ||
| 28-Dec-2025 | grlimprclnbgrvtx 48497 | For two locally isomorphic graphs 𝐺 and 𝐻 and a vertex 𝐴 of 𝐺 there is a bijection 𝑓 mapping the closed neighborhood 𝑁 of 𝐴 onto the closed neighborhood 𝑀 of (𝐹‘𝐴), so that the mapped vertices of an edge {𝐴, 𝐵} containing the vertex 𝐴 is an edge between the vertices in 𝑀 containing the vertex (𝐹‘𝐴). (Contributed by AV, 28-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 ClNeighbVtx 𝐴) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐾 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐼 ∣ 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑁} & ⊢ 𝑀 = (𝐻 ClNeighbVtx (𝐹‘𝐴)) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Edg‘𝐻) & ⊢ 𝐿 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐽 ∣ 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑀} ⇒ ⊢ (((𝐺 ∈ USPGraph ∧ 𝐻 ∈ USPGraph) ∧ 𝐹 ∈ (𝐺 GraphLocIso 𝐻) ∧ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝑊 ∧ {𝐴, 𝐵} ∈ 𝐼)) → ∃𝑓(𝑓:𝑁–1-1-onto→𝑀 ∧ ({(𝐹‘𝐴), (𝑓‘𝐵)} ∈ 𝐿 ∨ {(𝐹‘𝐴), (𝑓‘𝐴)} ∈ 𝐿))) | ||
| 28-Dec-2025 | clnbupgreli 48333 | A member of the closed neighborhood of a vertex in a pseudograph. (Contributed by AV, 28-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐺 ∈ UPGraph ∧ 𝑁 ∈ (𝐺 ClNeighbVtx 𝐾)) → (𝑁 = 𝐾 ∨ {𝑁, 𝐾} ∈ 𝐸)) | ||
| 28-Dec-2025 | elirrvALT 9524 | Alternate proof of elirrv 9509, shorter but using more axioms. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 28-Dec-2025.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ¬ 𝑥 ∈ 𝑥 | ||
| 27-Dec-2025 | grlimgrtrilem1 48499 | Lemma 3 for grlimgrtri 48501. (Contributed by AV, 24-Aug-2025.) (Proof shortened by AV, 27-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 ClNeighbVtx 𝑎) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐾 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐼 ∣ 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑁} ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐺 ∈ UHGraph ∧ ({𝑎, 𝑏} ∈ 𝐼 ∧ {𝑎, 𝑐} ∈ 𝐼 ∧ {𝑏, 𝑐} ∈ 𝐼)) → ({𝑎, 𝑏} ∈ 𝐾 ∧ {𝑎, 𝑐} ∈ 𝐾 ∧ {𝑏, 𝑐} ∈ 𝐾)) | ||
| 27-Dec-2025 | grlimpredg 48496 | For two locally isomorphic graphs 𝐺 and 𝐻 and a vertex 𝐴 of 𝐺 there is a bijection 𝑓 mapping the closed neighborhood 𝑁 of 𝐴 onto the closed neighborhood 𝑀 of (𝐹‘𝐴), so that the mapped vertices of an edge {𝐴, 𝐵} containing the vertex 𝐴 is an edge in 𝐻. (Contributed by AV, 27-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 ClNeighbVtx 𝐴) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐾 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐼 ∣ 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑁} & ⊢ 𝑀 = (𝐻 ClNeighbVtx (𝐹‘𝐴)) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Edg‘𝐻) & ⊢ 𝐿 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐽 ∣ 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑀} ⇒ ⊢ (((𝐺 ∈ USPGraph ∧ 𝐻 ∈ USPGraph) ∧ 𝐹 ∈ (𝐺 GraphLocIso 𝐻) ∧ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝑊 ∧ {𝐴, 𝐵} ∈ 𝐼)) → ∃𝑓(𝑓:𝑁–1-1-onto→𝑀 ∧ {(𝑓‘𝐴), (𝑓‘𝐵)} ∈ 𝐽)) | ||
| 27-Dec-2025 | grlimprclnbgredg 48495 | For two locally isomorphic graphs 𝐺 and 𝐻 and a vertex 𝐴 of 𝐺 there is a bijection 𝑓 mapping the closed neighborhood 𝑁 of 𝐴 onto the closed neighborhood 𝑀 of (𝐹‘𝐴), so that the mapped vertices of an edge {𝐴, 𝐵} containing the vertex 𝐴 is an edge between the vertices in 𝑀. (Contributed by AV, 27-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 ClNeighbVtx 𝐴) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐾 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐼 ∣ 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑁} & ⊢ 𝑀 = (𝐻 ClNeighbVtx (𝐹‘𝐴)) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Edg‘𝐻) & ⊢ 𝐿 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐽 ∣ 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑀} ⇒ ⊢ (((𝐺 ∈ USPGraph ∧ 𝐻 ∈ USPGraph) ∧ 𝐹 ∈ (𝐺 GraphLocIso 𝐻) ∧ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝑊 ∧ {𝐴, 𝐵} ∈ 𝐼)) → ∃𝑓(𝑓:𝑁–1-1-onto→𝑀 ∧ {(𝑓‘𝐴), (𝑓‘𝐵)} ∈ 𝐿)) | ||
| 27-Dec-2025 | elirrvOLD 9510 | Obsolete version of elirrv 9509 as of 21-May-2026. (Contributed by NM, 19-Aug-1993.) Reduce axiom dependencies and make use of ax-reg 9504 directly. (Revised by BTernaryTau, 27-Dec-2025.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ¬ 𝑥 ∈ 𝑥 | ||
| 25-Dec-2025 | grlimprclnbgr 48494 | For two locally isomorphic graphs 𝐺 and 𝐻 and a vertex 𝐴 of 𝐺 there are two bijections 𝑓 and 𝑔 mapping the closed neighborhood 𝑁 of 𝐴 onto the closed neighborhood 𝑀 of (𝐹‘𝐴) and the edges between the vertices in 𝑁 onto the edges between the vertices in 𝑀, so that the mapped vertices of an edge {𝐴, 𝐵} containing the vertex 𝐴 is an edge between the vertices in 𝑀. (Contributed by AV, 25-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 ClNeighbVtx 𝐴) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐾 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐼 ∣ 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑁} & ⊢ 𝑀 = (𝐻 ClNeighbVtx (𝐹‘𝐴)) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Edg‘𝐻) & ⊢ 𝐿 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐽 ∣ 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑀} ⇒ ⊢ (((𝐺 ∈ USPGraph ∧ 𝐻 ∈ USPGraph) ∧ 𝐹 ∈ (𝐺 GraphLocIso 𝐻) ∧ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝑊 ∧ {𝐴, 𝐵} ∈ 𝐼)) → ∃𝑓∃𝑔(𝑓:𝑁–1-1-onto→𝑀 ∧ 𝑔:𝐾–1-1-onto→𝐿 ∧ {(𝑓‘𝐴), (𝑓‘𝐵)} = (𝑔‘{𝐴, 𝐵}))) | ||
| 25-Dec-2025 | grlimedgclnbgr 48493 | For two locally isomorphic graphs 𝐺 and 𝐻 and a vertex 𝐴 of 𝐺 there are two bijections 𝑓 and 𝑔 mapping the closed neighborhood 𝑁 of 𝐴 onto the closed neighborhood 𝑀 of (𝐹‘𝐴) and the edges between the vertices in 𝑁 onto the edges between the vertices in 𝑀, so that the mapped vertices of an edge 𝐸 containing the vertex 𝐴 is an edge between the vertices in 𝑀. (Contributed by AV, 25-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 ClNeighbVtx 𝐴) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐾 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐼 ∣ 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑁} & ⊢ 𝑀 = (𝐻 ClNeighbVtx (𝐹‘𝐴)) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Edg‘𝐻) & ⊢ 𝐿 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐽 ∣ 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑀} ⇒ ⊢ (((𝐺 ∈ USPGraph ∧ 𝐻 ∈ USPGraph) ∧ 𝐹 ∈ (𝐺 GraphLocIso 𝐻) ∧ (𝐸 ∈ 𝐼 ∧ 𝐴 ∈ 𝐸)) → ∃𝑓∃𝑔(𝑓:𝑁–1-1-onto→𝑀 ∧ 𝑔:𝐾–1-1-onto→𝐿 ∧ (𝑓 “ 𝐸) = (𝑔‘𝐸))) | ||
| 25-Dec-2025 | clnbgrvtxedg 48492 | An edge 𝐸 containing a vertex 𝐴 is an edge in the closed neighborhood of this vertex 𝐴. (Contributed by AV, 25-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 ClNeighbVtx 𝐴) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐾 = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐼 ∣ 𝑥 ⊆ 𝑁} ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐺 ∈ UHGraph ∧ 𝐸 ∈ 𝐼 ∧ 𝐴 ∈ 𝐸) → 𝐸 ∈ 𝐾) | ||
| 23-Dec-2025 | zsoring 28426 | The surreal integers form an ordered ring. Note that we have to restrict the operations here since No is a proper class. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 23-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ℤs = (Base‘𝐾) & ⊢ ( +s ↾ (ℤs × ℤs)) = (+g‘𝐾) & ⊢ ( ·s ↾ (ℤs × ℤs)) = (.r‘𝐾) & ⊢ ( ≤s ∩ (ℤs × ℤs)) = (le‘𝐾) & ⊢ 0s = (0g‘𝐾) ⇒ ⊢ 𝐾 ∈ oRing | ||
| 12-Dec-2025 | z12subscl 28496 | The dyadics are closed under subtraction. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 12-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℤs[1/2] ∧ 𝐵 ∈ ℤs[1/2]) → (𝐴 -s 𝐵) ∈ ℤs[1/2]) | ||
| 11-Dec-2025 | z12shalf 28497 | Half of a dyadic is a dyadic. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 11-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℤs[1/2] → (𝐴 /su 2s) ∈ ℤs[1/2]) | ||
| 11-Dec-2025 | z12addscl 28494 | The dyadics are closed under addition. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 11-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℤs[1/2] ∧ 𝐵 ∈ ℤs[1/2]) → (𝐴 +s 𝐵) ∈ ℤs[1/2]) | ||
| 11-Dec-2025 | z12no 28493 | A dyadic is a surreal. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 11-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℤs[1/2] → 𝐴 ∈ No ) | ||
| 11-Dec-2025 | avglts2d 28471 | Ordering property for average. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 11-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 <s 𝐵 ↔ ((𝐴 +s 𝐵) /su 2s) <s 𝐵)) | ||
| 11-Dec-2025 | avglts1d 28470 | Ordering property for average. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 11-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 <s 𝐵 ↔ 𝐴 <s ((𝐴 +s 𝐵) /su 2s))) | ||
| 11-Dec-2025 | pw2ltmuldivs2d 28468 | Surreal less-than relationship between division and multiplication for powers of two. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 11-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (((2s↑s𝑁) ·s 𝐴) <s 𝐵 ↔ 𝐴 <s (𝐵 /su (2s↑s𝑁)))) | ||
| 11-Dec-2025 | pw2ltdivmulsd 28467 | Surreal less-than relationship between division and multiplication for powers of two. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 11-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 /su (2s↑s𝑁)) <s 𝐵 ↔ 𝐴 <s ((2s↑s𝑁) ·s 𝐵))) | ||
| 11-Dec-2025 | pw2divscan4d 28461 | Cancellation law for divison by powers of two. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 11-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀 ∈ ℕ0s) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 /su (2s↑s𝑁)) = (((2s↑s𝑀) ·s 𝐴) /su (2s↑s(𝑁 +s 𝑀)))) | ||
| 11-Dec-2025 | pw2divsassd 28460 | An associative law for division by powers of two. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 11-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ No ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 ·s 𝐵) /su (2s↑s𝑁)) = (𝐴 ·s (𝐵 /su (2s↑s𝑁)))) | ||
| 11-Dec-2025 | zexpscl 28451 | Closure law for surreal integer exponentiation. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 11-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℤs ∧ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) → (𝐴↑s𝑁) ∈ ℤs) | ||
| 11-Dec-2025 | nobdaymin 27770 | Any non-empty class of surreals has a birthday-minimal element. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 11-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ⊆ No ∧ 𝐴 ≠ ∅) → ∃𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ( bday ‘𝑥) = ∩ ( bday “ 𝐴)) | ||
| 10-Dec-2025 | sinnpoly 47361 | Sine function is not a polynomial with complex coefficients. Indeed, it has infinitely many zeros but is not constant zero, contrary to fta1 26299. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 10-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ¬ sin ∈ (Poly‘ℂ) | ||
| 10-Dec-2025 | tannpoly 47360 | The tangent function is not a polynomial with complex coefficients, as it is not defined on the whole complex plane. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 10-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ¬ tan ∈ (Poly‘ℂ) | ||
| 8-Dec-2025 | cjnpoly 47359 | Complex conjugation operator is not a polynomial with complex coefficients. Indeed; if it was, then multiplying 𝑥 conjugate by 𝑥 itself and adding 1 would yield a nowhere-zero non-constant polynomial, contrary to the fta 27068. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 8-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ¬ ∗ ∈ (Poly‘ℂ) | ||
| 6-Dec-2025 | vonf1owev 35343 | If 𝐹 is a bijection from the universe to the ordinals, then 𝑅 well-orders the universe. This is the ZFC version of (2 → 3) in https://tinyurl.com/hamkins-gblac. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 6-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑅 = {〈𝑥, 𝑦〉 ∣ (𝐹‘𝑥) ∈ (𝐹‘𝑦)} ⇒ ⊢ (𝐹:V–1-1-onto→On → 𝑅 We V) | ||
| 5-Dec-2025 | antnestALT 35929 | Alternative proof of antnest 35924 from the valid schema ((((⊤ → 𝜑) → 𝜑) → 𝜓) → 𝜓) using laws of nested antecedents. Our proof uses only the laws antnestlaw1 35926 and antnestlaw3 35928. (Contributed by Adrian Ducourtial, 5-Dec-2025.) (Proof modification is discouraged.) (New usage is discouraged.) |
| ⊢ ((((((⊤ → 𝜑) → 𝜓) → 𝜓) → 𝜑) → 𝜓) → 𝜓) | ||
| 5-Dec-2025 | antnestlaw3 35928 | A law of nested antecedents. Compare with looinv 204. (Contributed by Adrian Ducourtial, 5-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((((𝜑 → 𝜓) → 𝜒) → 𝜒) ↔ (((𝜑 → 𝜒) → 𝜓) → 𝜓)) | ||
| 5-Dec-2025 | antnestlaw2 35927 | A law of nested antecedents. (Contributed by Adrian Ducourtial, 5-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((((𝜑 → 𝜓) → 𝜓) → 𝜒) ↔ (((𝜑 → 𝜒) → 𝜓) → 𝜒)) | ||
| 5-Dec-2025 | antnestlaw1 35926 | A law of nested antecedents. The converse direction is a subschema of pm2.27 42. (Contributed by Adrian Ducourtial, 5-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((((𝜑 → 𝜓) → 𝜓) → 𝜓) ↔ (𝜑 → 𝜓)) | ||
| 5-Dec-2025 | antnestlaw3lem 35925 | Lemma for antnestlaw3 35928. (Contributed by Adrian Ducourtial, 5-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (¬ (((𝜑 → 𝜓) → 𝜒) → 𝜒) → ¬ (((𝜑 → 𝜒) → 𝜓) → 𝜓)) | ||
| 5-Dec-2025 | onvf1od 35342 | If 𝐺 is a global choice function, then 𝐹 is a bijection from the ordinals to the universe. This is the ZFC version of (1 → 2) in https://tinyurl.com/hamkins-gblac. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 5-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑧(𝑧 ≠ ∅ → (𝐺‘𝑧) ∈ 𝑧)) & ⊢ 𝑀 = ∩ {𝑥 ∈ On ∣ ∃𝑦 ∈ (𝑅1‘𝑥) ¬ 𝑦 ∈ ran 𝑤} & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺‘((𝑅1‘𝑀) ∖ ran 𝑤)) & ⊢ 𝐹 = recs((𝑤 ∈ V ↦ 𝑁)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹:On–1-1-onto→V) | ||
| 5-Dec-2025 | z12zsodd 28499 | A dyadic fraction is either an integer or an odd number divided by a positive power of two. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 5-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℤs[1/2] → (𝐴 ∈ ℤs ∨ ∃𝑥 ∈ ℤs ∃𝑦 ∈ ℕs 𝐴 = (((2s ·s 𝑥) +s 1s ) /su (2s↑s𝑦)))) | ||
| 5-Dec-2025 | ltsrecd 27819 | A comparison law for surreals considered as cuts of sets of surreals. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 5-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 <<s 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 <<s 𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 = (𝐴 |s 𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 = (𝐶 |s 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 <s 𝑌 ↔ (∃𝑐 ∈ 𝐶 𝑋 ≤s 𝑐 ∨ ∃𝑏 ∈ 𝐵 𝑏 ≤s 𝑌))) | ||
| 5-Dec-2025 | lesrecd 27817 | A comparison law for surreals considered as cuts of sets of surreals. Definition from [Conway] p. 4. Theorem 4 of [Alling] p. 186. Theorem 2.5 of [Gonshor] p. 9. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 5-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 <<s 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 <<s 𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 = (𝐴 |s 𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 = (𝐶 |s 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 ≤s 𝑌 ↔ (∀𝑑 ∈ 𝐷 𝑋 <s 𝑑 ∧ ∀𝑎 ∈ 𝐴 𝑎 <s 𝑌))) | ||
| 4-Dec-2025 | onvf1odlem4 35341 | Lemma for onvf1od 35342. If the range of 𝐹 does not exist, then it must equal the universe. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 4-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑧(𝑧 ≠ ∅ → (𝐺‘𝑧) ∈ 𝑧)) & ⊢ 𝑀 = ∩ {𝑥 ∈ On ∣ ∃𝑦 ∈ (𝑅1‘𝑥) ¬ 𝑦 ∈ ran 𝑤} & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺‘((𝑅1‘𝑀) ∖ ran 𝑤)) & ⊢ 𝐹 = recs((𝑤 ∈ V ↦ 𝑁)) & ⊢ 𝐵 = ∩ {𝑢 ∈ On ∣ ∃𝑣 ∈ (𝑅1‘𝑢) ¬ 𝑣 ∈ (𝐹 “ 𝑡)} & ⊢ 𝐶 = (𝐺‘((𝑅1‘𝐵) ∖ (𝐹 “ 𝑡))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (¬ ran 𝐹 ∈ V → ran 𝐹 = V)) | ||
| 2-Dec-2025 | onvf1odlem3 35340 | Lemma for onvf1od 35342. The value of 𝐹 at an ordinal 𝐴. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 2-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑀 = ∩ {𝑥 ∈ On ∣ ∃𝑦 ∈ (𝑅1‘𝑥) ¬ 𝑦 ∈ ran 𝑤} & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺‘((𝑅1‘𝑀) ∖ ran 𝑤)) & ⊢ 𝐹 = recs((𝑤 ∈ V ↦ 𝑁)) & ⊢ 𝐵 = ∩ {𝑢 ∈ On ∣ ∃𝑣 ∈ (𝑅1‘𝑢) ¬ 𝑣 ∈ (𝐹 “ 𝐴)} & ⊢ 𝐶 = (𝐺‘((𝑅1‘𝐵) ∖ (𝐹 “ 𝐴))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ On → (𝐹‘𝐴) = 𝐶) | ||
| 2-Dec-2025 | onvf1odlem2 35339 | Lemma for onvf1od 35342. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 2-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑧(𝑧 ≠ ∅ → (𝐺‘𝑧) ∈ 𝑧)) & ⊢ 𝑀 = ∩ {𝑥 ∈ On ∣ ∃𝑦 ∈ (𝑅1‘𝑥) ¬ 𝑦 ∈ 𝐴} & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺‘((𝑅1‘𝑀) ∖ 𝐴)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → 𝑁 ∈ ((𝑅1‘𝑀) ∖ 𝐴))) | ||
| 2-Dec-2025 | onvf1odlem1 35338 | Lemma for onvf1od 35342. (Contributed by BTernaryTau, 2-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 → ∃𝑥 ∈ On ∃𝑦 ∈ (𝑅1‘𝑥) ¬ 𝑦 ∈ 𝐴) | ||
| 1-Dec-2025 | sn-msqgt0d 42983 | A nonzero square is positive. (Contributed by SN, 1-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 0 < (𝐴 · 𝐴)) | ||
| 1-Dec-2025 | sn-mullt0d 42982 | The product of two negative numbers is positive. (Contributed by SN, 1-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 < 0) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 < 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 0 < (𝐴 · 𝐵)) | ||
| 1-Dec-2025 | elabgt 3617 | Membership in a class abstraction, using implicit substitution. (Closed theorem version of elabg 3621.) (Contributed by NM, 7-Nov-2005.) (Proof shortened by Andrew Salmon, 8-Jun-2011.) Reduce axiom usage. (Revised by GG, 12-Oct-2024.) (Proof shortened by Wolf Lammen, 11-May-2025.) (Proof shortened by SN, 1-Dec-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ ∀𝑥(𝑥 = 𝐴 → (𝜑 ↔ 𝜓))) → (𝐴 ∈ {𝑥 ∣ 𝜑} ↔ 𝜓)) | ||
| 30-Nov-2025 | eluz3nn 12837 | An integer greater than or equal to 3 is a positive integer. (Contributed by Alexander van der Vekens, 17-Sep-2018.) (Proof shortened by AV, 30-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘3) → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ) | ||
| 28-Nov-2025 | eqcuts3 27821 | A variant of the simplicity theorem - if 𝐵 lies between the cut sets of 𝐴 but none of its options do, then 𝐴 = 𝐵. Theorem 11 of [Conway] p. 23. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 28-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐿 <<s 𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀 <<s 𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 = (𝐿 |s 𝑅)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 = (𝑀 |s 𝑆)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐿 <<s {𝐵}) & ⊢ (𝜑 → {𝐵} <<s 𝑅) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∀𝑥𝑂 ∈ (𝑀 ∪ 𝑆) ¬ (𝐿 <<s {𝑥𝑂} ∧ {𝑥𝑂} <<s 𝑅)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 = 𝐵) | ||
| 27-Nov-2025 | difmodm1lt 47835 | The difference between an integer modulo a positive integer and the integer decreased by 1 modulo the same modulus is less than the modulus decreased by 1 (if the modulus is greater than 2). This theorem would not be valid for an odd 𝐴 and 𝑁 = 2, since ((𝐴 mod 𝑁) − ((𝐴 − 1) mod 𝑁)) would be (1 − 0) = 1 which is not less than (𝑁 − 1) = 1. (Contributed by AV, 6-Jun-2012.) (Proof shortened by SN, 27-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℤ ∧ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ ∧ 2 < 𝑁) → ((𝐴 mod 𝑁) − ((𝐴 − 1) mod 𝑁)) < (𝑁 − 1)) | ||
| 26-Nov-2025 | cmdlan 50169 | To each colimit of a diagram there is a corresponding left Kan extention of the diagram along a functor to a terminal category. The morphism parts coincide, while the object parts are one-to-one correspondent (diag1f1o 50031). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 26-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 1 ∈ TermCat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝐷 Func 1 )) & ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc 1 ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 = ((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑋)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋((𝐶 Colimit 𝐷)‘𝐹)𝑀 ↔ 𝑌(𝐺(〈𝐷, 1 〉 Lan 𝐶)𝐹)𝑀)) | ||
| 26-Nov-2025 | lmdran 50168 | To each limit of a diagram there is a corresponding right Kan extention of the diagram along a functor to a terminal category. The morphism parts coincide, while the object parts are one-to-one correspondent (diag1f1o 50031). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 26-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 1 ∈ TermCat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝐷 Func 1 )) & ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc 1 ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 = ((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑋)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋((𝐶 Limit 𝐷)‘𝐹)𝑀 ↔ 𝑌(𝐺(〈𝐷, 1 〉 Ran 𝐶)𝐹)𝑀)) | ||
| 26-Nov-2025 | ranval3 50128 | The set of right Kan extensions is the set of universal pairs. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 26-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘(𝐷 FuncCat 𝐸)) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘(𝐶 FuncCat 𝐸)) & ⊢ 𝐾 = (〈𝐷, 𝐸〉 −∘F 𝐹) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷) → (𝐹(〈𝐶, 𝐷〉 Ran 𝐸)𝑋) = (( oppFunc ‘𝐾)(𝑂 UP 𝑃)𝑋)) | ||
| 26-Nov-2025 | ffthoppf 49662 | The opposite functor of a fully faithful functor is also full and faithful. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 26-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ ((𝐶 Full 𝐷) ∩ (𝐶 Faith 𝐷))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) ∈ ((𝑂 Full 𝑃) ∩ (𝑂 Faith 𝑃))) | ||
| 26-Nov-2025 | fthoppf 49661 | The opposite functor of a faithful functor is also faithful. Proposition 3.43(c) in [Adamek] p. 39. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 26-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Faith 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) ∈ (𝑂 Faith 𝑃)) | ||
| 26-Nov-2025 | fulloppf 49660 | The opposite functor of a full functor is also full. Proposition 3.43(d) in [Adamek] p. 39. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 26-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Full 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) ∈ (𝑂 Full 𝑃)) | ||
| 26-Nov-2025 | cofuoppf 49647 | Composition of opposite functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 26-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐾) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (( oppFunc ‘𝐺) ∘func ( oppFunc ‘𝐹)) = ( oppFunc ‘𝐾)) | ||
| 26-Nov-2025 | mullt0b2d 42981 | When the second term is negative, the first term is positive iff the product is negative. (Contributed by SN, 26-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 < 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (0 < 𝐴 ↔ (𝐴 · 𝐵) < 0)) | ||
| 26-Nov-2025 | mullt0b1d 42980 | When the first term is negative, the second term is positive iff the product is negative. (Contributed by SN, 26-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 < 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (0 < 𝐵 ↔ (𝐴 · 𝐵) < 0)) | ||
| 26-Nov-2025 | mulltgt0d 42979 | Negative times positive is negative. (Contributed by SN, 26-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 < 0) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 0 < 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 · 𝐵) < 0) | ||
| 26-Nov-2025 | sn-reclt0d 42978 | The reciprocal of a negative real is negative. (Contributed by SN, 26-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 < 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (1 /ℝ 𝐴) < 0) | ||
| 26-Nov-2025 | sn-recgt0d 42974 | The reciprocal of a positive real is positive. (Contributed by SN, 26-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 0 < 𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 0 < (1 /ℝ 𝐴)) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | prcofdiag 49891 | A diagonal functor post-composed by a pre-composition functor is another diagonal functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐸) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐸 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐷, 𝐶〉 −∘F 𝐹) = 𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 ∘func 𝐿) = 𝑀) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | prcofdiag1 49890 | A constant functor pre-composed by a functor is another constant functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐸) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐸 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑋) ∘func 𝐹) = ((1st ‘𝑀)‘𝑋)) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | uptr2a 49719 | Universal property and fully faithful functor surjective on objects. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 = ((1st ‘𝐾)‘𝑋)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 ∘func 𝐾) = 𝐹) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ ((𝐶 Full 𝐷) ∩ (𝐶 Faith 𝐷))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (1st ‘𝐾):𝐴–onto→𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋(𝐹(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑍)𝑀 ↔ 𝑌(𝐺(𝐷 UP 𝐸)𝑍)𝑀)) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | uptr2 49718 | Universal property and fully faithful functor surjective on objects. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 = (𝑅‘𝑋)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅:𝐴–onto→𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅((𝐶 Full 𝐷) ∩ (𝐶 Faith 𝐷))𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐾, 𝐿〉 ∘func 〈𝑅, 𝑆〉) = 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾(𝐷 Func 𝐸)𝐿) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋(〈𝐹, 𝐺〉(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑍)𝑀 ↔ 𝑌(〈𝐾, 𝐿〉(𝐷 UP 𝐸)𝑍)𝑀)) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | xpco2 49354 | Composition of a Cartesian product with a function. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐹:𝐴⟶𝐵 → ((𝐵 × 𝐶) ∘ 𝐹) = (𝐴 × 𝐶)) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | ffvbr 49353 | Relation with function value. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐹:𝐴⟶𝐵 ∧ 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) → 𝑋𝐹(𝐹‘𝑋)) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | rerecid2d 42942 | Multiplication of a number and its reciprocal. (Contributed by SN, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1 /ℝ 𝐴) · 𝐴) = 1) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | rerecidd 42941 | Multiplication of a number and its reciprocal. (Contributed by SN, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 · (1 /ℝ 𝐴)) = 1) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | sn-rereccld 42939 | Closure law for reciprocal. (Contributed by SN, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (1 /ℝ 𝐴) ∈ ℝ) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | rediveq0d 42933 | A ratio is zero iff the numerator is zero. (Contributed by SN, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 /ℝ 𝐵) = 0 ↔ 𝐴 = 0)) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | redivcan3d 42932 | A cancellation law for division. (Contributed by SN, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐵 · 𝐴) /ℝ 𝐵) = 𝐴) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | redivcan2d 42931 | A cancellation law for division. (Contributed by SN, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐵 · (𝐴 /ℝ 𝐵)) = 𝐴) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | redivmuld 42929 | Relationship between division and multiplication. (Contributed by SN, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 /ℝ 𝐶) = 𝐵 ↔ (𝐶 · 𝐵) = 𝐴)) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | sn-redivcld 42928 | Closure law for real division. (Contributed by SN, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 /ℝ 𝐵) ∈ ℝ) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | rediveud 42927 | Existential uniqueness of real quotients. (Contributed by SN, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ∃!𝑥 ∈ ℝ (𝐵 · 𝑥) = 𝐴) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | redivvald 42926 | Value of real division, which is the (unique) real 𝑥 such that (𝐵 · 𝑥) = 𝐴. (Contributed by SN, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ≠ 0) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 /ℝ 𝐵) = (℩𝑥 ∈ ℝ (𝐵 · 𝑥) = 𝐴)) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | df-rediv 42925 | Define division between real numbers. This operator saves ax-mulcom 11100 over df-div 11806 in certain situations. (Contributed by SN, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ /ℝ = (𝑥 ∈ ℝ, 𝑦 ∈ (ℝ ∖ {0}) ↦ (℩𝑧 ∈ ℝ (𝑦 · 𝑧) = 𝑥)) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | uniqsw 8718 | The union of a quotient set. More restrictive antecedent; kept for backward compatibility; for new work, prefer uniqs 8717. (Contributed by NM, 9-Dec-2008.) (Proof shortened by AV, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ 𝑉 → ∪ (𝐴 / 𝑅) = (𝑅 “ 𝐴)) | ||
| 25-Nov-2025 | ecelqsw 8712 | Membership of an equivalence class in a quotient set. More restrictive antecedent; kept for backward compatibility; for new work, prefer ecelqs 8711. (Contributed by Jeff Madsen, 10-Jun-2010.) (Revised by Mario Carneiro, 9-Jul-2014.) (Proof shortened by AV, 25-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑅 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝐴) → [𝐵]𝑅 ∈ (𝐴 / 𝑅)) | ||
| 24-Nov-2025 | f1omo 49390 | There is at most one element in the function value of a constant function whose output is 1o. (An artifact of our function value definition.) Proof could be significantly shortened by fvconstdomi 49389 assuming ax-un 7685 (see f1omoALT 49392). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Sep-2024.) (Proof shortened by SN, 24-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = (𝐴 × {1o})) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ∃*𝑦 𝑦 ∈ (𝐹‘𝑋)) | ||
| 24-Nov-2025 | mulgt0b2d 42975 | Biconditional, deductive form of mulgt0 11221. The first factor is positive iff the product is. (Contributed by SN, 24-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 0 < 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (0 < 𝐴 ↔ 0 < (𝐴 · 𝐵))) | ||
| 24-Nov-2025 | sn-remul0ord 42892 | A product is zero iff one of its factors are zero. (Contributed by SN, 24-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℝ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 · 𝐵) = 0 ↔ (𝐴 = 0 ∨ 𝐵 = 0))) | ||
| 23-Nov-2025 | lgricngricex 48627 | There are two different locally isomorphic graphs which are not isomorphic. (Contributed by AV, 23-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ∃𝑔∃ℎ(𝑔 ≃𝑙𝑔𝑟 ℎ ∧ ¬ 𝑔 ≃𝑔𝑟 ℎ) | ||
| 23-Nov-2025 | dmqsblocks 39341 | If the pet 39339 span (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) partitions 𝐴, then every block 𝑢 ∈ 𝐴 is of the form [𝑣] for some 𝑣 that not only lies in the domain but also has at least one internal element 𝑐 and at least one 𝑅-target 𝑏 (cf. also the comments of qseq 39107). It makes explicit that pet 39339 gives active representatives for each block, without ever forcing 𝑣 = 𝑢. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 23-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((dom (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) / (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴))) = 𝐴 → ∀𝑢 ∈ 𝐴 ∃𝑣 ∈ dom (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴))∃𝑏∃𝑐(𝑢 = [𝑣](𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) ∧ 𝑐 ∈ 𝑣 ∧ 𝑣𝑅𝑏)) | ||
| 23-Nov-2025 | eceldmqsxrncnvepres2 38811 | An (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴))-coset in its domain quotient. In the pet 39339 span (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)), a block [ B ] lies in the domain quotient exactly when its representative 𝐵 belongs to 𝐴 and actually fires at least one arrow (has some 𝑥 ∈ 𝐵 and some 𝑦 with 𝐵𝑅𝑦). (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 23-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝑊 ∧ 𝑅 ∈ 𝑋) → ([𝐵](𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) ∈ (dom (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) / (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴))) ↔ (𝐵 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ ∃𝑥 𝑥 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ ∃𝑦 𝐵𝑅𝑦))) | ||
| 23-Nov-2025 | eceldmqsxrncnvepres 38810 | An (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴))-coset in its domain quotient. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 23-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝑊 ∧ 𝑅 ∈ 𝑋) → ([𝐵](𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) ∈ (dom (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) / (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴))) ↔ (𝐵 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ 𝐵 ≠ ∅ ∧ [𝐵]𝑅 ≠ ∅))) | ||
| 23-Nov-2025 | eldmxrncnvepres2 38809 | Element of the domain of the range product with restricted converse epsilon relation. This identifies the domain of the pet 39339 span (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)): a 𝐵 belongs to the domain of the span exactly when 𝐵 is in 𝐴 and has at least one 𝑥 ∈ 𝐵 and 𝑦 with 𝐵𝑅𝑦. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 23-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐵 ∈ 𝑉 → (𝐵 ∈ dom (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) ↔ (𝐵 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ ∃𝑥 𝑥 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ ∃𝑦 𝐵𝑅𝑦))) | ||
| 23-Nov-2025 | eldmxrncnvepres 38808 | Element of the domain of the range product with restricted converse epsilon relation. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 23-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐵 ∈ 𝑉 → (𝐵 ∈ dom (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) ↔ (𝐵 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ 𝐵 ≠ ∅ ∧ [𝐵]𝑅 ≠ ∅))) | ||
| 23-Nov-2025 | dmxrncnvepres 38806 | Domain of the range product with restricted converse epsilon relation. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 23-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ dom (𝑅 ⋉ (◡ E ↾ 𝐴)) = (dom (𝑅 ↾ 𝐴) ∖ {∅}) | ||
| 23-Nov-2025 | dmxrncnvep 38763 | Domain of the range product with converse epsilon relation. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 23-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ dom (𝑅 ⋉ ◡ E ) = (dom 𝑅 ∖ {∅}) | ||
| 23-Nov-2025 | dmcnvep 38762 | Domain of converse epsilon relation. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 30-Jan-2018.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 23-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ dom ◡ E = (V ∖ {∅}) | ||
| 23-Nov-2025 | eldmres3 38657 | Elementhood in the domain of a restriction. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 23-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐵 ∈ 𝑉 → (𝐵 ∈ dom (𝑅 ↾ 𝐴) ↔ (𝐵 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ [𝐵]𝑅 ≠ ∅))) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | gpg5ngric 48626 | The two generalized Petersen graphs G(5,K) of order 10, which are the Petersen graph G(5,2) and the 5-prism G(5,1), are not isomorphic. (Contributed by AV, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ¬ (5 gPetersenGr 1) ≃𝑔𝑟 (5 gPetersenGr 2) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | pg4cyclnex 48625 | In the Petersen graph G(5,2), there is no cycle of length 4. (Contributed by AV, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ¬ ∃𝑝∃𝑓(𝑓(Cycles‘(5 gPetersenGr 2))𝑝 ∧ (♯‘𝑓) = 4) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | gpg5grlic 48592 | The two generalized Petersen graphs G(N,K) of order 10 (𝑁 = 5), which are the Petersen graph G(5,2) and the 5-prism G(5,1), are locally isomorphic. (Contributed by AV, 29-Sep-2025.) (Proof shortened by AV, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (5 gPetersenGr 1) ≃𝑙𝑔𝑟 (5 gPetersenGr 2) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | gpg3nbgrvtx1 48576 | In a generalized Petersen graph 𝐺, every inside vertex has exactly three (different) neighbors. (Contributed by AV, 3-Sep-2025.) (Proof shortened by AV, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐽 = (1..^(⌈‘(𝑁 / 2))) & ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝑁 gPetersenGr 𝐾) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑈 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ (((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘3) ∧ 𝐾 ∈ 𝐽) ∧ (𝑋 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ (1st ‘𝑋) = 1)) → (♯‘𝑈) = 3) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | modm1nem2 47845 | A nonnegative integer less than a modulus greater than 4 minus one/minus two are not equal modulo the modulus. (Contributed by AV, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (0..^𝑁) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘5) ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) → ((𝑌 − 1) mod 𝑁) ≠ ((𝑌 − 2) mod 𝑁)) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | modm1nep2 47844 | A nonnegative integer less than a modulus greater than 4 plus one/minus two are not equal modulo the modulus. (Contributed by AV, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (0..^𝑁) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘5) ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) → ((𝑌 − 1) mod 𝑁) ≠ ((𝑌 + 2) mod 𝑁)) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | modp2nep1 47843 | A nonnegative integer less than a modulus greater than 4 plus one/plus two are not equal modulo the modulus. (Contributed by AV, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (0..^𝑁) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘5) ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) → ((𝑌 + 2) mod 𝑁) ≠ ((𝑌 + 1) mod 𝑁)) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | modm2nep1 47842 | A nonnegative integer less than a modulus greater than 4 plus one/minus two are not equal modulo the modulus. (Contributed by AV, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (0..^𝑁) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘5) ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) → ((𝑌 − 2) mod 𝑁) ≠ ((𝑌 + 1) mod 𝑁)) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | dmxrn 38761 | Domain of the range product. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 19-Apr-2020.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ dom (𝑅 ⋉ 𝑆) = (dom 𝑅 ∩ dom 𝑆) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | brxrncnvep 38760 | The range product with converse epsilon relation. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 22-Jun-2020.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝑊 ∧ 𝐶 ∈ 𝑋) → (𝐴(𝑅 ⋉ ◡ E )〈𝐵, 𝐶〉 ↔ (𝐶 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ 𝐴𝑅𝐵))) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | bdayle 27933 | A condition for bounding a birthday above. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑋 ∈ No ∧ Ord 𝑂) → (( bday ‘𝑋) ⊆ 𝑂 ↔ ∀𝑦 ∈ ( O ‘( bday ‘𝑋))( bday ‘𝑦) ∈ 𝑂)) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | bdayiun 27932 | The birthday of a surreal is the least upper bound of the successors of the birthdays of its options. This is the definition of the birthday of a combinatorial game in the Lean Combinatorial Game Theory library at https://github.com/vihdzp/combinatorial-games. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ No → ( bday ‘𝐴) = ∪ 𝑥 ∈ ( O ‘( bday ‘𝐴))suc ( bday ‘𝑥)) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | nn0absidi 15391 | A nonnegative integer is its own absolute value (inference form). (Contributed by AV, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0 ⇒ ⊢ (abs‘𝑁) = 𝑁 | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | nn0absid 15390 | A nonnegative integer is its own absolute value. (Contributed by AV, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ ℕ0 → (abs‘𝑁) = 𝑁) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | eluz5nn 12839 | An integer greater than or equal to 5 is a positive integer. (Contributed by AV, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘5) → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | eceldmqs 8731 | 𝑅-coset in its domain quotient. This is the bridge between 𝐴 in the domain and its block [𝐴]𝑅 in its domain quotient. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 17-Apr-2019.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝑅 ∈ 𝑉 → ([𝐴]𝑅 ∈ (dom 𝑅 / 𝑅) ↔ 𝐴 ∈ dom 𝑅)) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | ecelqsdmb 8730 | 𝑅-coset of 𝐵 in a quotient set, biconditional version. (Contributed by Peter Mazsa, 17-Apr-2019.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (((𝑅 ↾ 𝐴) ∈ 𝑉 ∧ dom 𝑅 = 𝐴) → ([𝐵]𝑅 ∈ (𝐴 / 𝑅) ↔ 𝐵 ∈ 𝐴)) | ||
| 22-Nov-2025 | ecelqs 8711 | Membership of an equivalence class in a quotient set. (Contributed by Jeff Madsen, 10-Jun-2010.) (Revised by Mario Carneiro, 9-Jul-2014.) (Revised by Peter Mazsa, 22-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (((𝑅 ↾ 𝐴) ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝐵 ∈ 𝐴) → [𝐵]𝑅 ∈ (𝐴 / 𝑅)) | ||
| 21-Nov-2025 | ranpropd 50113 | If the categories have the same set of objects, morphisms, and compositions, then they have the same right Kan extensions. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 21-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐴) = (Homf ‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐴) = (compf‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐶) = (Homf ‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐶) = (compf‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐸) = (Homf ‘𝐹)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐸) = (compf‘𝐹)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐴, 𝐶〉 Ran 𝐸) = (〈𝐵, 𝐷〉 Ran 𝐹)) | ||
| 21-Nov-2025 | lanpropd 50112 | If the categories have the same set of objects, morphisms, and compositions, then they have the same left Kan extensions. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 21-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐴) = (Homf ‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐴) = (compf‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐶) = (Homf ‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐶) = (compf‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐸) = (Homf ‘𝐹)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐸) = (compf‘𝐹)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐴, 𝐶〉 Lan 𝐸) = (〈𝐵, 𝐷〉 Lan 𝐹)) | ||
| 21-Nov-2025 | prcofpropd 49876 | If the categories have the same set of objects, morphisms, and compositions, then they have the same pre-composition functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 21-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐴) = (Homf ‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐴) = (compf‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐶) = (Homf ‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐶) = (compf‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐴, 𝐶〉 −∘F 𝐹) = (〈𝐵, 𝐷〉 −∘F 𝐹)) | ||
| 21-Nov-2025 | pgnbgreunbgrlem5 48621 | Lemma 5 for pgnbgreunbgr 48623. Impossible cases. (Contributed by AV, 21-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐿 = 〈0, (((2nd ‘𝑋) + 1) mod 5)〉 ∨ 𝐿 = 〈1, (2nd ‘𝑋)〉 ∨ 𝐿 = 〈0, (((2nd ‘𝑋) − 1) mod 5)〉) → ((𝐾 = 〈0, (((2nd ‘𝑋) + 1) mod 5)〉 ∨ 𝐾 = 〈1, (2nd ‘𝑋)〉 ∨ 𝐾 = 〈0, (((2nd ‘𝑋) − 1) mod 5)〉) → ((𝑋 = 〈0, 𝑦〉 ∧ 𝑋 ∈ 𝑉) → ((𝐾 ≠ 𝐿 ∧ (𝑏 ∈ (0..^5) ∧ 𝑦 ∈ (0..^5))) → (({𝐾, 〈1, 𝑏〉} ∈ 𝐸 ∧ {〈1, 𝑏〉, 𝐿} ∈ 𝐸) → 𝑋 = 〈1, 𝑏〉))))) | ||
| 21-Nov-2025 | pgnbgreunbgrlem5lem1 48618 | Lemma 1 for pgnbgreunbgrlem5 48621. (Contributed by AV, 21-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ ((((𝐿 = 〈0, ((𝑦 + 1) mod 5)〉 ∧ 𝐾 = 〈1, 𝑦〉) ∧ (𝑏 ∈ (0..^5) ∧ 𝑦 ∈ (0..^5))) ∧ {𝐾, 〈1, 𝑏〉} ∈ 𝐸) → ¬ {〈1, 𝑏〉, 𝐿} ∈ 𝐸) | ||
| 21-Nov-2025 | pgnioedg5 48610 | An inside and an outside vertex not adjacent in a Petersen graph. (Contributed by AV, 21-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝑦 ∈ (0..^5) → ¬ {〈1, ((𝑦 − 1) mod 5)〉, 〈0, ((𝑦 + 1) mod 5)〉} ∈ 𝐸) | ||
| 21-Nov-2025 | pgnioedg4 48609 | An inside and an outside vertex not adjacent in a Petersen graph. (Contributed by AV, 21-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝑦 ∈ (0..^5) → ¬ {〈1, ((𝑦 − 2) mod 5)〉, 〈0, ((𝑦 − 1) mod 5)〉} ∈ 𝐸) | ||
| 21-Nov-2025 | pgnioedg3 48608 | An inside and an outside vertex not adjacent in a Petersen graph. (Contributed by AV, 21-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝑦 ∈ (0..^5) → ¬ {〈1, ((𝑦 + 2) mod 5)〉, 〈0, ((𝑦 − 1) mod 5)〉} ∈ 𝐸) | ||
| 21-Nov-2025 | pgnioedg2 48607 | An inside and an outside vertex not adjacent in a Petersen graph. (Contributed by AV, 21-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝑦 ∈ (0..^5) → ¬ {〈1, ((𝑦 + 2) mod 5)〉, 〈0, ((𝑦 + 1) mod 5)〉} ∈ 𝐸) | ||
| 21-Nov-2025 | pgnioedg1 48606 | An inside and an outside vertex not adjacent in a Petersen graph. (Contributed by AV, 21-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝑦 ∈ (0..^5) → ¬ {〈1, ((𝑦 − 2) mod 5)〉, 〈0, ((𝑦 + 1) mod 5)〉} ∈ 𝐸) | ||
| 21-Nov-2025 | modlt0b 47839 | An integer with an absolute value less than a positive integer is 0 modulo the positive integer iff it is 0. (Contributed by AV, 21-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ ℕ ∧ 𝑋 ∈ ℤ ∧ (abs‘𝑋) < 𝑁) → ((𝑋 mod 𝑁) = 0 ↔ 𝑋 = 0)) | ||
| 21-Nov-2025 | zabs0b 15274 | An integer has an absolute value less than 1 iff it is 0. (Contributed by AV, 21-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝑋 ∈ ℤ → ((abs‘𝑋) < 1 ↔ 𝑋 = 0)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | termolmd 50167 | Terminal objects are the object part of limits of the empty diagram. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (TermO‘𝐶) = dom (∅(𝐶 Limit ∅)∅) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | cmddu 50165 | The duality of limits and colimits: colimits of a diagram are limits of an opposite diagram in opposite categories. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐺 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐶 Colimit 𝐷)‘𝐹) = ((𝑂 Limit 𝑃)‘𝐺)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | lmddu 50164 | The duality of limits and colimits: limits of a diagram are colimits of an opposite diagram in opposite categories. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐺 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐶 Limit 𝐷)‘𝐹) = ((𝑂 Colimit 𝑃)‘𝐺)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | cmdpropd 50155 | If the categories have the same set of objects, morphisms, and compositions, then they have the same colimits. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐴) = (Homf ‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐴) = (compf‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐶) = (Homf ‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐶) = (compf‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 Colimit 𝐶) = (𝐵 Colimit 𝐷)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | lmdpropd 50154 | If the categories have the same set of objects, morphisms, and compositions, then they have the same limits. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐴) = (Homf ‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐴) = (compf‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐶) = (Homf ‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐶) = (compf‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 Limit 𝐶) = (𝐵 Limit 𝐷)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | cmdrcl 50149 | Reverse closure for a colimit of a diagram. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝑋 ∈ ((𝐶 Colimit 𝐷)‘𝐹) → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐶)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | lmdrcl 50148 | Reverse closure for a limit of a diagram. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝑋 ∈ ((𝐶 Limit 𝐷)‘𝐹) → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐶)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | diagpropd 49789 | If two categories have the same set of objects, morphisms, and compositions, then they have same diagonal functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐴) = (Homf ‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐴) = (compf‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐶) = (Homf ‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐶) = (compf‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ Cat) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴Δfunc𝐶) = (𝐵Δfunc𝐷)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | 2ndfpropd 49788 | If two categories have the same set of objects, morphisms, and compositions, then they have same second projection functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐴) = (Homf ‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐴) = (compf‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐶) = (Homf ‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐶) = (compf‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ Cat) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 2ndF 𝐶) = (𝐵 2ndF 𝐷)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | 1stfpropd 49787 | If two categories have the same set of objects, morphisms, and compositions, then they have same first projection functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐴) = (Homf ‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐴) = (compf‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐶) = (Homf ‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐶) = (compf‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ Cat) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 1stF 𝐶) = (𝐵 1stF 𝐷)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | uppropd 49678 | If two categories have the same set of objects, morphisms, and compositions, then they have the same universal pairs. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐴) = (Homf ‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐴) = (compf‘𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (Homf ‘𝐶) = (Homf ‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐶) = (compf‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 UP 𝐶) = (𝐵 UP 𝐷)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | reueqbidva 49303 | Formula-building rule for restricted existential uniqueness quantifier. Deduction form. General version of reueqbidv 3381. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 = 𝐵) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑥 ∈ 𝐴) → (𝜓 ↔ 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∃!𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 𝜓 ↔ ∃!𝑥 ∈ 𝐵 𝜒)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | pgnbgreunbgrlem6 48622 | Lemma 6 for pgnbgreunbgr 48623. (Contributed by AV, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ (((𝐾 ∈ 𝑁 ∧ 𝐿 ∈ 𝑁 ∧ 𝐾 ≠ 𝐿) ∧ 𝑏 ∈ (0..^5)) → (({𝐾, 〈1, 𝑏〉} ∈ 𝐸 ∧ {〈1, 𝑏〉, 𝐿} ∈ 𝐸) → 𝑋 = 〈1, 𝑏〉)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | pgnbgreunbgrlem5lem3 48620 | Lemma 3 for pgnbgreunbgrlem5 48621. (Contributed by AV, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ ((((𝐿 = 〈0, ((𝑦 + 1) mod 5)〉 ∧ 𝐾 = 〈0, ((𝑦 − 1) mod 5)〉) ∧ (𝑏 ∈ (0..^5) ∧ 𝑦 ∈ (0..^5))) ∧ {𝐾, 〈1, 𝑏〉} ∈ 𝐸) → ¬ {〈1, 𝑏〉, 𝐿} ∈ 𝐸) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | pgnbgreunbgrlem5lem2 48619 | Lemma 2 for pgnbgreunbgrlem5 48621. (Contributed by AV, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ ((((𝐿 = 〈0, ((𝑦 − 1) mod 5)〉 ∧ 𝐾 = 〈1, 𝑦〉) ∧ (𝑏 ∈ (0..^5) ∧ 𝑦 ∈ (0..^5))) ∧ {𝐾, 〈1, 𝑏〉} ∈ 𝐸) → ¬ {〈1, 𝑏〉, 𝐿} ∈ 𝐸) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | pgnbgreunbgrlem4 48617 | Lemma 4 for pgnbgreunbgr 48623. (Contributed by AV, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐿 = 〈1, (((2nd ‘𝑋) + 2) mod 5)〉 ∨ 𝐿 = 〈0, (2nd ‘𝑋)〉 ∨ 𝐿 = 〈1, (((2nd ‘𝑋) − 2) mod 5)〉) → ((𝐾 = 〈1, (((2nd ‘𝑋) + 2) mod 5)〉 ∨ 𝐾 = 〈0, (2nd ‘𝑋)〉 ∨ 𝐾 = 〈1, (((2nd ‘𝑋) − 2) mod 5)〉) → ((𝑋 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝑋 = 〈1, 𝑦〉) → ((𝐾 ≠ 𝐿 ∧ (𝑏 ∈ (0..^5) ∧ 𝑦 ∈ (0..^5))) → (({𝐾, 〈1, 𝑏〉} ∈ 𝐸 ∧ {〈1, 𝑏〉, 𝐿} ∈ 𝐸) → 𝑋 = 〈1, 𝑏〉))))) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | gpgedg2iv 48565 | The edges of the generalized Petersen graph GPG(N,K) between two inside vertices. (Contributed by AV, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐽 = (1..^(⌈‘(𝑁 / 2))) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (0..^𝑁) & ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝑁 gPetersenGr 𝐾) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘5) ∧ (𝑋 ∈ 𝐼 ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) ∧ (𝐾 ∈ 𝐽 ∧ ((4 · 𝐾) mod 𝑁) ≠ 0)) → (({〈1, ((𝑌 − 𝐾) mod 𝑁)〉, 〈1, 𝑋〉} ∈ 𝐸 ∧ {〈1, 𝑋〉, 〈1, ((𝑌 + 𝐾) mod 𝑁)〉} ∈ 𝐸) ↔ 𝑋 = 𝑌)) | ||
| 20-Nov-2025 | 8mod5e3 47836 | 8 modulo 5 is 3. (Contributed by AV, 20-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (8 mod 5) = 3 | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | oppfdiag 49913 | A diagonal functor for opposite categories is the opposite functor of the diagonal functor for original categories post-composed by an isomorphism (fucoppc 49907). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = ( oppFunc ↾ (𝐷 Func 𝐶))) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐷 Nat 𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 = (𝑚 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐶), 𝑛 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐶) ↦ ( I ↾ (𝑛𝑁𝑚)))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐹, 𝐺〉 ∘func ( oppFunc ‘𝐿)) = (𝑂Δfunc𝑃)) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | oppfdiag1a 49912 | A constant functor for opposite categories is the opposite functor of the constant functor for original categories. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ‘((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑋)) = ((1st ‘(𝑂Δfunc𝑃))‘𝑋)) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | oppfdiag1 49911 | A constant functor for opposite categories is the opposite functor of the constant functor for original categories. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = ( oppFunc ↾ (𝐷 Func 𝐶))) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐹‘((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑋)) = ((1st ‘(𝑂Δfunc𝑃))‘𝑋)) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | fucoppcfunc 49909 | A functor from the opposite category of functors to the category of opposite functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐶 FuncCat 𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑅 = (oppCat‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝑆 = (𝑂 FuncCat 𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐶 Nat 𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = ( oppFunc ↾ (𝐶 Func 𝐷))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 = (𝑥 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷), 𝑦 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷) ↦ ( I ↾ (𝑦𝑁𝑥)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ Cat) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝑅 Func 𝑆)𝐺) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | fucoppcffth 49908 | A fully faithful functor from the opposite category of functors to the category of opposite functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐶 FuncCat 𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑅 = (oppCat‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝑆 = (𝑂 FuncCat 𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐶 Nat 𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = ( oppFunc ↾ (𝐶 Func 𝐷))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 = (𝑥 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷), 𝑦 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷) ↦ ( I ↾ (𝑦𝑁𝑥)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ Cat) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹((𝑅 Full 𝑆) ∩ (𝑅 Faith 𝑆))𝐺) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | opf12 49901 | The object part of the op functor on functor categories. Lemma for oppfdiag 49913. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = ( oppFunc ↾ (𝐶 Func 𝐷))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑀(2nd ‘(𝐹‘𝑋))𝑁) = (𝑁(2nd ‘𝑋)𝑀)) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | oppc2ndf 49786 | The opposite functor of the second projection functor is the second projection functor of opposite categories. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ‘(𝐶 2ndF 𝐷)) = (𝑂 2ndF 𝑃)) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | oppc1stf 49785 | The opposite functor of the first projection functor is the first projection functor of opposite categories. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ‘(𝐶 1stF 𝐷)) = (𝑂 1stF 𝑃)) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | oppc1stflem 49784 | A utility theorem for proving theorems on projection functors of opposite categories. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ (𝐶 ∈ Cat ∧ 𝐷 ∈ Cat)) → ( oppFunc ‘(𝐶𝐹𝐷)) = (𝑂𝐹𝑃)) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑐 ∈ Cat, 𝑑 ∈ Cat ↦ 𝑌) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ‘(𝐶𝐹𝐷)) = (𝑂𝐹𝑃)) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | uobffth 49715 | A fully faithful functor generates equal sets of universal objects. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐾 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1st ‘𝐾)‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ ((𝐷 Full 𝐸) ∩ (𝐷 Faith 𝐸))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → dom (𝐹(𝐶 UP 𝐷)𝑋) = dom (𝐺(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑌)) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | oppf2 49637 | Value of the morphism part of the opposite functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑀(2nd ‘( oppFunc ‘𝐹))𝑁) = (𝑁(2nd ‘𝐹)𝑀)) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | oppf1 49636 | Value of the object part of the opposite functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (1st ‘( oppFunc ‘𝐹)) = (1st ‘𝐹)) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | oppfval3 49635 | Value of the opposite functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = 〈𝐺, 𝐾〉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) = 〈𝐺, tpos 𝐾〉) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | eqfnovd 49363 | Deduction for equality of operations. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 Fn (𝐴 × 𝐵)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 Fn (𝐴 × 𝐵)) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ (𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵)) → (𝑥𝐹𝑦) = (𝑥𝐺𝑦)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = 𝐺) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | cos4t3rdpi 42840 | The cosine of 4 · (π / 3) is -1 / 2. (Contributed by SN, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (cos‘(4 · (π / 3))) = -(1 / 2) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | sin4t3rdpi 42839 | The sine of 4 · (π / 3) is -(√3) / 2. (Contributed by SN, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (sin‘(4 · (π / 3))) = -((√‘3) / 2) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | cos2t3rdpi 42838 | The cosine of 2 · (π / 3) is -1 / 2. (Contributed by SN, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (cos‘(2 · (π / 3))) = -(1 / 2) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | sin2t3rdpi 42837 | The sine of 2 · (π / 3) is (√3) / 2. (Contributed by SN, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (sin‘(2 · (π / 3))) = ((√‘3) / 2) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | cospim 42835 | Cosine of a number subtracted from π. (Contributed by SN, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℂ → (cos‘(π − 𝐴)) = -(cos‘𝐴)) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | sinpim 42834 | Sine of a number subtracted from π. (Contributed by SN, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℂ → (sin‘(π − 𝐴)) = (sin‘𝐴)) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | 3rdpwhole 42776 | A third of a number plus the number is four thirds of the number. (Contributed by SN, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℂ → ((𝐴 / 3) + 𝐴) = (4 · (𝐴 / 3))) | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | 1p3e4 42749 | 1 + 3 = 4. (Contributed by SN, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (1 + 3) = 4 | ||
| 19-Nov-2025 | spsv 1994 | Generalization of antecedent. A trivial weak version of sps 2197 avoiding ax-12 2189. (Contributed by SN, 13-Nov-2025.) (Proof shortened by WL, 19-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝜓) ⇒ ⊢ (∀𝑥𝜑 → 𝜓) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fucoppccic 49910 | The opposite category of functors is isomorphic to the category of opposite functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐶 = (CatCat‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑋 = (oppCat‘(𝐷 FuncCat 𝐸)) & ⊢ 𝑌 = ((oppCat‘𝐷) FuncCat (oppCat‘𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 ∈ 𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋( ≃𝑐 ‘𝐶)𝑌) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fucoppc 49907 | The isomorphism from the opposite category of functors to the category of opposite functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐶 FuncCat 𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑅 = (oppCat‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝑆 = (𝑂 FuncCat 𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐶 Nat 𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = ( oppFunc ↾ (𝐶 Func 𝐷))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 = (𝑥 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷), 𝑦 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷) ↦ ( I ↾ (𝑦𝑁𝑥)))) & ⊢ 𝑇 = (CatCat‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑇) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Iso‘𝑇) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑆 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝑅𝐼𝑆)𝐺) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fucoppcco 49906 | The opposite category of functors is compatible with the category of opposite functors in terms of composition. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐶 FuncCat 𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑅 = (oppCat‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝑆 = (𝑂 FuncCat 𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐶 Nat 𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = ( oppFunc ↾ (𝐶 Func 𝐷))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 = (𝑥 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷), 𝑦 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷) ↦ ( I ↾ (𝑦𝑁𝑥)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝑋(Hom ‘𝑅)𝑌)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ (𝑌(Hom ‘𝑅)𝑍)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋𝐺𝑍)‘(𝐵(〈𝑋, 𝑌〉(comp‘𝑅)𝑍)𝐴)) = (((𝑌𝐺𝑍)‘𝐵)(〈(𝐹‘𝑋), (𝐹‘𝑌)〉(comp‘𝑆)(𝐹‘𝑍))((𝑋𝐺𝑌)‘𝐴))) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fucoppcid 49905 | The opposite category of functors is compatible with the category of opposite functors in terms of identity morphism. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐶 FuncCat 𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑅 = (oppCat‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝑆 = (𝑂 FuncCat 𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐶 Nat 𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = ( oppFunc ↾ (𝐶 Func 𝐷))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 = (𝑥 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷), 𝑦 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷) ↦ ( I ↾ (𝑦𝑁𝑥)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋𝐺𝑋)‘((Id‘𝑅)‘𝑋)) = ((Id‘𝑆)‘(𝐹‘𝑋))) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fucoppclem 49904 | Lemma for fucoppc 49907. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐶 Nat 𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = ( oppFunc ↾ (𝐶 Func 𝐷))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑌𝑁𝑋) = ((𝐹‘𝑋)(𝑂 Nat 𝑃)(𝐹‘𝑌))) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | opf2 49903 | The morphism part of the op functor on functor categories. Lemma for fucoppc 49907. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = (𝑥 ∈ 𝐴, 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ ( I ↾ (𝑦𝑁𝑥)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 = 𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ (𝑌𝑁𝑋)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋𝐹𝑌)‘𝐶) = 𝐷) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | opf2fval 49902 | The morphism part of the op functor on functor categories. Lemma for fucoppc 49907. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = (𝑥 ∈ 𝐴, 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ ( I ↾ (𝑦𝑁𝑥)))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋𝐹𝑌) = ( I ↾ (𝑌𝑁𝑋))) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | opf11 49900 | The object part of the op functor on functor categories. Lemma for fucoppc 49907. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = ( oppFunc ↾ (𝐶 Func 𝐷))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (1st ‘(𝐹‘𝑋)) = (1st ‘𝑋)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | natoppfb 49728 | A natural transformation is natural between opposite functors, and vice versa. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐶 Nat 𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (𝑂 Nat 𝑃) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐹)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐿 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐺)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐹𝑁𝐺) = (𝐿𝑀𝐾)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | natoppf2 49727 | A natural transformation is natural between opposite functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐶 Nat 𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (𝑂 Nat 𝑃) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐹)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐿 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐺)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝐹𝑁𝐺)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝐿𝑀𝐾)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | natoppf 49726 | A natural transformation is natural between opposite functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐶 Nat 𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (𝑂 Nat 𝑃) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (〈𝐹, 𝐺〉𝑁〈𝐾, 𝐿〉)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (〈𝐾, tpos 𝐿〉𝑀〈𝐹, tpos 𝐺〉)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | eloppf2 49631 | Both components of a pre-image of a non-empty opposite functor exist; and the second component is a relation on triples. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐹 oppFunc 𝐺) = 𝐾 & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐾) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐹 ∈ V ∧ 𝐺 ∈ V) ∧ (Rel 𝐺 ∧ Rel dom 𝐺))) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | eloppf 49630 | The pre-image of a non-empty opposite functor is non-empty; and the second component of the pre-image is a relation on triples. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐹 ≠ ∅ ∧ (Rel (2nd ‘𝐹) ∧ Rel dom (2nd ‘𝐹)))) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | pgnbgreunbgrlem3 48616 | Lemma 3 for pgnbgreunbgr 48623. (Contributed by AV, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ (((𝐾 ∈ 𝑁 ∧ 𝐿 ∈ 𝑁 ∧ 𝐾 ≠ 𝐿) ∧ 𝑏 ∈ (0..^5)) → (({𝐾, 〈0, 𝑏〉} ∈ 𝐸 ∧ {〈0, 𝑏〉, 𝐿} ∈ 𝐸) → 𝑋 = 〈0, 𝑏〉)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | pgnbgreunbgrlem2 48615 | Lemma 2 for pgnbgreunbgr 48623. Impossible cases. (Contributed by AV, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐿 = 〈1, (((2nd ‘𝑋) + 2) mod 5)〉 ∨ 𝐿 = 〈0, (2nd ‘𝑋)〉 ∨ 𝐿 = 〈1, (((2nd ‘𝑋) − 2) mod 5)〉) → ((𝐾 = 〈1, (((2nd ‘𝑋) + 2) mod 5)〉 ∨ 𝐾 = 〈0, (2nd ‘𝑋)〉 ∨ 𝐾 = 〈1, (((2nd ‘𝑋) − 2) mod 5)〉) → ((𝑋 = 〈1, 𝑦〉 ∧ 𝑋 ∈ 𝑉) → ((𝐾 ≠ 𝐿 ∧ (𝑏 ∈ (0..^5) ∧ 𝑦 ∈ (0..^5))) → (({𝐾, 〈0, 𝑏〉} ∈ 𝐸 ∧ {〈0, 𝑏〉, 𝐿} ∈ 𝐸) → 𝑋 = 〈0, 𝑏〉))))) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fxpsdrg 33263 | The fixed points of a group action 𝐴 on a division ring 𝑊 is a sub-division-ring. Since sub-division-rings of fields are subfields (see fldsdrgfld 20777), (𝐶FixPts𝐴) might be called the fixed subfield under 𝐴. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐶 = (Base‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑥 ∈ 𝐶 ↦ (𝑝𝐴𝑥)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝐺 GrpAct 𝐶)) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑝 ∈ 𝐵) → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑊 RingHom 𝑊)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑊 ∈ DivRing) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐶FixPts𝐴) ∈ (SubDRing‘𝑊)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fxpsubrg 33262 | The fixed points of a group action 𝐴 on a ring 𝑊 is a subgring. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐶 = (Base‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑥 ∈ 𝐶 ↦ (𝑝𝐴𝑥)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝐺 GrpAct 𝐶)) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑝 ∈ 𝐵) → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑊 RingHom 𝑊)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐶FixPts𝐴) ∈ (SubRing‘𝑊)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fxpsubg 33261 | The fixed points of a group action 𝐴 on a group 𝑊 is a subgroup. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐶 = (Base‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑥 ∈ 𝐶 ↦ (𝑝𝐴𝑥)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝐺 GrpAct 𝐶)) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑝 ∈ 𝐵) → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑊 GrpHom 𝑊)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐶FixPts𝐴) ∈ (SubGrp‘𝑊)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fxpsubm 33260 | Provided the group action 𝐴 induces monoid automorphisms, the set of fixed points of 𝐴 on a monoid 𝑊 is a submonoid, which could be called the fixed submonoid under 𝐴. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐶 = (Base‘𝑊) & ⊢ 𝐹 = (𝑥 ∈ 𝐶 ↦ (𝑝𝐴𝑥)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝐺 GrpAct 𝐶)) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ 𝑝 ∈ 𝐵) → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑊 MndHom 𝑊)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐶FixPts𝐴) ∈ (SubMnd‘𝑊)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | cntrval2 33259 | Express the center 𝑍 of a group 𝑀 as the set of fixed points of the conjugation operation ⊕. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑀) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝑀) & ⊢ − = (-g‘𝑀) & ⊢ ⊕ = (𝑥 ∈ 𝐵, 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ ((𝑥 + 𝑦) − 𝑥)) & ⊢ 𝑍 = (Cntr‘𝑀) ⇒ ⊢ (𝑀 ∈ Grp → 𝑍 = (𝐵FixPts ⊕ )) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | conjga 33258 | Group conjugation induces a group action. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑀) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝑀) & ⊢ − = (-g‘𝑀) & ⊢ ⊕ = (𝑥 ∈ 𝐵, 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ ((𝑥 + 𝑦) − 𝑥)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝑀 ∈ Grp → ⊕ ∈ (𝑀 GrpAct 𝐵)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fxpgaeq 33257 | A fixed point 𝑋 is invariant under group action 𝐴. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑈 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝐺 GrpAct 𝐶)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ (𝐶FixPts𝐴)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑃 ∈ 𝑈) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑃𝐴𝑋) = 𝑋) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | isfxp 33256 | Property of being a fixed point. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑈 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝐺 GrpAct 𝐶)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 ∈ (𝐶FixPts𝐴) ↔ ∀𝑝 ∈ 𝑈 (𝑝𝐴𝑋) = 𝑋)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fxpgaval 33255 | Value of the set of fixed points for a group action 𝐴. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑈 = (Base‘𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝐺 GrpAct 𝐶)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐶FixPts𝐴) = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐶 ∣ ∀𝑝 ∈ 𝑈 (𝑝𝐴𝑥) = 𝑥}) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fxpss 33254 | The set of fixed points is a subset of the set acted upon. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐵FixPts𝐴) ⊆ 𝐵) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | fxpval 33253 | Value of the set of fixed points. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ 𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐵FixPts𝐴) = {𝑥 ∈ 𝐵 ∣ ∀𝑝 ∈ dom dom 𝐴(𝑝𝐴𝑥) = 𝑥}) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | df-fxp 33252 | Define the set of fixed points left unchanged by a group action. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ FixPts = (𝑏 ∈ V, 𝑎 ∈ V ↦ {𝑥 ∈ 𝑏 ∣ ∀𝑝 ∈ dom dom 𝑎(𝑝𝑎𝑥) = 𝑥}) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | ralimd6v 3193 | Deduction sextupally quantifying both antecedent and consequent. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 5-Mar-2025.) Reduce DV conditions. (Revised by Eric Schmidt, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜓 → 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ∀𝑧 ∈ 𝐶 ∀𝑤 ∈ 𝐷 ∀𝑝 ∈ 𝐸 ∀𝑞 ∈ 𝐹 𝜓 → ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ∀𝑧 ∈ 𝐶 ∀𝑤 ∈ 𝐷 ∀𝑝 ∈ 𝐸 ∀𝑞 ∈ 𝐹 𝜒)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | ralimd4v 3191 | Deduction quadrupally quantifying both antecedent and consequent. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 2-Mar-2025.) Reduce DV conditions. (Revised by Eric Schmidt, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜓 → 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ∀𝑧 ∈ 𝐶 ∀𝑤 ∈ 𝐷 𝜓 → ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ∀𝑧 ∈ 𝐶 ∀𝑤 ∈ 𝐷 𝜒)) | ||
| 18-Nov-2025 | ralimdvv 3189 | Deduction doubly quantifying both antecedent and consequent. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 2-Mar-2025.) Shorten and reduce DV conditions. (Revised by Eric Schmidt, 18-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝜓 → 𝜒)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 𝜓 → ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 𝜒)) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | initocmd 50166 | Initial objects are the object part of colimits of the empty diagram. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (InitO‘𝐶) = dom (∅(𝐶 Colimit ∅)∅) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | isinito4a 50045 | The predicate "is an initial object" of a category, using universal property. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 1 ∈ TermCat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ (Base‘ 1 )) & ⊢ 𝐹 = ((1st ‘( 1 Δfunc𝐶))‘𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐼 ∈ (InitO‘𝐶) ↔ 𝐼 ∈ dom (𝐹(𝐶 UP 1 )𝑋))) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | isinito4 50044 | The predicate "is an initial object" of a category, using universal property. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 1 ∈ TermCat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ (Base‘ 1 )) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 1 )) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐼 ∈ (InitO‘𝐶) ↔ 𝐼 ∈ dom (𝐹(𝐶 UP 1 )𝑋))) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | uobeqterm 50043 | Universal objects and terminal categories. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐸) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ TermCat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 ∈ TermCat) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → dom (𝐹(𝐶 UP 𝐷)𝑋) = dom (𝐺(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑌)) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | cofuterm 50042 | Post-compose with a functor to a terminal category. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 ∈ TermCat) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐾) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | termfucterm 50041 | All functors between two terminal categories are isomorphisms. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐶 = (CatCat‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Iso‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ TermCat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ TermCat) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 Func 𝑌) = (𝑋𝐼𝑌)) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | 0fucterm 50040 | The category of functors from an initial category is terminal. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ∅ = (Base‘𝐶)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐶 FuncCat 𝐷) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑄 ∈ TermCat) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | fucterm 50039 | The category of functors to a terminal category is terminal. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐶 FuncCat 𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ TermCat) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑄 ∈ TermCat) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | funcsn 50038 | The category of one functor to a thin category is terminal. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐶 FuncCat 𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐶 Func 𝐷) = {𝐹}) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ ThinCat) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑄 ∈ TermCat) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | termco 49978 | The object of a terminal category. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ TermCat) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ∪ 𝐵 ∈ 𝐵) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | uobeq3 49899 | An isomorphism between categories generates equal sets of universal objects. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐾 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1st ‘𝐾)‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (CatCat‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Iso‘𝑄) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (𝐷𝐼𝐸)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → dom (𝐹(𝐶 UP 𝐷)𝑋) = dom (𝐺(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑌)) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | uobeq2 49898 | If a full functor (in fact, a full embedding) is a section, then the sets of universal objects are equal. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐾 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1st ‘𝐾)‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (CatCat‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝑆 = (Sect‘𝑄) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (𝐷 Full 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ dom (𝐷𝑆𝐸)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → dom (𝐹(𝐶 UP 𝐷)𝑋) = dom (𝐺(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑌)) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | catcisoi 49897 | A functor is an isomorphism of categories only if it is full and faithful, and is a bijection on the objects. Remark 3.28(2) in [Adamek] p. 34. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐶 = (CatCat‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝑅 = (Base‘𝑋) & ⊢ 𝑆 = (Base‘𝑌) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Iso‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑋𝐼𝑌)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐹 ∈ ((𝑋 Full 𝑌) ∩ (𝑋 Faith 𝑌)) ∧ (1st ‘𝐹):𝑅–1-1-onto→𝑆)) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | uobeq 49717 | If a full functor (in fact, a full embedding) is a section of a functor (surjective on objects), then the sets of universal objects are equal. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐾 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1st ‘𝐾)‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (𝐷 Full 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐿 ∘func 𝐾) = 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐿 ∈ (𝐸 Func 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → dom (𝐹(𝐶 UP 𝐷)𝑋) = dom (𝐺(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑌)) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | uobeqw 49716 | If a full functor (in fact, a full embedding) is a section of a fully faithful functor (surjective on objects), then the sets of universal objects are equal. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐾 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1st ‘𝐾)‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ (𝐷 Full 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐿 ∘func 𝐾) = 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐿 ∈ ((𝐸 Full 𝐷) ∩ (𝐸 Faith 𝐷))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → dom (𝐹(𝐶 UP 𝐷)𝑋) = dom (𝐺(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑌)) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | uptrar 49713 | Universal property and fully faithful functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1st ‘𝐾)‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ ((𝐷 Full 𝐸) ∩ (𝐷 Faith 𝐸))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐾 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (◡(𝑋(2nd ‘𝐾)((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑍))‘𝑁) = 𝑀) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍(𝐺(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑌)𝑁) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍(𝐹(𝐶 UP 𝐷)𝑋)𝑀) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | uobrcl 49690 | Reverse closure for universal object. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝑋 ∈ dom (𝐹(𝐷 UP 𝐸)𝑊) → (𝐷 ∈ Cat ∧ 𝐸 ∈ Cat)) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | oppff1o 49646 | The operation generating opposite functors is bijective. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑊) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ↾ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)):(𝐶 Func 𝐷)–1-1-onto→(𝑂 Func 𝑃)) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | oppff1 49645 | The operation generating opposite functors is injective. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) ⇒ ⊢ ( oppFunc ↾ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)):(𝐶 Func 𝐷)–1-1→(𝑂 Func 𝑃) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | 2oppffunc 49643 | The opposite functor of an opposite functor is a functor on the original categories. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) The functor in opposite categories does not have to be an opposite functor. (Revised by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑂 Func 𝑃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | oppffn 49621 | oppFunc is a function on (V × V). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ oppFunc Fn (V × V) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | isoval2 49532 | The isomorphisms are the domain of the inverse relation. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑁 = (Inv‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Iso‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝑋𝐼𝑌) = dom (𝑋𝑁𝑌) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | isorcl2 49531 | Reverse closure for isomorphism relations. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (Iso‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑋𝐼𝑌)) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵)) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | isorcl 49530 | Reverse closure for isomorphism relations. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (Iso‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑋𝐼𝑌)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) | ||
| 17-Nov-2025 | pgnbgreunbgrlem2lem3 48614 | Lemma 3 for pgnbgreunbgrlem2 48615. (Contributed by AV, 17-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ ((((𝐿 = 〈1, ((𝑦 + 2) mod 5)〉 ∧ 𝐾 = 〈1, ((𝑦 − 2) mod 5)〉) ∧ (𝑏 ∈ (0..^5) ∧ 𝑦 ∈ (0..^5))) ∧ {𝐾, 〈0, 𝑏〉} ∈ 𝐸) → ¬ {〈0, 𝑏〉, 𝐿} ∈ 𝐸) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | uptrai 49714 | Universal property and fully faithful functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1st ‘𝐾)‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ ((𝐷 Full 𝐸) ∩ (𝐷 Faith 𝐸))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐾 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋(2nd ‘𝐾)((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑍))‘𝑀) = 𝑁) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍(𝐹(𝐶 UP 𝐷)𝑋)𝑀) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍(𝐺(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑌)𝑁) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | uptra 49712 | Universal property and fully faithful functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1st ‘𝐾)‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ ((𝐷 Full 𝐸) ∩ (𝐷 Faith 𝐸))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐾 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋(2nd ‘𝐾)((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑍))‘𝑀) = 𝑁) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀 ∈ (𝑋𝐽((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑍))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑍(𝐹(𝐶 UP 𝐷)𝑋)𝑀 ↔ 𝑍(𝐺(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑌)𝑁)) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | uptri 49711 | Universal property and fully faithful functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑅‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅((𝐷 Full 𝐸) ∩ (𝐷 Faith 𝐸))𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝑅, 𝑆〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 〈𝐾, 𝐿〉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋𝑆(𝐹‘𝑍))‘𝑀) = 𝑁) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍(〈𝐹, 𝐺〉(𝐶 UP 𝐷)𝑋)𝑀) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍(〈𝐾, 𝐿〉(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑌)𝑁) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | uptr 49710 | Universal property and fully faithful functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑅‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅((𝐷 Full 𝐸) ∩ (𝐷 Faith 𝐸))𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝑅, 𝑆〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 〈𝐾, 𝐿〉) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐶 Func 𝐷)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋𝑆(𝐹‘𝑍))‘𝑀) = 𝑁) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀 ∈ (𝑋𝐽(𝐹‘𝑍))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑍(〈𝐹, 𝐺〉(𝐶 UP 𝐷)𝑋)𝑀 ↔ 𝑍(〈𝐾, 𝐿〉(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑌)𝑁)) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | uptrlem3 49709 | Lemma for uptr 49710. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑅‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅((𝐷 Full 𝐸) ∩ (𝐷 Faith 𝐸))𝑆) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝑅, 𝑆〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 〈𝐾, 𝐿〉) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐶 Func 𝐷)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋𝑆(𝐹‘𝑍))‘𝑀) = 𝑁) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀 ∈ (𝑋𝐽(𝐹‘𝑍))) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍 ∈ 𝐴) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑍(〈𝐹, 𝐺〉(𝐶 UP 𝐷)𝑋)𝑀 ↔ 𝑍(〈𝐾, 𝐿〉(𝐶 UP 𝐸)𝑌)𝑁)) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | uptrlem2 49708 | Lemma for uptr 49710. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Hom ‘𝐸) & ⊢ ∙ = (comp‘𝐷) & ⊢ ⚬ = (comp‘𝐸) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1st ‘𝐾)‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍 ∈ 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑊 ∈ 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀 ∈ (𝑋𝐼((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑍))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋(2nd ‘𝐾)((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑍))‘𝑀) = 𝑁) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾 ∈ ((𝐷 Full 𝐸) ∩ (𝐷 Faith 𝐸))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐾 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀ℎ ∈ (𝑌𝐽((1st ‘𝐺)‘𝑊))∃!𝑘 ∈ (𝑍𝐻𝑊)ℎ = (((𝑍(2nd ‘𝐺)𝑊)‘𝑘)(〈𝑌, ((1st ‘𝐺)‘𝑍)〉 ⚬ ((1st ‘𝐺)‘𝑊))𝑁) ↔ ∀𝑔 ∈ (𝑋𝐼((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑊))∃!𝑘 ∈ (𝑍𝐻𝑊)𝑔 = (((𝑍(2nd ‘𝐹)𝑊)‘𝑘)(〈𝑋, ((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑍)〉 ∙ ((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑊))𝑀))) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | uptrlem1 49707 | Lemma for uptr 49710. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Hom ‘𝐸) & ⊢ ∙ = (comp‘𝐷) & ⊢ ⚬ = (comp‘𝐸) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ (Base‘𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑀‘𝑋) = 𝑌) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍 ∈ (Base‘𝐶)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑊 ∈ (Base‘𝐶)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ (𝑋𝐼(𝐹‘𝑍))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋𝑁(𝐹‘𝑍))‘𝐴) = 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐶 Func 𝐷)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀((𝐷 Full 𝐸) ∩ (𝐷 Faith 𝐸))𝑁) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝑀, 𝑁〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 〈𝐾, 𝐿〉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (∀ℎ ∈ (𝑌𝐽(𝐾‘𝑊))∃!𝑘 ∈ (𝑍𝐻𝑊)ℎ = (((𝑍𝐿𝑊)‘𝑘)(〈𝑌, (𝐾‘𝑍)〉 ⚬ (𝐾‘𝑊))𝐵) ↔ ∀𝑔 ∈ (𝑋𝐼(𝐹‘𝑊))∃!𝑘 ∈ (𝑍𝐻𝑊)𝑔 = (((𝑍𝐺𝑊)‘𝑘)(〈𝑋, (𝐹‘𝑍)〉 ∙ (𝐹‘𝑊))𝐴))) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | idemb 49656 | The inclusion functor is an embedding. Remark 4.4(1) in [Adamek] p. 49. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐼 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸) → (𝐼 ∈ (𝐷 Faith 𝐸) ∧ Fun ◡(1st ‘𝐼))) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | idfu1stf1o 49596 | The identity functor/inclusion functor is bijective on objects. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐶 ∈ Cat → (1st ‘𝐼):𝐵–1-1-onto→𝐵) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | cofucla 49593 | The composition of two functors is a functor. Proposition 3.23 of [Adamek] p. 33. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐶 Func 𝐷)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾(𝐷 Func 𝐸)𝐿) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐾, 𝐿〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐸)) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | cofu2a 49592 | Value of the morphism part of the functor composition. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐶 Func 𝐷)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾(𝐷 Func 𝐸)𝐿) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐾, 𝐿〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 〈𝑀, 𝑁〉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ (𝑋𝐻𝑌)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (((𝐹‘𝑋)𝐿(𝐹‘𝑌))‘((𝑋𝐺𝑌)‘𝑅)) = ((𝑋𝑁𝑌)‘𝑅)) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | cofu1a 49591 | Value of the object part of the functor composition. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐶 Func 𝐷)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾(𝐷 Func 𝐸)𝐿) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐾, 𝐿〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 〈𝑀, 𝑁〉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐾‘(𝐹‘𝑋)) = (𝑀‘𝑋)) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | pgnbgreunbgrlem2lem2 48613 | Lemma 2 for pgnbgreunbgrlem2 48615. (Contributed by AV, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ ((((𝐿 = 〈1, ((𝑦 − 2) mod 5)〉 ∧ 𝐾 = 〈0, 𝑦〉) ∧ (𝑏 ∈ (0..^5) ∧ 𝑦 ∈ (0..^5))) ∧ {𝐾, 〈0, 𝑏〉} ∈ 𝐸) → ¬ {〈0, 𝑏〉, 𝐿} ∈ 𝐸) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | pgnbgreunbgrlem2lem1 48612 | Lemma 1 for pgnbgreunbgrlem2 48615. (Contributed by AV, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ ((((𝐿 = 〈1, ((𝑦 + 2) mod 5)〉 ∧ 𝐾 = 〈0, 𝑦〉) ∧ (𝑏 ∈ (0..^5) ∧ 𝑦 ∈ (0..^5))) ∧ {𝐾, 〈0, 𝑏〉} ∈ 𝐸) → ¬ {〈0, 𝑏〉, 𝐿} ∈ 𝐸) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | nregmodelaxext 45469 | The Axiom of Extensionality ax-ext 2712 is true in the permutation model defined from 𝐹. This theorem is an immediate consequence of the fact that ax-ext 2712 holds in all permutation models and is provided as an illustration. (Contributed by Eric Schmidt, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐹 = (( I ↾ (V ∖ {∅, {∅}})) ∪ {〈∅, {∅}〉, 〈{∅}, ∅〉}) & ⊢ 𝑅 = (◡𝐹 ∘ E ) ⇒ ⊢ (∀𝑧(𝑧𝑅𝑥 ↔ 𝑧𝑅𝑦) → 𝑥 = 𝑦) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | nregmodel 45468 | The Axiom of Regularity ax-reg 9504 is false in the permutation model defined from 𝐹. Since the other axioms of ZFC hold in all permutation models (permaxext 45456 through permac8prim 45465), we can conclude that Regularity does not follow from those axioms, assuming ZFC is consistent. (If we could prove Regularity from the other axioms, we could prove it in the permutation model and thus obtain a contradiction with this theorem.) Since we also know that Regularity is consistent with the other axioms (wfaxext 45444 through wfac8prim 45453), Regularity is neither provable nor disprovable from the other axioms; i.e., it is independent of them. (Contributed by Eric Schmidt, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐹 = (( I ↾ (V ∖ {∅, {∅}})) ∪ {〈∅, {∅}〉, 〈{∅}, ∅〉}) & ⊢ 𝑅 = (◡𝐹 ∘ E ) ⇒ ⊢ ¬ ∀𝑥(∃𝑦 𝑦𝑅𝑥 → ∃𝑦(𝑦𝑅𝑥 ∧ ∀𝑧(𝑧𝑅𝑦 → ¬ 𝑧𝑅𝑥))) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | nregmodellem 45467 | Lemma for nregmodel 45468. (Contributed by Eric Schmidt, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐹 = (( I ↾ (V ∖ {∅, {∅}})) ∪ {〈∅, {∅}〉, 〈{∅}, ∅〉}) & ⊢ 𝑅 = (◡𝐹 ∘ E ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝑥𝑅∅ ↔ 𝑥 ∈ {∅}) | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | nregmodelf1o 45466 | Define a permutation 𝐹 used to produce a model in which ax-reg 9504 is false. The permutation swaps ∅ and {∅} and leaves the rest of 𝑉 fixed. This is an example given after Exercise II.9.2 of [Kunen2] p. 148. (Contributed by Eric Schmidt, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐹 = (( I ↾ (V ∖ {∅, {∅}})) ∪ {〈∅, {∅}〉, 〈{∅}, ∅〉}) ⇒ ⊢ 𝐹:V–1-1-onto→V | ||
| 16-Nov-2025 | permac8prim 45465 | The Axiom of Choice ac8prim 45442 holds in permutation models. Part of Exercise II.9.3 of [Kunen2] p. 149. Note that ax-ac 10379 requires Regularity for its derivation from the usual Axiom of Choice and does not necessarily hold in permutation models. (Contributed by Eric Schmidt, 16-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐹:V–1-1-onto→V & ⊢ 𝑅 = (◡𝐹 ∘ E ) ⇒ ⊢ ((∀𝑧(𝑧𝑅𝑥 → ∃𝑤 𝑤𝑅𝑧) ∧ ∀𝑧∀𝑤((𝑧𝑅𝑥 ∧ 𝑤𝑅𝑥) → (¬ 𝑧 = 𝑤 → ∀𝑦(𝑦𝑅𝑧 → ¬ 𝑦𝑅𝑤)))) → ∃𝑦∀𝑧(𝑧𝑅𝑥 → ∃𝑤∀𝑣((𝑣𝑅𝑧 ∧ 𝑣𝑅𝑦) ↔ 𝑣 = 𝑤))) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cofidfth 49659 | If "𝐹 is a section of 𝐺 " in a category of small categories (in a universe), then 𝐹 is faithful. Combined with cofidf1 49618, this theorem proves that 𝐹 is an embedding (a faithful functor injective on objects, remark 3.28(1) of [Adamek] p. 34). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐷 Func 𝐸)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾(𝐸 Func 𝐷)𝐿) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐾, 𝐿〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 𝐼) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐷 Faith 𝐸)𝐺) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cofidf1 49618 | If "〈𝐹, 𝐺〉 is a section of 〈𝐾, 𝐿〉 " in a category of small categories (in a universe), then 𝐹 is injective, and 𝐾 is surjective. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐷 Func 𝐸)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾(𝐸 Func 𝐷)𝐿) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐾, 𝐿〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐶 = (Base‘𝐸) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐹:𝐵–1-1→𝐶 ∧ 𝐾:𝐶–onto→𝐵)) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cofidf2 49617 | If "𝐹 is a section of 𝐺 " in a category of small categories (in a universe), then the morphism part of 𝐹 is injective, and the morphism part of 𝐺 is surjective in the image of 𝐹. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐷 Func 𝐸)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾(𝐸 Func 𝐷)𝐿) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐾, 𝐿〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Hom ‘𝐸) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋𝐺𝑌):(𝑋𝐻𝑌)–1-1→((𝐹‘𝑋)𝐽(𝐹‘𝑌)) ∧ ((𝐹‘𝑋)𝐿(𝐹‘𝑌)):((𝐹‘𝑋)𝐽(𝐹‘𝑌))–onto→(𝑋𝐻𝑌))) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cofidval 49616 | The property "〈𝐹, 𝐺〉 is a section of 〈𝐾, 𝐿〉 " in a category of small categories (in a universe); expressed explicitly. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐷 Func 𝐸)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾(𝐸 Func 𝐷)𝐿) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐾, 𝐿〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐷) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐾 ∘ 𝐹) = ( I ↾ 𝐵) ∧ (𝑥 ∈ 𝐵, 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ (((𝐹‘𝑥)𝐿(𝐹‘𝑦)) ∘ (𝑥𝐺𝑦))) = (𝑧 ∈ (𝐵 × 𝐵) ↦ ( I ↾ (𝐻‘𝑧))))) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cofidf1a 49615 | If "𝐹 is a section of 𝐺 " in a category of small categories (in a universe), then the object part of 𝐹 is injective, and the object part of 𝐺 is surjective. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝐸 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐶 = (Base‘𝐸) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1st ‘𝐹):𝐵–1-1→𝐶 ∧ (1st ‘𝐺):𝐶–onto→𝐵)) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cofidf2a 49614 | If "𝐹 is a section of 𝐺 " in a category of small categories (in a universe), then the morphism part of 𝐹 is injective, and the morphism part of 𝐺 is surjective in the image of 𝐹. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝐸 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Hom ‘𝐸) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝑋(2nd ‘𝐹)𝑌):(𝑋𝐻𝑌)–1-1→(((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑋)𝐽((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑌)) ∧ (((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑋)(2nd ‘𝐺)((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑌)):(((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑋)𝐽((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑌))–onto→(𝑋𝐻𝑌))) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cofidvala 49613 | The property "𝐹 is a section of 𝐺 " in a category of small categories (in a universe); expressed explicitly. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝐸 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐼) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐷) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (((1st ‘𝐺) ∘ (1st ‘𝐹)) = ( I ↾ 𝐵) ∧ (𝑥 ∈ 𝐵, 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ ((((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑥)(2nd ‘𝐺)((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑦)) ∘ (𝑥(2nd ‘𝐹)𝑦))) = (𝑧 ∈ (𝐵 × 𝐵) ↦ ( I ↾ (𝐻‘𝑧))))) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cofid2 49612 | Express the morphism part of (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐼 explicitly. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐷 Func 𝐸)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾(𝐸 Func 𝐷)𝐿) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐾, 𝐿〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ (𝑋𝐻𝑌)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (((𝐹‘𝑋)𝐿(𝐹‘𝑌))‘((𝑋𝐺𝑌)‘𝑅)) = 𝑅) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cofid1 49611 | Express the object part of (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐼 explicitly. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐷 Func 𝐸)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐾(𝐸 Func 𝐷)𝐿) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (〈𝐾, 𝐿〉 ∘func 〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 𝐼) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐾‘(𝐹‘𝑋)) = 𝑋) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cofid2a 49610 | Express the morphism part of (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐼 explicitly. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝐸 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐼) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ (𝑋𝐻𝑌)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑋)(2nd ‘𝐺)((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑌))‘((𝑋(2nd ‘𝐹)𝑌)‘𝑅)) = 𝑅) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cofid1a 49609 | Express the object part of (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐼 explicitly. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝐸 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐼) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((1st ‘𝐺)‘((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑋)) = 𝑋) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cofu1st2nd 49589 | Rewrite the functor composition with separated functor parts. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = (〈(1st ‘𝐺), (2nd ‘𝐺)〉 ∘func 〈(1st ‘𝐹), (2nd ‘𝐹)〉)) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | initc 49588 | Sets with empty base are the only initial objects in the category of small categories. Example 7.2(3) of [Adamek] p. 101. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐶 ∈ V ∧ ∅ = (Base‘𝐶)) ↔ ∀𝑑 ∈ Cat ∃!𝑓 𝑓 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝑑)) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | func2nd 49575 | Extract the second member of a functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐶 Func 𝐷)𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (2nd ‘〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 𝐺) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | func1st 49574 | Extract the first member of a functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐶 Func 𝐷)𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (1st ‘〈𝐹, 𝐺〉) = 𝐹) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | pgnbgreunbgrlem1 48611 | Lemma 1 for pgnbgreunbgr 48623. (Contributed by AV, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (5 gPetersenGr 2) & ⊢ 𝑉 = (Vtx‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐺 NeighbVtx 𝑋) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐿 = 〈0, (((2nd ‘𝑋) + 1) mod 5)〉 ∨ 𝐿 = 〈1, (2nd ‘𝑋)〉 ∨ 𝐿 = 〈0, (((2nd ‘𝑋) − 1) mod 5)〉) → ((𝐾 = 〈0, (((2nd ‘𝑋) + 1) mod 5)〉 ∨ 𝐾 = 〈1, (2nd ‘𝑋)〉 ∨ 𝐾 = 〈0, (((2nd ‘𝑋) − 1) mod 5)〉) → ((𝑋 ∈ 𝑉 ∧ 𝑋 = 〈0, 𝑦〉) → ((𝐾 ≠ 𝐿 ∧ (𝑏 ∈ (0..^5) ∧ 𝑦 ∈ (0..^5))) → (({𝐾, 〈0, 𝑏〉} ∈ 𝐸 ∧ {〈0, 𝑏〉, 𝐿} ∈ 𝐸) → 𝑋 = 〈0, 𝑏〉))))) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | gpgedg2ov 48564 | The edges of the generalized Petersen graph GPG(N,K) between two outside vertices. (Contributed by AV, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐽 = (1..^(⌈‘(𝑁 / 2))) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (0..^𝑁) & ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝑁 gPetersenGr 𝐾) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘5) ∧ 𝐾 ∈ 𝐽) ∧ (𝑋 ∈ 𝐼 ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼)) → (({〈0, ((𝑌 − 1) mod 𝑁)〉, 〈0, 𝑋〉} ∈ 𝐸 ∧ {〈0, 𝑋〉, 〈0, ((𝑌 + 1) mod 𝑁)〉} ∈ 𝐸) ↔ 𝑋 = 𝑌)) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | modm1p1ne 47846 | If an integer minus one equals another integer plus one modulo an integer greater than 4, then the first integer plus one is not equal to the second integer minus one modulo the same modulus. (Contributed by AV, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (0..^𝑁) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘5) ∧ 𝑋 ∈ 𝐼 ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) → (((𝑌 − 1) mod 𝑁) = ((𝑋 + 1) mod 𝑁) → ((𝑌 + 1) mod 𝑁) ≠ ((𝑋 − 1) mod 𝑁))) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | modm1nep1 47841 | A nonnegative integer less than a modulus greater than 2 plus/minus one are not equal modulo the modulus. (Contributed by AV, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (0..^𝑁) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘3) ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) → ((𝑌 − 1) mod 𝑁) ≠ ((𝑌 + 1) mod 𝑁)) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | mod2addne 47840 | The sums of a nonnegative integer less than the modulus and two integers whose difference is less than the modulus are not equal modulo the modulus. (Contributed by AV, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (0..^𝑁) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ ℕ ∧ (𝑋 ∈ 𝐼 ∧ 𝐴 ∈ ℤ ∧ 𝐵 ∈ ℤ) ∧ (abs‘(𝐴 − 𝐵)) ∈ (1..^𝑁)) → ((𝑋 + 𝐴) mod 𝑁) ≠ ((𝑋 + 𝐵) mod 𝑁)) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | modmknepk 47838 | A nonnegative integer less than the modulus plus/minus a positive integer less than (the ceiling of) half of the modulus are not equal modulo the modulus. For this theorem, it is essential that 𝐾 < (𝑁 / 2)! (Contributed by AV, 3-Sep-2025.) (Revised by AV, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐽 = (1..^(⌈‘(𝑁 / 2))) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (0..^𝑁) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘3) ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼 ∧ 𝐾 ∈ 𝐽) → ((𝑌 − 𝐾) mod 𝑁) ≠ ((𝑌 + 𝐾) mod 𝑁)) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | modmkpkne 47837 | If an integer minus a constant equals another integer plus the constant modulo 𝑁, then the first integer plus the constant equals the second integer minus the constant modulo 𝑁 iff the fourfold of the constant is a multiple of 𝑁. (Contributed by AV, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ ℕ ∧ (𝑋 ∈ ℤ ∧ 𝑌 ∈ ℤ ∧ 𝐾 ∈ ℤ)) → (((𝑌 − 𝐾) mod 𝑁) = ((𝑋 + 𝐾) mod 𝑁) → (((𝑌 + 𝐾) mod 𝑁) = ((𝑋 − 𝐾) mod 𝑁) ↔ ((4 · 𝐾) mod 𝑁) = 0))) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | trisecnconstr 33983 | Not all angles can be trisected. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ¬ ∀𝑜 ∈ Constr (𝑜↑𝑐(1 / 3)) ∈ Constr | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cos9thpinconstr 33982 | Trisecting an angle is an impossible construction. Given for example 𝑂 = (exp‘((i · (2 · π)) / 3)), which represents an angle of ((2 · π) / 3), the cube root of 𝑂 is not constructible with straightedge and compass, while 𝑂 itself is constructible. This is the second part of Metamath 100 proof #8. Theorem 7.14 of [Stewart] p. 99. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux and Saveliy Skresanov, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (exp‘((i · (2 · π)) / 3)) & ⊢ 𝑍 = (𝑂↑𝑐(1 / 3)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝑂 ∈ Constr ∧ 𝑍 ∉ Constr) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | cos9thpinconstrlem2 33981 | The complex number 𝐴 is not constructible. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (exp‘((i · (2 · π)) / 3)) & ⊢ 𝑍 = (𝑂↑𝑐(1 / 3)) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (𝑍 + (1 / 𝑍)) ⇒ ⊢ ¬ 𝐴 ∈ Constr | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | difmod0 16254 | The difference of two integers modulo a positive integer equals zero iff the two integers are equal modulo the positive integer. (Contributed by AV, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐴 ∈ ℤ ∧ 𝐵 ∈ ℤ ∧ 𝑁 ∈ ℕ) → (((𝐴 − 𝐵) mod 𝑁) = 0 ↔ (𝐴 mod 𝑁) = (𝐵 mod 𝑁))) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | uzuzle35 12835 | An integer greater than or equal to 5 is an integer greater than or equal to 3. (Contributed by AV, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ (ℤ≥‘5) → 𝐴 ∈ (ℤ≥‘3)) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | addsubsub23 11556 | Swap the second and the third terms in a difference of a sum and a difference (or, vice versa, in a sum of a difference and a sum). (Contributed by AV, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℂ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℂ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ℂ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ ℂ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 + 𝐵) − (𝐶 − 𝐷)) = ((𝐴 − 𝐶) + (𝐵 + 𝐷))) | ||
| 15-Nov-2025 | subsubadd23 11555 | Swap the second and the third terms in a difference of a difference and a sum. (Contributed by AV, 15-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℂ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 ∈ ℂ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ℂ) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ ℂ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ((𝐴 − 𝐵) − (𝐶 + 𝐷)) = ((𝐴 − 𝐶) − (𝐵 + 𝐷))) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | islmd 50162 | The universal property of limits of a diagram. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐷 Nat 𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶) & ⊢ · = (comp‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝑋((𝐶 Limit 𝐷)‘𝐹)𝑅 ↔ ((𝑋 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ 𝑅 ∈ (((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑋)𝑁𝐹)) ∧ ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∀𝑎 ∈ (((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑥)𝑁𝐹)∃!𝑚 ∈ (𝑥𝐻𝑋)𝑎 = (𝑗 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ ((𝑅‘𝑗)(〈𝑥, 𝑋〉 · ((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑗))𝑚)))) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | rellmd 50156 | The set of limits of a diagram is a relation. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ Rel ((𝐶 Limit 𝐷)‘𝐹) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | lmdfval2 50152 | The set of limits of a diagram. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐶 Limit 𝐷)‘𝐹) = (( oppFunc ‘(𝐶Δfunc𝐷))((oppCat‘𝐶) UP (oppCat‘(𝐷 FuncCat 𝐶)))𝐹) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | reldmlmd2 50150 | The domain of (𝐶 Limit 𝐷) is a relation. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ Rel dom (𝐶 Limit 𝐷) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | lmdfval 50146 | Function value of Limit. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐶 Limit 𝐷) = (𝑓 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐶) ↦ (( oppFunc ‘(𝐶Δfunc𝐷))((oppCat‘𝐶) UP (oppCat‘(𝐷 FuncCat 𝐶)))𝑓)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | catcinv 49896 | The property "𝐹 is an inverse of 𝐺 " in a category of small categories (in a universe). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐶 = (CatCat‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (Inv‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝑋) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (idfunc‘𝑌) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐹(𝑋𝑁𝑌)𝐺 ↔ ((𝐹 ∈ (𝑋𝐻𝑌) ∧ 𝐺 ∈ (𝑌𝐻𝑋)) ∧ ((𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐼 ∧ (𝐹 ∘func 𝐺) = 𝐽))) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | catcsect 49895 | The property "𝐹 is a section of 𝐺 " in a category of small categories (in a universe). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐶 = (CatCat‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝑋) & ⊢ 𝑆 = (Sect‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐹(𝑋𝑆𝑌)𝐺 ↔ ((𝐹 ∈ (𝑋𝐻𝑌) ∧ 𝐺 ∈ (𝑌𝐻𝑋)) ∧ (𝐺 ∘func 𝐹) = 𝐼)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | elcatchom 49894 | A morphism of the category of categories (in a universe) is a functor. See df-catc 18064 for the definition of the category Cat, which consists of all categories in the universe 𝑢 (i.e., "𝑢-small categories", see Definition 3.44. of [Adamek] p. 39), with functors as the morphisms (catchom 18068). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐶 = (CatCat‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑋𝐻𝑌)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑋 Func 𝑌)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | catcrcl2 49893 | Reverse closure for the category of categories (in a universe) (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐶 = (CatCat‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑋𝐻𝑌)) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | catcrcl 49892 | Reverse closure for the category of categories (in a universe) (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐶 = (CatCat‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝑋𝐻𝑌)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑈 ∈ V) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | oppfuprcl2 49702 | Reverse closure for the class of universal property for opposite functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋(𝐺(𝑂 UP 𝑃)𝑊)𝑀) & ⊢ 𝐺 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) & ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐸) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑈) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = 〈𝐴, 𝐵〉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴(𝐷 Func 𝐸)𝐵) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | oppfuprcl 49701 | Reverse closure for the class of universal property for opposite functors. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋(𝐺(𝑂 UP 𝑃)𝑊)𝑀) & ⊢ 𝐺 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) & ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐸) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑈) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 ∈ 𝑉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | uprcl2a 49700 | Reverse closure for the class of universal property. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋(𝐺(𝑂 UP 𝑃)𝑊)𝑀) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ (𝑂 Func 𝑃)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | funcoppc5 49642 | A functor on opposite categories yields a functor on the original categories. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) ∈ (𝑂 Func 𝑃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | funcoppc4 49641 | A functor on opposite categories yields a functor on the original categories. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ 𝑉) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐷 ∈ 𝑊) & ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐹 oppFunc 𝐺) ∈ (𝑂 Func 𝑃)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐶 Func 𝐷)𝐺) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | oppfoppc2 49639 | The opposite functor is a functor on opposite categories. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (oppCat‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (oppCat‘𝐷) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) ∈ (𝑂 Func 𝑃)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | 2oppf 49629 | The double opposite functor is the original functor. Remark 3.42 of [Adamek] p. 39. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ 𝑅) & ⊢ Rel 𝑅 & ⊢ 𝐺 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ( oppFunc ‘𝐺) = 𝐹) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | oppf1st2nd 49628 | Rewrite the opposite functor into its components (eqopi 7974). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ 𝑅) & ⊢ Rel 𝑅 & ⊢ 𝐺 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = 〈𝐴, 𝐵〉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐺 ∈ (V × V) ∧ ((1st ‘𝐺) = 𝐴 ∧ (2nd ‘𝐺) = tpos 𝐵))) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | oppfrcl3 49627 | If an opposite functor of a class is a functor, then the second component of the original class must be a relation whose domain is a relation as well. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ 𝑅) & ⊢ Rel 𝑅 & ⊢ 𝐺 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = 〈𝐴, 𝐵〉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (Rel 𝐵 ∧ Rel dom 𝐵)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | oppfrcl2 49626 | If an opposite functor of a class is a functor, then the two components of the original class must be sets. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ 𝑅) & ⊢ Rel 𝑅 & ⊢ 𝐺 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 = 〈𝐴, 𝐵〉) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝐴 ∈ V ∧ 𝐵 ∈ V)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | oppfrcl 49625 | If an opposite functor of a class is a functor, then the original class must be an ordered pair. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ 𝑅) & ⊢ Rel 𝑅 & ⊢ 𝐺 = ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ (V × V)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | oppfrcllem 49624 | Lemma for oppfrcl 49625. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ∈ 𝑅) & ⊢ Rel 𝑅 ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐺 ≠ ∅) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | isinv2 49523 | The property "𝐹 is an inverse of 𝐺". (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑁 = (Inv‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑆 = (Sect‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐹(𝑋𝑁𝑌)𝐺 ↔ (𝐹(𝑋𝑆𝑌)𝐺 ∧ 𝐺(𝑌𝑆𝑋)𝐹)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | invrcl2 49522 | Reverse closure for inverse relations. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑁 = (Inv‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝑋𝑁𝑌)𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | invrcl 49521 | Reverse closure for inverse relations. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑁 = (Inv‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝑋𝑁𝑌)𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | sectrcl2 49520 | Reverse closure for section relations. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (Sect‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝑋𝑆𝑌)𝐺) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑋 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | sectrcl 49519 | Reverse closure for section relations. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑆 = (Sect‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝑋𝑆𝑌)𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | cos9thpinconstrlem1 33980 | The complex number 𝑂, representing an angle of (2 · π) / 3, is constructible. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (exp‘((i · (2 · π)) / 3)) ⇒ ⊢ 𝑂 ∈ Constr | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | cos9thpiminply 33979 | The polynomial ((𝑋↑3) + ((-3 · 𝑋) + 1)) is the minimal polynomial for 𝐴 over ℚ, and its degree is 3. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (exp‘((i · (2 · π)) / 3)) & ⊢ 𝑍 = (𝑂↑𝑐(1 / 3)) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (𝑍 + (1 / 𝑍)) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (ℂfld ↾s ℚ) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝑃) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑃) & ⊢ ↑ = (.g‘(mulGrp‘𝑃)) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Poly1‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝐾 = (algSc‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑋 = (var1‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝐷 = (deg1‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝐹 = ((3 ↑ 𝑋) + (((𝐾‘-3) · 𝑋) + (𝐾‘1))) & ⊢ 𝑀 = (ℂfld minPoly ℚ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐹 = (𝑀‘𝐴) ∧ (𝐷‘𝐹) = 3) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | cos9thpiminplylem6 33978 | Evaluation of the polynomial ((𝑋↑3) + ((-3 · 𝑋) + 1)). (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (exp‘((i · (2 · π)) / 3)) & ⊢ 𝑍 = (𝑂↑𝑐(1 / 3)) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (𝑍 + (1 / 𝑍)) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (ℂfld ↾s ℚ) & ⊢ + = (+g‘𝑃) & ⊢ · = (.r‘𝑃) & ⊢ ↑ = (.g‘(mulGrp‘𝑃)) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Poly1‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝐾 = (algSc‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑋 = (var1‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝐷 = (deg1‘𝑄) & ⊢ 𝐹 = ((3 ↑ 𝑋) + (((𝐾‘-3) · 𝑋) + (𝐾‘1))) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ ℂ) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (((ℂfld evalSub1 ℚ)‘𝐹)‘𝑌) = ((𝑌↑3) + ((-3 · 𝑌) + 1))) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | cos9thpiminplylem5 33977 | The constructed complex number 𝐴 is a root of the polynomial ((𝑋↑3) + ((-3 · 𝑋) + 1)). (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (exp‘((i · (2 · π)) / 3)) & ⊢ 𝑍 = (𝑂↑𝑐(1 / 3)) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (𝑍 + (1 / 𝑍)) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝐴↑3) + ((-3 · 𝐴) + 1)) = 0 | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | cos9thpiminplylem4 33976 | Lemma for cos9thpiminply 33979. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (exp‘((i · (2 · π)) / 3)) & ⊢ 𝑍 = (𝑂↑𝑐(1 / 3)) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑍↑6) + (𝑍↑3)) = -1 | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | cos9thpiminplylem3 33975 | Lemma for cos9thpiminply 33979. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑂 = (exp‘((i · (2 · π)) / 3)) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑂↑2) + (𝑂 + 1)) = 0 | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | vr1nz 33683 | A univariate polynomial variable cannot be the zero polynomial. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑋 = (var1‘𝑈) & ⊢ 𝑍 = (0g‘𝑃) & ⊢ 𝑈 = (𝑆 ↾s 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Poly1‘𝑈) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑆 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑆 ∈ NzRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ (SubRing‘𝑆)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ≠ 𝑍) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | ressply1evls1 33655 | Subring evaluation of a univariate polynomial is the same as the subring evaluation in the bigger ring. (Contributed by Thierry Arnoux, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝐸 ↾s 𝑅) & ⊢ 𝑂 = (𝐸 evalSub1 𝑆) & ⊢ 𝑄 = (𝐺 evalSub1 𝑆) & ⊢ 𝑃 = (Poly1‘𝐾) & ⊢ 𝐾 = (𝐸 ↾s 𝑆) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝑃) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐸 ∈ CRing) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ (SubRing‘𝐸)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑆 ∈ (SubRing‘𝐺)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹 ∈ 𝐵) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑄‘𝐹) = ((𝑂‘𝐹) ↾ 𝑅)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | efne0 16061 | The exponential of a complex number is nonzero. Corollary 15-4.3 of [Gleason] p. 309. (Contributed by NM, 13-Jan-2006.) (Revised by Mario Carneiro, 29-Apr-2014.) (Proof shortened by TA, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐴 ∈ ℂ → (exp‘𝐴) ≠ 0) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | modaddid 13867 | The sums of two nonnegative integers less than the modulus and an integer are equal iff the two nonnegative integers are equal. (Contributed by AV, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (0..^𝑁) ⇒ ⊢ ((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘3) ∧ (𝑋 ∈ 𝐼 ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼) ∧ 𝐾 ∈ ℤ) → (((𝑋 + 𝐾) mod 𝑁) = ((𝑌 + 𝐾) mod 𝑁) ↔ 𝑋 = 𝑌)) | ||
| 14-Nov-2025 | modaddb 13866 | Addition property of the modulo operation. Biconditional version of modadd1 13865 by applying modadd1 13865 twice. (Contributed by AV, 14-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (((𝐴 ∈ ℝ ∧ 𝐵 ∈ ℝ) ∧ (𝐶 ∈ ℝ ∧ 𝐷 ∈ ℝ+)) → ((𝐴 mod 𝐷) = (𝐵 mod 𝐷) ↔ ((𝐴 + 𝐶) mod 𝐷) = ((𝐵 + 𝐶) mod 𝐷))) | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | iscmd 50163 | The universal property of colimits of a diagram. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐷 Nat 𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶) & ⊢ · = (comp‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝑋((𝐶 Colimit 𝐷)‘𝐹)𝑅 ↔ ((𝑋 ∈ 𝐴 ∧ 𝑅 ∈ (𝐹𝑁((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑋))) ∧ ∀𝑥 ∈ 𝐴 ∀𝑎 ∈ (𝐹𝑁((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑥))∃!𝑚 ∈ (𝑋𝐻𝑥)𝑎 = (𝑗 ∈ 𝐵 ↦ (𝑚(〈((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑗), 𝑋〉 · 𝑥)(𝑅‘𝑗))))) | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | coccom 50161 | A co-cone to a diagram commutes with the diagram. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐷 Nat 𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐾 = ((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑋) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀 ∈ (𝑌𝐽𝑍)) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ · = (comp‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ (𝐹𝑁𝐾)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑅‘𝑌) = ((𝑅‘𝑍)(〈((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑌), ((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑍)〉 · 𝑋)((𝑌(2nd ‘𝐹)𝑍)‘𝑀))) | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | concom 50160 | A cone to a diagram commutes with the diagram. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐷 Nat 𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐾 = ((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑋) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑍 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑀 ∈ (𝑌𝐽𝑍)) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ · = (comp‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ (𝐾𝑁𝐹)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑅‘𝑍) = (((𝑌(2nd ‘𝐹)𝑍)‘𝑀)(〈𝑋, ((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑌)〉 · ((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑍))(𝑅‘𝑌))) | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | coccl 50159 | A natural transformation to a constant functor of an object maps to morphisms whose codomain is the object. Therefore, the range of the second component of a co-cone are morphisms with a common codomain. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐷 Nat 𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐾 = ((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑋) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ (𝐹𝑁𝐾)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑅‘𝑌) ∈ (((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑌)𝐻𝑋)) | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | concl 50158 | A natural transformation from a constant functor of an object maps to morphisms whose domain is the object. Therefore, the range of the second component of a cone are morphisms with a common domain. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐿 = (𝐶Δfunc𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐴 = (Base‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝑁 = (𝐷 Nat 𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐾 = ((1st ‘𝐿)‘𝑋) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑋 ∈ 𝐴) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑌 ∈ 𝐵) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑅 ∈ (𝐾𝑁𝐹)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (𝑅‘𝑌) ∈ (𝑋𝐻((1st ‘𝐹)‘𝑌))) | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | relcmd 50157 | The set of colimits of a diagram is a relation. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ Rel ((𝐶 Colimit 𝐷)‘𝐹) | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | reldmcmd2 50151 | The domain of (𝐶 Colimit 𝐷) is a relation. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ Rel dom (𝐶 Colimit 𝐷) | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | oppfval2 49634 | Value of the opposite functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐹 ∈ (𝐶 Func 𝐷) → ( oppFunc ‘𝐹) = 〈(1st ‘𝐹), tpos (2nd ‘𝐹)〉) | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | oppfvallem 49632 | Lemma for oppfval 49633. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐹(𝐶 Func 𝐷)𝐺 → (Rel 𝐺 ∧ Rel dom 𝐺)) | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | oppfvalg 49623 | Value of the opposite functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐹 ∈ V ∧ 𝐺 ∈ V) → (𝐹 oppFunc 𝐺) = if((Rel 𝐺 ∧ Rel dom 𝐺), 〈𝐹, tpos 𝐺〉, ∅)) | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | reldmoppf 49622 | The domain of oppFunc is a relation. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ Rel dom oppFunc | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | df-oppf 49620 | Definition of the operation generating opposite functors. Definition 3.41 of [Adamek] p. 39. The object part of the functor is unchanged while the morphism part is transposed due to reversed direction of arrows in the opposite category. The opposite functor is a functor on opposite categories (oppfoppc 49638). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 4-Nov-2025.) Better reverse closure. (Revised by Zhi Wang, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ oppFunc = (𝑓 ∈ V, 𝑔 ∈ V ↦ if((Rel 𝑔 ∧ Rel dom 𝑔), 〈𝑓, tpos 𝑔〉, ∅)) | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | lamberte 47358 | A value of Lambert W (product logarithm) function at e. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑅 = ◡(𝑥 ∈ ℂ ↦ (𝑥 · (exp‘𝑥))) ⇒ ⊢ e𝑅1 | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | lambert0 47357 | A value of Lambert W (product logarithm) function at zero. (Contributed by Ender Ting, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝑅 = ◡(𝑥 ∈ ℂ ↦ (𝑥 · (exp‘𝑥))) ⇒ ⊢ 0𝑅0 | ||
| 13-Nov-2025 | sbralie 3318 | Implicit to explicit substitution that swaps variables in a restrictedly universally quantified expression. (Contributed by NM, 5-Sep-2004.) Avoid ax-ext 2712, df-cleq 2732, df-clel 2815. (Revised by Wolf Lammen, 10-Mar-2025.) Avoid ax-10 2152, ax-12 2189. (Revised by SN, 13-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝑥 = 𝑦 → (𝜑 ↔ 𝜓)) ⇒ ⊢ (∀𝑥 ∈ 𝑦 𝜑 ↔ [𝑦 / 𝑥]∀𝑦 ∈ 𝑥 𝜓) | ||
| 12-Nov-2025 | cmdfval2 50153 | The set of colimits of a diagram. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 12-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ ((𝐶 Colimit 𝐷)‘𝐹) = ((𝐶Δfunc𝐷)(𝐶 UP (𝐷 FuncCat 𝐶))𝐹) | ||
| 12-Nov-2025 | cmdfval 50147 | Function value of Colimit. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 12-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝐶 Colimit 𝐷) = (𝑓 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐶) ↦ ((𝐶Δfunc𝐷)(𝐶 UP (𝐷 FuncCat 𝐶))𝑓)) | ||
| 12-Nov-2025 | reldmcmd 50145 | The domain of Colimit is a relation. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 12-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ Rel dom Colimit | ||
| 12-Nov-2025 | reldmlmd 50144 | The domain of Limit is a relation. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 12-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ Rel dom Limit | ||
| 12-Nov-2025 | df-cmd 50143 |
A co-cone (or cocone) to a diagram (see df-lmd 50142 for definition), or a
natural sink for a diagram in a category 𝐶 is a pair of an object
𝑋 in 𝐶 and a natural
transformation from the diagram to the
constant functor (or constant diagram) of the object 𝑋. The
second
component associates each object in the index category with a morphism
in 𝐶 whose codomain is 𝑋 (coccl 50159). The naturality guarantees
that the combination of the diagram with the co-cone must commute
(coccom 50161). Definition 11.27(1) of [Adamek] p. 202.
A colimit of a diagram 𝐹:𝐷⟶𝐶 of type 𝐷 in category 𝐶 is a universal pair from the diagram to the diagonal functor (𝐶Δfunc𝐷). The universal pair is a co-cone to the diagram satisfying the universal property, that each co-cone to the diagram uniquely factors through the colimit. (iscmd 50163). Definition 11.27(2) of [Adamek] p. 202. Initial objects (initocmd 50166), coproducts, coequalizers, pushouts, and direct limits can be considered as colimits of some diagram; colimits can be further generalized as left Kan extensions (cmdlan 50169). "cmd" is short for "colimit of a diagram". See df-lmd 50142 for the dual concept (lmddu 50164, cmddu 50165). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 12-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ Colimit = (𝑐 ∈ V, 𝑑 ∈ V ↦ (𝑓 ∈ (𝑑 Func 𝑐) ↦ ((𝑐Δfunc𝑑)(𝑐 UP (𝑑 FuncCat 𝑐))𝑓))) | ||
| 12-Nov-2025 | df-lmd 50142 |
A diagram of type 𝐷 or a 𝐷-shaped diagram in a
category 𝐶,
is a functor 𝐹:𝐷⟶𝐶 where the source category 𝐷,
usually
small or even finite, is called the index category or the scheme of the
diagram. The actual objects and morphisms in 𝐷 are largely
irrelevant; only the way in which they are interrelated matters. The
diagram is thought of as indexing a collection of objects and morphisms
in 𝐶 patterned on 𝐷. Definition 11.1(1) of
[Adamek] p. 193.
A cone to a diagram, or a natural source for a diagram in a category 𝐶 is a pair of an object 𝑋 in 𝐶 and a natural transformation from the constant functor (or constant diagram) of the object 𝑋 to the diagram. The second component associates each object in the index category with a morphism in 𝐶 whose domain is 𝑋 (concl 50158). The naturality guarantees that the combination of the diagram with the cone must commute (concom 50160). Definition 11.3(1) of [Adamek] p. 193. A limit of a diagram 𝐹:𝐷⟶𝐶 of type 𝐷 in category 𝐶 is a universal pair from the diagonal functor (𝐶Δfunc𝐷) to the diagram. The universal pair is a cone to the diagram satisfying the universal property, that each cone to the diagram uniquely factors through the limit (islmd 50162). Definition 11.3(2) of [Adamek] p. 194. Terminal objects (termolmd 50167), products, equalizers, pullbacks, and inverse limits can be considered as limits of some diagram; limits can be further generalized as right Kan extensions (lmdran 50168). "lmd" is short for "limit of a diagram". See df-cmd 50143 for the dual concept (lmddu 50164, cmddu 50165). (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 12-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ Limit = (𝑐 ∈ V, 𝑑 ∈ V ↦ (𝑓 ∈ (𝑑 Func 𝑐) ↦ (( oppFunc ‘(𝑐Δfunc𝑑))((oppCat‘𝑐) UP (oppCat‘(𝑑 FuncCat 𝑐)))𝑓))) | ||
| 12-Nov-2025 | upfval 49673 | Function value of the class of universal properties. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 24-Sep-2025.) (Proof shortened by Zhi Wang, 12-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐶 = (Base‘𝐸) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Hom ‘𝐸) & ⊢ 𝑂 = (comp‘𝐸) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐷 UP 𝐸) = (𝑓 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸), 𝑤 ∈ 𝐶 ↦ {〈𝑥, 𝑚〉 ∣ ((𝑥 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ 𝑚 ∈ (𝑤𝐽((1st ‘𝑓)‘𝑥))) ∧ ∀𝑦 ∈ 𝐵 ∀𝑔 ∈ (𝑤𝐽((1st ‘𝑓)‘𝑦))∃!𝑘 ∈ (𝑥𝐻𝑦)𝑔 = (((𝑥(2nd ‘𝑓)𝑦)‘𝑘)(〈𝑤, ((1st ‘𝑓)‘𝑥)〉𝑂((1st ‘𝑓)‘𝑦))𝑚))}) | ||
| 12-Nov-2025 | reldmfunc 49572 | The domain of Func is a relation. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 12-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ Rel dom Func | ||
| 11-Nov-2025 | discthing 49958 | A discrete category, i.e., a category where all morphisms are identity morphisms, is thin. Example 3.26(1) of [Adamek] p. 33. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 11-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ (𝑥 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵)) → (𝑥𝐻𝑦) = if(𝑥 = 𝑦, {𝐼}, ∅)) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ThinCat) | ||
| 11-Nov-2025 | indcthing 49957 | An indiscrete category, i.e., a category where all hom-sets have exactly one morphism, is thin. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 11-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐶)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐻 = (Hom ‘𝐶)) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ Cat) & ⊢ ((𝜑 ∧ (𝑥 ∈ 𝐵 ∧ 𝑦 ∈ 𝐵)) → (𝑥𝐻𝑦) = {𝐹}) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐶 ∈ ThinCat) | ||
| 11-Nov-2025 | idfullsubc 49658 | The source category of an inclusion functor is a full subcategory of the target category if the inclusion functor is full. Remark 4.4(2) in [Adamek] p. 49. See also ressffth 17905. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 11-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Homf ‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐽 = (Homf ‘𝐸) & ⊢ 𝐵 = (Base‘𝐷) & ⊢ 𝐶 = (Base‘𝐸) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐼 ∈ (𝐷 Full 𝐸) → (𝐵 ⊆ 𝐶 ∧ (𝐽 ↾ (𝐵 × 𝐵)) = 𝐻)) | ||
| 11-Nov-2025 | gpgedgiov 48563 | The edges of the generalized Petersen graph GPG(N,K) between an inside and an outside vertex. (Contributed by AV, 11-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐽 = (1..^(⌈‘(𝑁 / 2))) & ⊢ 𝐼 = (0..^𝑁) & ⊢ 𝐺 = (𝑁 gPetersenGr 𝐾) & ⊢ 𝐸 = (Edg‘𝐺) ⇒ ⊢ (((𝑁 ∈ (ℤ≥‘3) ∧ 𝐾 ∈ 𝐽) ∧ (𝑋 ∈ 𝐼 ∧ 𝑌 ∈ 𝐼)) → ({〈0, 𝑋〉, 〈1, 𝑌〉} ∈ 𝐸 ↔ 𝑋 = 𝑌)) | ||
| 11-Nov-2025 | pw2cutp1 28478 | Simplify pw2cut 28477 in the case of successors of surreal integers. (Contributed by Scott Fenton, 11-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐴 ∈ ℤs) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝑁 ∈ ℕ0s) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → ({(𝐴 /su (2s↑s𝑁))} |s {((𝐴 +s 1s ) /su (2s↑s𝑁))}) = (((2s ·s 𝐴) +s 1s ) /su (2s↑s(𝑁 +s 1s )))) | ||
| 10-Nov-2025 | idsubc 49657 | The source category of an inclusion functor is a subcategory of the target category. See also Remark 4.4 in [Adamek] p. 49. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 10-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐶) & ⊢ 𝐻 = (Homf ‘𝐷) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐼 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸) → 𝐻 ∈ (Subcat‘𝐸)) | ||
| 10-Nov-2025 | idfth 49655 | The inclusion functor is a faithful functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 10-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ 𝐼 = (idfunc‘𝐶) ⇒ ⊢ (𝐼 ∈ (𝐷 Func 𝐸) → 𝐼 ∈ (𝐷 Faith 𝐸)) | ||
| 10-Nov-2025 | fthcomf 49654 | Source categories of a faithful functor have the same base, hom-sets and composition operation if the composition is compatible in images of the functor. (Contributed by Zhi Wang, 10-Nov-2025.) |
| ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐴 Faith 𝐶)𝐺) & ⊢ (𝜑 → 𝐹(𝐵 Func 𝐷)𝐺) & ⊢ (((𝜑 ∧ (𝑥 ∈ (Base‘𝐴) ∧ 𝑦 ∈ (Base‘𝐴) ∧ 𝑧 ∈ (Base‘𝐴))) ∧ (𝑓 ∈ (𝑥(Hom ‘𝐴)𝑦) ∧ 𝑔 ∈ (𝑦(Hom ‘𝐴)𝑧))) → (((𝑦𝐺𝑧)‘𝑔)(〈(𝐹‘𝑥), (𝐹‘𝑦)〉(comp‘𝐶)(𝐹‘𝑧))((𝑥𝐺𝑦)‘𝑓)) = (((𝑦𝐺𝑧)‘𝑔)(〈(𝐹‘𝑥), (𝐹‘𝑦)〉(comp‘𝐷)(𝐹‘𝑧))((𝑥𝐺𝑦)‘𝑓))) ⇒ ⊢ (𝜑 → (compf‘𝐴) = (compf‘𝐵)) | ||
(29-Jul-2020) Mario Carneiro presented MM0 at the CICM conference. See this Google Group post which includes a YouTube link.
(20-Jul-2020) Rohan Ridenour found 5 shorter D-proofs in our Shortest known proofs... file. In particular, he reduced *4.39 from 901 to 609 steps. A note on the Metamath Solitaire page mentions a tool that he worked with.
(19-Jul-2020) David A. Wheeler posted a video (https://youtu.be/3R27Qx69jHc) on how to (re)prove Schwabh�user 4.6 for the Metamath Proof Explorer. See also his older videos.
(19-Jul-2020) In version 0.184 of the metamath program, "verify markup" now checks that mathboxes are independent i.e. do not cross-reference each other. To turn off this check, use "/mathbox_skip"
(30-Jun-2020) In version 0.183 of the metamath program, (1) "verify markup" now has checking for (i) underscores in labels, (ii) that *ALT and *OLD theorems have both discouragement tags, and (iii) that lines don't have trailing spaces. (2) "save proof.../rewrap" no longer left-aligns $p/$a comments that contain the string "<HTML>"; see this note.
(5-Apr-2020) Glauco Siliprandi added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, e is Transcendental etransc, bringing the Metamath total to 74.
(12-Feb-2020) A bug in the 'minimize' command of metamath.exe versions 0.179 (29-Nov-2019) and 0.180 (10-Dec-2019) may incorrectly bring in the use of new axioms. Version 0.181 fixes it.
(20-Jan-2020) David A. Wheeler created a video called Walkthrough of the tutorial in mmj2. See the Google Group announcement for more details. (All of his videos are listed on the Other Metamath-Related Topics page.)
(18-Jan-2020) The FOMM 2020 talks are on youtube now. Mario Carneiro's talk is Metamath Zero, or: How to Verify a Verifier. Since they are washed out in the video, the PDF slides are available separately.
(14-Dec-2019) Glauco Siliprandi added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, Fourier series convergence fourier, bringing the Metamath total to 73.
(25-Nov-2019) Alexander van der Vekens added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, The Cayley-Hamilton Theorem cayleyhamilton, bringing the Metamath total to 72.
(25-Oct-2019) Mario Carneiro's paper "Metamath Zero: The Cartesian Theorem Prover" (submitted to CPP 2020) is now available on arXiv: https://arxiv.org/abs/1910.10703. There is a related discussion on Hacker News.
(30-Sep-2019) Mario Carneiro's talk about MM0 at ITP 2019 is available on YouTube: x86 verification from scratch (24 minutes). Google Group discussion: Metamath Zero.
(29-Sep-2019) David Wheeler created a fascinating Gource video that animates the construction of set.mm, available on YouTube: Metamath set.mm contributions viewed with Gource through 2019-09-26 (4 minutes). Google Group discussion: Gource video of set.mm contributions.
(24-Sep-2019) nLab added a page for Metamath. It mentions Stefan O'Rear's Busy Beaver work using the set.mm axiomatization (and fails to mention Mario's definitional soundness checker)
(1-Sep-2019) Xuanji Li published a Visual Studio Code extension to support metamath syntax highlighting.
(10-Aug-2019) (revised 21-Sep-2019) Version 0.178 of the metamath program has the following changes: (1) "minimize_with" will now prevent dependence on new $a statements unless the new qualifier "/allow_new_axioms" is specified. For routine usage, it is suggested that you use "minimize_with * /allow_new_axioms * /no_new_axioms_from ax-*" instead of just "minimize_with *". See "help minimize_with" and this Google Group post. Also note that the qualifier "/allow_growth" has been renamed to "/may_grow". (2) "/no_versioning" was added to "write theorem_list".
(8-Jul-2019) Jon Pennant announced the creation of a Metamath search engine. Try it and feel free to comment on it at https://groups.google.com/d/msg/metamath/cTeU5AzUksI/5GesBfDaCwAJ.
(16-May-2019) Set.mm now has a major new section on elementary geometry. This begins with definitions that implement Tarski's axioms of geometry (including concepts such as congruence and betweenness). This uses set.mm's extensible structures, making them easier to use for many circumstances. The section then connects Tarski geometry with geometry in Euclidean places. Most of the work in this section is due to Thierry Arnoux, with earlier work by Mario Carneiro and Scott Fenton. [Reported by DAW.]
(9-May-2019) We are sad to report that long-time contributor Alan Sare passed away on Mar. 23. There is some more information at the top of his mathbox (click on "Mathbox for Alan Sare") and his obituary. We extend our condolences to his family.
(10-Mar-2019) Jon Pennant and Mario Carneiro added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, Heron's formula heron, bringing the Metamath total to 71.
(22-Feb-2019) Alexander van der Vekens added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, Cramer's rule cramer, bringing the Metamath total to 70.
(6-Feb-2019) David A. Wheeler has made significant improvements and updates to the Metamath book. Any comments, errors found, or suggestions are welcome and should be turned into an issue or pull request at https://github.com/metamath/metamath-book (or sent to me if you prefer).
(26-Dec-2018) I added Appendix 8 to the MPE Home Page that cross-references new and old axiom numbers.
(20-Dec-2018) The axioms have been renumbered according to this Google Groups post.
(24-Nov-2018) Thierry Arnoux created a new page on topological structures. The page along with its SVG files are maintained on GitHub.
(11-Oct-2018) Alexander van der Vekens added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, the Friendship Theorem friendship, bringing the Metamath total to 69.
(1-Oct-2018) Naip Moro has written gramm, a Metamath proof verifier written in Antlr4/Java.
(16-Sep-2018) The definition df-riota has been simplified so that it evaluates to the empty set instead of an Undef value. This change affects a significant part of set.mm.
(2-Sep-2018) Thierry Arnoux added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, Euler's partition theorem eulerpart, bringing the Metamath total to 68.
(1-Sep-2018) The Kate editor now has Metamath syntax highlighting built in. (Communicated by Wolf Lammen.)
(15-Aug-2018) The Intuitionistic Logic Explorer now has a Most Recent Proofs page.
(4-Aug-2018) Version 0.163 of the metamath program now indicates (with an asterisk) which Table of Contents headers have associated comments.
(10-May-2018) George Szpiro, journalist and author of several books on popular mathematics such as Poincare's Prize and Numbers Rule, used a genetic algorithm to find shorter D-proofs of "*3.37" and "meredith" in our Shortest known proofs... file.
(19-Apr-2018) The EMetamath Eclipse plugin has undergone many improvements since its initial release as the change log indicates. Thierry uses it as his main proof assistant and writes, "I added support for mmj2's auto-transformations, which allows it to infer several steps when building proofs. This added a lot of comfort for writing proofs.... I can now switch back and forth between the proof assistant and editing the Metamath file.... I think no other proof assistant has this feature."
(11-Apr-2018) Benoît Jubin solved an open problem about the "Axiom of Twoness," showing that it is necessary for completeness. See item 14 on the "Open problems and miscellany" page.
(25-Mar-2018) Giovanni Mascellani has announced mmpp, a new proof editing environment for the Metamath language.
(27-Feb-2018) Bill Hale has released an app for the Apple iPad and desktop computer that allows you to browse Metamath theorems and their proofs.
(17-Jan-2018) Dylan Houlihan has kindly provided a new mirror site. He has also provided an rsync server; type "rsync uk.metamath.org::" in a bash shell to check its status (it should return "metamath metamath").
(15-Jan-2018) The metamath program, version 0.157, has been updated to implement the file inclusion conventions described in the 21-Dec-2017 entry of mmnotes.txt.
(11-Dec-2017) I added a paragraph, suggested by Gérard Lang, to the distinct variable description here.
(10-Dec-2017) Per FL's request, his mathbox will be removed from set.mm. If you wish to export any of his theorems, today's version (master commit 1024a3a) is the last one that will contain it.
(11-Nov-2017) Alan Sare updated his completeusersproof program.
(3-Oct-2017) Sean B. Palmer created a web page that runs the metamath program under emulated Linux in JavaScript. He also wrote some programs to work with our shortest known proofs of the PM propositional calculus theorems.
(28-Sep-2017) Ivan Kuckir wrote a tutorial blog entry, Introduction to Metamath, that summarizes the language syntax. (It may have been written some time ago, but I was not aware of it before.)
(26-Sep-2017) The default directory for the Metamath Proof Explorer (MPE) has been changed from the GIF version (mpegif) to the Unicode version (mpeuni) throughout the site. Please let me know if you find broken links or other issues.
(24-Sep-2017) Saveliy Skresanov added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, Ceva's Theorem cevath, bringing the Metamath total to 67.
(3-Sep-2017) Brendan Leahy added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, Area of a Circle areacirc, bringing the Metamath total to 66.
(7-Aug-2017) Mario Carneiro added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, Principle of Inclusion/Exclusion incexc, bringing the Metamath total to 65.
(1-Jul-2017) Glauco Siliprandi added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, Stirling's Formula stirling, bringing the Metamath total to 64. Related theorems include 2 versions of Wallis' formula for π (wallispi and wallispi2).
(7-May-2017) Thierry Arnoux added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, Betrand's Ballot Problem ballotth, bringing the Metamath total to 63.
(20-Apr-2017) Glauco Siliprandi added a new proof in the supplementary list on the 100 theorem list, Stone-Weierstrass Theorem stowei.
(28-Feb-2017) David Moews added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, Product of Segments of Chords chordthm, bringing the Metamath total to 62.
(1-Jan-2017) Saveliy Skresanov added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, Isosceles triangle theorem isosctr, bringing the Metamath total to 61.
(1-Jan-2017) Mario Carneiro added 2 new proofs to the 100 theorem list, L'Hôpital's Rule lhop and Taylor's Theorem taylth, bringing the Metamath total to 60.
(28-Dec-2016) David A. Wheeler is putting together a page on Metamath (specifically set.mm) conventions. Comments are welcome on the Google Group thread.
(24-Dec-2016) Mario Carneiro introduced the abbreviation "F/ x ph" (symbols: turned F, x, phi) in df-nf to represent the "effectively not free" idiom "A. x ( ph -> A. x ph )". Theorem nf2 shows a version without nested quantifiers.
(22-Dec-2016) Naip Moro has developed a Metamath database for G. Spencer-Brown's Laws of Form. You can follow the Google Group discussion here.
(20-Dec-2016) In metamath program version 0.137, 'verify markup *' now checks that ax-XXX $a matches axXXX $p when the latter exists, per the discussion at https://groups.google.com/d/msg/metamath/Vtz3CKGmXnI/Fxq3j1I_EQAJ.
(24-Nov-2016) Mingl Yuan has kindly provided a mirror site in Beijing, China. He has also provided an rsync server; type "rsync cn.metamath.org::" in a bash shell to check its status (it should return "metamath metamath").
(14-Aug-2016) All HTML pages on this site should now be mobile-friendly and pass the Mobile-Friendly Test. If you find one that does not, let me know.
(14-Aug-2016) Daniel Whalen wrote a paper describing the use of using deep learning to prove 14% of test theorems taken from set.mm: Holophrasm: a neural Automated Theorem Prover for higher-order logic. The associated program is called Holophrasm.
(14-Aug-2016) David A. Wheeler created a video called Metamath Proof Explorer: A Modern Principia Mathematica
(12-Aug-2016) A Gitter chat room has been created for Metamath.
(9-Aug-2016) Mario Carneiro wrote a Metamath proof verifier in the Scala language as part of the ongoing Metamath -> MMT import project
(9-Aug-2016) David A. Wheeler created a GitHub project called metamath-test (last execution run) to check that different verifiers both pass good databases and detect errors in defective ones.
(4-Aug-2016) Mario gave two presentations at CICM 2016.
(17-Jul-2016) Thierry Arnoux has written EMetamath, a Metamath plugin for the Eclipse IDE.
(16-Jul-2016) Mario recovered Chris Capel's collapsible proof demo.
(13-Jul-2016) FL sent me an updated version of PDF (LaTeX source) developed with Lamport's pf2 package. See the 23-Apr-2012 entry below.
(12-Jul-2016) David A. Wheeler produced a new video for mmj2 called "Creating functions in Metamath". It shows a more efficient approach than his previous recent video "Creating functions in Metamath" (old) but it can be of interest to see both approaches.
(10-Jul-2016) Metamath program version 0.132 changes the command 'show restricted' to 'show discouraged' and adds a new command, 'set discouragement'. See the mmnotes.txt entry of 11-May-2016 (updated 10-Jul-2016).
(12-Jun-2016) Dan Getz has written Metamath.jl, a Metamath proof verifier written in the Julia language.
(10-Jun-2016) If you are using metamath program versions 0.128, 0.129, or 0.130, please update to version 0.131. (In the bad versions, 'minimize_with' ignores distinct variable violations.)
(1-Jun-2016) Mario Carneiro added new proofs to the 100 theorem list, the Prime Number Theorem pnt and the Perfect Number Theorem perfect, bringing the Metamath total to 58.
(12-May-2016) Mario Carneiro added a new proof to the 100 theorem list, Dirichlet's theorem dirith, bringing the Metamath total to 56. (Added 17-May-2016) An informal exposition of the proof can be found at http://metamath-blog.blogspot.com/2016/05/dirichlets-theorem.html
(10-Mar-2016) Metamath program version 0.125 adds a new qualifier, /fast, to 'save proof'. See the mmnotes.txt entry of 10-Mar-2016.
(6-Mar-2016) The most recent set.mm has a large update converting variables from letters to symbols. See this Google Groups post.
(16-Feb-2016) Mario Carneiro's new paper "Models for Metamath" can be found here and on arxiv.org.
(6-Feb-2016) There are now 22 math symbols that can be used as variable names. See mmascii.html near the 50th table row, starting with "./\".
(29-Jan-2016) Metamath program version 0.123 adds /packed and /explicit qualifiers to 'save proof' and 'show proof'. See this Google Groups post.
(13-Jan-2016) The Unicode math symbols now provide for external CSS and use the XITS web font. Thanks to David A. Wheeler, Mario Carneiro, Cris Perdue, Jason Orendorff, and Frédéric Liné for discussions on this topic. Two commands, htmlcss and htmlfont, were added to the $t comment in set.mm and are recognized by Metamath program version 0.122.
(21-Dec-2015) Axiom ax-12, now renamed ax-12o, was replaced by a new shorter equivalent, ax-12. The equivalence is provided by theorems ax12o and ax12.
(13-Dec-2015) A new section on the theory of classes was added to the MPE Home Page. Thanks to Gérard Lang for suggesting this section and improvements to it.
(17-Nov-2015) Metamath program version 0.121: 'verify markup' was added to check comment markup consistency; see 'help verify markup'. You are encouraged to make sure 'verify markup */f' has no warnings prior to mathbox submissions. The date consistency rules are given in this Google Groups post.
(23-Sep-2015) Drahflow wrote, "I am currently working on yet another proof assistant, main reason being: I understand stuff best if I code it. If anyone is interested: https://github.com/Drahflow/Igor (but in my own programming language, so expect a complicated build process :P)"
(23-Aug-2015) Ivan Kuckir created MM Tool, a Metamath proof verifier and editor written in JavaScript that runs in a browser.
(25-Jul-2015) Axiom ax-10 is shown to be redundant by theorem ax10 , so it was removed from the predicate calculus axiom list.
(19-Jul-2015) Mario Carneiro gave two talks related to Metamath at CICM 2015, which are linked to at Other Metamath-Related Topics.
(18-Jul-2015) The metamath program has been updated to version 0.118. 'show trace_back' now has a '/to' qualifier to show the path back to a specific axiom such as ax-ac. See 'help show trace_back'.
(12-Jul-2015) I added the HOL Explorer for Mario Carneiro's hol.mm database. Although the home page needs to be filled out, the proofs can be accessed.
(11-Jul-2015) I started a new page, Other Metamath-Related Topics, that will hold miscellaneous material that doesn't fit well elsewhere (or is hard to find on this site). Suggestions welcome.
(23-Jun-2015) Metamath's mascot, Penny the cat (2007 photo), passed away today. She was 18 years old.
(21-Jun-2015) Mario Carneiro added 3 new proofs to the 100 theorem list: All Primes (1 mod 4) Equal the Sum of Two Squares 2sq, The Law of Quadratic Reciprocity lgsquad and the AM-GM theorem amgm, bringing the Metamath total to 55.
(13-Jun-2015) Stefan O'Rear's smm, written in JavaScript, can now be used as a standalone proof verifier. This brings the total number of independent Metamath verifiers to 8, written in just as many languages (C, Java. JavaScript, Python, Haskell, Lua, C#, C++).
(12-Jun-2015) David A. Wheeler added 2 new proofs to the 100 theorem list: The Law of Cosines lawcos and Ptolemy's Theorem ptolemy, bringing the Metamath total to 52.
(30-May-2015) The metamath program has been updated to version 0.117. (1) David A. Wheeler provided an enhancement to speed up the 'improve' command by 28%; see README.TXT for more information. (2) In web pages with proofs, local hyperlinks on step hypotheses no longer clip the Expression cell at the top of the page.
(9-May-2015) Stefan O'Rear has created an archive of older set.mm releases back to 1998: https://github.com/sorear/set.mm-history/.
(7-May-2015) The set.mm dated 7-May-2015 is a major revision, updated by Mario, that incorporates the new ordered pair definition df-op that was agreed upon. There were 700 changes, listed at the top of set.mm. Mathbox users are advised to update their local mathboxes. As usual, if any mathbox user has trouble incorporating these changes into their mathbox in progress, Mario or I will be glad to do them for you.
(7-May-2015) Mario has added 4 new theorems to the 100 theorem list: Ramsey's Theorem ramsey, The Solution of a Cubic cubic, The Solution of the General Quartic Equation quart, and The Birthday Problem birthday. In the Supplementary List, Stefan O'Rear added the Hilbert Basis Theorem hbt.
(28-Apr-2015) A while ago, Mario Carneiro wrote up a proof of the unambiguity of set.mm's grammar, which has now been added to this site: grammar-ambiguity.txt.
(22-Apr-2015) The metamath program has been updated to version 0.114. In MM-PA, 'show new_proof/unknown' now shows the relative offset (-1, -2,...) used for 'assign' arguments, suggested by Stefan O'Rear.
(20-Apr-2015) I retrieved an old version of the missing "Metamath 100" page from archive.org and updated it to what I think is the current state: mm_100.html. Anyone who wants to edit it can email updates to this page to me.
(19-Apr-2015) The metamath program has been updated to version 0.113, mostly with patches provided by Stefan O'Rear. (1) 'show statement %' (or any command allowing label wildcards) will select statements whose proofs were changed in current session. ('help search' will show all wildcard matching rules.) (2) 'show statement =' will select the statement being proved in MM-PA. (3) The proof date stamp is now created only if the proof is complete.
(18-Apr-2015) There is now a section for Scott Fenton's NF database: New Foundations Explorer.
(16-Apr-2015) Mario describes his recent additions to set.mm at https://groups.google.com/forum/#!topic/metamath/VAGNmzFkHCs. It include 2 new additions to the Formalizing 100 Theorems list, Leibniz' series for pi (leibpi) and the Konigsberg Bridge problem (konigsberg)
(10-Mar-2015) Mario Carneiro has written a paper, "Arithmetic in Metamath, Case Study: Bertrand's Postulate," for CICM 2015. A preprint is available at arXiv:1503.02349.
(23-Feb-2015) Scott Fenton has created a Metamath formalization of NF set theory: https://github.com/sctfn/metamath-nf/. For more information, see the Metamath Google Group posting.
(28-Jan-2015) Mario Carneiro added Wilson's Theorem (wilth), Ascending or Descending Sequences (erdsze, erdsze2), and Derangements Formula (derangfmla, subfaclim), bringing the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 44.
(19-Jan-2015) Mario Carneiro added Sylow's Theorem (sylow1, sylow2, sylow2b, sylow3), bringing the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 41.
(9-Jan-2015) The hypothesis order of mpbi*an* was changed. See the Notes entry of 9-Jan-2015.
(1-Jan-2015) Mario Carneiro has written a paper, "Conversion of HOL Light proofs into Metamath," that has been submitted to the Journal of Formalized Reasoning. A preprint is available on arxiv.org.
(22-Nov-2014) Stefan O'Rear added the Solutions to Pell's Equation (rmxycomplete) and Liouville's Theorem and the Construction of Transcendental Numbers (aaliou), bringing the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 40.
(22-Nov-2014) The metamath program has been updated with version 0.111. (1) Label wildcards now have a label range indicator "~" so that e.g. you can show or search all of the statements in a mathbox. See 'help search'. (Stefan O'Rear added this to the program.) (2) A qualifier was added to 'minimize_with' to prevent the use of any axioms not already used in the proof e.g. 'minimize_with * /no_new_axioms_from ax-*' will prevent the use of ax-ac if the proof doesn't already use it. See 'help minimize_with'.
(10-Oct-2014) Mario Carneiro has encoded the axiomatic basis for the HOL theorem prover into a Metamath source file, hol.mm.
(24-Sep-2014) Mario Carneiro added the Sum of the Angles of a Triangle (ang180), bringing the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 38.
(15-Sep-2014) Mario Carneiro added the Fundamental Theorem of Algebra (fta), bringing the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 37.
(3-Sep-2014) Mario Carneiro added the Fundamental Theorem of Integral Calculus (ftc1, ftc2). This brings the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 35. (added 14-Sep-2014) Along the way, he added the Mean Value Theorem (mvth), bringing the total to 36.
(16-Aug-2014) Mario Carneiro started a Metamath blog at http://metamath-blog.blogspot.com/.
(10-Aug-2014) Mario Carneiro added Erdős's proof of the divergence of the inverse prime series (prmrec). This brings the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 34.
(31-Jul-2014) Mario Carneiro added proofs for Euler's Summation of 1 + (1/2)^2 + (1/3)^2 + .... (basel) and The Factor and Remainder Theorems (facth, plyrem). This brings the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 33.
(16-Jul-2014) Mario Carneiro added proofs for Four Squares Theorem (4sq), Formula for the Number of Combinations (hashbc), and Divisibility by 3 Rule (3dvds). This brings the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 31.
(11-Jul-2014) Mario Carneiro added proofs for Divergence of the Harmonic Series (harmonic), Order of a Subgroup (lagsubg), and Lebesgue Measure and Integration (itgcl). This brings the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 28.
(7-Jul-2014) Mario Carneiro presented a talk, "Natural Deduction in the Metamath Proof Language," at the 6PCM conference. Slides Audio
(25-Jun-2014) In version 0.108 of the metamath program, the 'minimize_with' command is now more automated. It now considers compressed proof length; it scans the statements in forward and reverse order and chooses the best; and it avoids $d conflicts. The '/no_distinct', '/brief', and '/reverse' qualifiers are obsolete, and '/verbose' no longer lists all statements scanned but gives more details about decision criteria.
(12-Jun-2014) To improve naming uniformity, theorems about operation values now use the abbreviation "ov". For example, df-opr, opreq1, oprabval5, and oprvres are now called df-ov, oveq1, ov5, and ovres respectively.
(11-Jun-2014) Mario Carneiro finished a major revision of set.mm. His notes are under the 11-Jun-2014 entry in the Notes
(4-Jun-2014) Mario Carneiro provided instructions and screenshots for syntax highlighting for the jEdit editor for use with Metamath and mmj2 source files.
(19-May-2014) Mario Carneiro added a feature to mmj2, in the build at
https://github.com/digama0/mmj2/raw/dev-build/mmj2jar/mmj2.jar, which
tests all but 5 definitions in set.mm for soundness. You can turn on
the test by adding
SetMMDefinitionsCheckWithExclusions,ax-*,df-bi,df-clab,df-cleq,df-clel,df-sbc
to your RunParms.txt file.
(17-May-2014) A number of labels were changed in set.mm, listed at the top of set.mm as usual. Note in particular that the heavily-used visset, elisseti, syl11anc, syl111anc were changed respectively to vex, elexi, syl2anc, syl3anc.
(16-May-2014) Scott Fenton formalized a proof for "Sum of kth powers": fsumkthpow. This brings the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 25.
(9-May-2014) I (Norm Megill) presented an overview of Metamath at the "Formalization of mathematics in proof assistants" workshop at the Institut Henri Poincar� in Paris. The slides for this talk are here.
(22-Jun-2014) Version 0.107 of the metamath program adds a "PART" indention level to the Statement List table of contents, adds 'show proof ... /size' to show source file bytes used, and adds 'show elapsed_time'. The last one is helpful for measuring the run time of long commands. See 'help write theorem_list', 'help show proof', and 'help show elapsed_time' for more information.
(2-May-2014) Scott Fenton formalized a proof of Sum of the Reciprocals of the Triangular Numbers: trirecip. This brings the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 24.
(19-Apr-2014) Scott Fenton formalized a proof of the Formula for Pythagorean Triples: pythagtrip. This brings the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 23.
(11-Apr-2014) David A. Wheeler produced a much-needed and well-done video for mmj2, called "Introduction to Metamath & mmj2". Thanks, David!
(15-Mar-2014) Mario Carneiro formalized a proof of Bertrand's postulate: bpos. This brings the Metamath total for Formalizing 100 Theorems to 22.
(18-Feb-2014) Mario Carneiro proved that complex number axiom ax-cnex is redundant (theorem cnex). See also Real and Complex Numbers.
(11-Feb-2014) David A. Wheeler has created a theorem compilation that tracks those theorems in Freek Wiedijk's Formalizing 100 Theorems list that have been proved in set.mm. If you find a error or omission in this list, let me know so it can be corrected. (Update 1-Mar-2014: Mario has added eulerth and bezout to the list.)
(4-Feb-2014) Mario Carneiro writes:
The latest commit on the mmj2 development branch introduced an exciting new feature, namely syntax highlighting for mmp files in the main window. (You can pick up the latest mmj2.jar at https://github.com/digama0/mmj2/blob/develop/mmj2jar/mmj2.jar .) The reason I am asking for your help at this stage is to help with design for the syntax tokenizer, which is responsible for breaking down the input into various tokens with names like "comment", "set", and "stephypref", which are then colored according to the user's preference. As users of mmj2 and metamath, what types of highlighting would be useful to you?One limitation of the tokenizer is that since (for performance reasons) it can be started at any line in the file, highly contextual coloring, like highlighting step references that don't exist previously in the file, is difficult to do. Similarly, true parsing of the formulas using the grammar is possible but likely to be unmanageably slow. But things like checking theorem labels against the database is quite simple to do under the current setup.
That said, how can this new feature be optimized to help you when writing proofs?
(13-Jan-2014) Mathbox users: the *19.21a*, *19.23a* series of theorems have been renamed to *alrim*, *exlim*. You can update your mathbox with a global replacement of string '19.21a' with 'alrim' and '19.23a' with 'exlim'.
(5-Jan-2014) If you downloaded mmj2 in the past 3 days, please update it with the current version, which fixes a bug introduced by the recent changes that made it unable to read in most of the proofs in the textarea properly.
(4-Jan-2014) I added a list of "Allowed substitutions" under the "Distinct variable groups" list on the theorem web pages, for example axsep. This is an experimental feature and comments are welcome.
(3-Jan-2014) Version 0.102 of the metamath program produces more space-efficient compressed proofs (still compatible with the specification in Appendix B of the Metamath book) using an algorithm suggested by Mario Carneiro. See 'help save proof' in the program. Also, mmj2 now generates proofs in the new format. The new mmj2 also has a mandatory update that fixes a bug related to the new format; you must update your mmj2 copy to use it with the latest set.mm.
(23-Dec-2013) Mario Carneiro has updated many older definitions to use the maps-to notation. If you have difficulty updating your local mathbox, contact him or me for assistance.
(1-Nov-2013) 'undo' and 'redo' commands were added to the Proof Assistant in metamath program version 0.07.99. See 'help undo' in the program.
(8-Oct-2013) Today's Notes entry describes some proof repair techniques.
(5-Oct-2013) Today's Notes entry explains some recent extensible structure improvements.
(8-Sep-2013) Mario Carneiro has revised the square root and sequence generator definitions. See today's Notes entry.
(3-Aug-2013) Mario Carneiro writes: "I finally found enough time to create a GitHub repository for development at https://github.com/digama0/mmj2. A permalink to the latest version plus source (akin to mmj2.zip) is https://github.com/digama0/mmj2/zipball/, and the jar file on its own (mmj2.jar) is at https://github.com/digama0/mmj2/blob/master/mmj2jar/mmj2.jar?raw=true. Unfortunately there is no easy way to automatically generate mmj2jar.zip, but this is available as part of the zip distribution for mmj2.zip. History tracking will be handled by the repository now. Do you have old versions of the mmj2 directory? I could add them as historical commits if you do."
(18-Jun-2013) Mario Carneiro has done a major revision and cleanup of the construction of real and complex numbers. In particular, rather than using equivalence classes as is customary for the construction of the temporary rationals, he used only "reduced fractions", so that the use of the axiom of infinity is avoided until it becomes necessary for the construction of the temporary reals.
(18-May-2013) Mario Carneiro has added the ability to produce compressed proofs to mmj2. This is not an official release but can be downloaded here if you want to try it: mmj2.jar. If you have any feedback, send it to me (NM), and I will forward it to Mario. (Disclaimer: this release has not been endorsed by Mel O'Cat. If anyone has been in contact with him, please let me know.)
(29-Mar-2013) Charles Greathouse reduced the size of our PNG symbol images using the pngout program.
(8-Mar-2013) Wolf Lammen has reorganized the theorems in the "Logical negation" section of set.mm into a more orderly, less scattered arrangement.
(27-Feb-2013) Scott Fenton has done a large cleanup of set.mm, eliminating *OLD references in 144 proofs. See the Notes entry for 27-Feb-2013.
(21-Feb-2013) *ATTENTION MATHBOX USERS* The order of hypotheses of many syl* theorems were changed, per a suggestion of Mario Carneiro. You need to update your local mathbox copy for compatibility with the new set.mm, or I can do it for you if you wish. See the Notes entry for 21-Feb-2013.
(16-Feb-2013) Scott Fenton shortened the direct-from-axiom proofs of *3.1, *3.43, *4.4, *4.41, *4.5, *4.76, *4.83, *5.33, *5.35, *5.36, and meredith in the "Shortest known proofs of the propositional calculus theorems from Principia Mathematica" (pmproofs.txt).
(27-Jan-2013) Scott Fenton writes, "I've updated Ralph Levien's mmverify.py. It's now a Python 3 program, and supports compressed proofs and file inclusion statements. This adds about fifty lines to the original program. Enjoy!"
(10-Jan-2013) A new mathbox was added for Mario Carneiro, who has contributed a number of cardinality theorems without invoking the Axiom of Choice. This is nice work, and I will be using some of these (those suffixed with "NEW") to replace the existing ones in the main part of set.mm that currently invoke AC unnecessarily.
(4-Jan-2013) As mentioned in the 19-Jun-2012 item below, Eric Schmidt discovered that the complex number axioms axaddcom (now addcom) and ax0id (now addid1) are redundant (schmidt-cnaxioms.pdf, .tex). In addition, ax1id (now mulid1) can be weakened to ax1rid. Scott Fenton has now formalized this work, so that now there are 23 instead of 25 axioms for real and complex numbers in set.mm. The Axioms for Complex Numbers page has been updated with these results. An interesting part of the proof, showing how commutativity of addition follows from other laws, is in addcomi.
(27-Nov-2012) The frequently-used theorems "an1s", "an1rs", "ancom13s", "ancom31s" were renamed to "an12s", "an32s", "an13s", "an31s" to conform to the convention for an12 etc.
(4-Nov-2012) The changes proposed in the Notes, renaming Grp to GrpOp etc., have been incorporated into set.mm. See the list of changes at the top of set.mm. If you want me to update your mathbox with these changes, send it to me along with the version of set.mm that it works with.
(20-Sep-2012) Mel O'Cat updated https://us.metamath.org/ocat/mmj2/TESTmmj2jar.zip. See the README.TXT for a description of the new features.
(21-Aug-2012) Mel O'Cat has uploaded SearchOptionsMockup9.zip, a mockup for the new search screen in mmj2. See the README.txt file for instructions. He will welcome feedback via x178g243 at yahoo.com.
(19-Jun-2012) Eric Schmidt has discovered that in our axioms for complex numbers, axaddcom and ax0id are redundant. (At some point these need to be formalized for set.mm.) He has written up these and some other nice results, including some independence results for the axioms, in schmidt-cnaxioms.pdf (schmidt-cnaxioms.tex).
(23-Apr-2012) Frédéric Liné sent me a PDF (LaTeX source) developed with Lamport's pf2 package. He wrote: "I think it works well with Metamath since the proofs are in a tree form. I use it to have a sketch of a proof. I get this way a better understanding of the proof and I can cut down its size. For instance, inpreima5 was reduced by 50% when I wrote the corresponding proof with pf2."
(5-Mar-2012) I added links to Wikiproofs and its recent changes in the "Wikis" list at the top of this page.
(12-Jan-2012) Thanks to William Hoza who sent me a ZFC T-shirt, and thanks to the ZFC models (courtesy of the Inaccessible Cardinals agency).
| Front | Back | Detail |
|
|
|
|
(24-Nov-2011) In metamath program version 0.07.71, the 'minimize_with' command by default now scans from bottom to top instead of top to bottom, since empirically this often (although not always) results in a shorter proof. A top to bottom scan can be specified with a new qualifier '/reverse'. You can try both methods (starting from the same original proof, of course) and pick the shorter proof.
(15-Oct-2011) From Mel O'Cat:
I just uploaded mmj2.zip containing the 1-Nov-2011 (20111101)
release:
https://us.metamath.org/ocat/mmj2/mmj2.zip
https://us.metamath.org/ocat/mmj2/mmj2.md5
A few last minute tweaks:
1. I now bless double-click starting of mmj2.bat (MacMMJ2.command in Mac OS-X)!
See mmj2\QuickStart.html
2. Much improved support of Mac OS-X systems.
See mmj2\QuickStart.html
3. I tweaked the Command Line Argument Options report to
a) print every time;
b) print as much as possible even if
there are errors in the command line arguments -- and the
last line printed corresponds to the argument in error;
c) removed Y/N argument on the command line to enable/disable
the report. this simplifies things.
4) Documentation revised, including the PATutorial.
See CHGLOG.TXT for list of all changes.
Good luck. And thanks for all of your help!
(15-Sep-2011) MATHBOX USERS: I made a large number of label name changes to set.mm to improve naming consistency. There is a script at the top of the current set.mm that you can use to update your mathbox or older set.mm. Or if you wish, I can do the update on your next mathbox submission - in that case, please include a .zip of the set.mm version you used.
(30-Aug-2011) Scott Fenton shortened the direct-from-axiom proofs of *3.33, *3.45, *4.36, and meredith in the "Shortest known proofs of the propositional calculus theorems from Principia Mathematica" (pmproofs.txt).
(21-Aug-2011) A post on reddit generated 60,000 hits (and a TOS violation notice from my provider...),
(18-Aug-2011) The Metamath Google Group has a discussion of my canonical conjunctions proposal. Any feedback directly to me (Norm Megill) is also welcome.
(4-Jul-2011) John Baker has provided (metamath_kindle.zip) "a modified version of [the] metamath.tex [Metamath] book source that is formatted for the Kindle. If you compile the document the resulting PDF can be loaded into into a Kindle and easily read." (Update: the PDF file is now included also.)
(3-Jul-2011) Nested 'submit' calls are now allowed, in metamath program version 0.07.68. Thus you can create or modify a command file (script) from within a command file then 'submit' it. While 'submit' cannot pass arguments (nor are there plans to add this feature), you can 'substitute' strings in the 'submit' target file before calling it in order to emulate this.
(28-Jun-2011)The metamath program version 0.07.64 adds the '/include_mathboxes' qualifier to 'minimize_with'; by default, 'minimize_with *' will now skip checking user mathboxes. Since mathboxes should be independent from each other, this will help prevent accidental cross-"contamination". Also, '/rewrap' was added to 'write source' to automatically wrap $a and $p comments so as to conform to the current formatting conventions used in set.mm. This means you no longer have to be concerned about line length < 80 etc.
(19-Jun-2011) ATTENTION MATHBOX USERS: The wff variables et, ze, si, and rh are now global. This change was made primarily to resolve some conflicts between mathboxes, but it will also let you avoid having to constantly redeclare these locally in the future. Unfortunately, this change can affect the $f hypothesis order, which can cause proofs referencing theorems that use these variables to fail. All mathbox proofs currently in set.mm have been corrected for this, and you should refresh your local copy for further development of your mathbox. You can correct your proofs that are not in set.mm as follows. Only the proofs that fail under the current set.mm (using version 0.07.62 or later of the metamath program) need to be modified.
To fix a proof that references earlier theorems using et, ze, si, and rh, do the following (using a hypothetical theorem 'abc' as an example): 'prove abc' (ignore error messages), 'delete floating', 'initialize all', 'unify all/interactive', 'improve all', 'save new_proof/compressed'. If your proof uses dummy variables, these must be reassigned manually.
To fix a proof that uses et, ze, si, and rh as local variables, make sure the proof is saved in 'compressed' format. Then delete the local declarations ($v and $f statements) and follow the same steps above to correct the proof.
I apologize for the inconvenience. If you have trouble fixing your proofs, you can contact me for assistance.
Note: Versions of the metamath program before 0.07.62 did not flag an error when global variables were redeclared locally, as it should have according to the spec. This caused these spec violations to go unnoticed in some older set.mm versions. The new error messages are in fact just informational and can be ignored when working with older set.mm versions.
(7-Jun-2011) The metamath program version 0.07.60 fixes a bug with the 'minimize_with' command found by Andrew Salmon.
(12-May-2010) Andrew Salmon shortened many proofs, shown above. For comparison, I have temporarily kept the old version, which is suffixed with OLD, such as oridmOLD for oridm.
(9-Dec-2010) Eric Schmidt has written a Metamath proof verifier in C++, called checkmm.cpp.
(3-Oct-2010) The following changes were made to the tokens in set.mm. The subset and proper subset symbol changes to C_ and C. were made to prevent defeating the parenthesis matching in Emacs. Other changes were made so that all letters a-z and A-Z are now available for variable names. One-letter constants such as _V, _e, and _i are now shown on the web pages with Roman instead of italic font, to disambiguate italic variable names. The new convention is that a prefix of _ indicates Roman font and a prefix of ~ indicates a script (curly) font. Thanks to Stefan Allan and Frédéric Liné for discussions leading to this change.
| Old | New | Description |
|---|---|---|
| C. | _C | binomial coefficient |
| E | _E | epsilon relation |
| e | _e | Euler's constant |
| I | _I | identity relation |
| i | _i | imaginary unit |
| V | _V | universal class |
| (_ | C_ | subset |
| (. | C. | proper subset |
| P~ | ~P | power class |
| H~ | ~H | Hilbert space |
(25-Sep-2010) The metamath program (version 0.07.54) now implements the current Metamath spec, so footnote 2 on p. 92 of the Metamath book can be ignored.
(24-Sep-2010) The metamath program (version 0.07.53) fixes bug 2106, reported by Michal Burger.
(14-Sep-2010) The metamath program (version 0.07.52) has a revamped LaTeX output with 'show statement xxx /tex', which produces the combined statement, description, and proof similar to the web page generation. Also, 'show proof xxx /lemmon/renumber' now matches the web page step numbers. ('show proof xxx/renumber' still has the indented form conforming to the actual RPN proof, with slightly different numbering.)
(9-Sep-2010) The metamath program (version 0.07.51) was updated with a modification by Stefan Allan that adds hyperlinks the the Ref column of proofs.
(12-Jun-2010) Scott Fenton contributed a D-proof (directly from axioms) of Meredith's single axiom (see the end of pmproofs.txt). A description of Meredith's axiom can be found in theorem meredith.
(11-Jun-2010) A new Metamath mirror was added in Austria, courtesy of Kinder-Enduro.
(28-Feb-2010) Raph Levien's Ghilbert project now has a new Ghilbert site and a Google Group.
(26-Jan-2010) Dmitri Vlasov writes, "I admire the simplicity and power of the metamath language, but still I see its great disadvantage - the proofs in metamath are completely non-manageable by humans without proof assistants. Therefore I decided to develop another language, which would be a higher-level superstructure language towards metamath, and which will support human-readable/writable proofs directly, without proof assistants. I call this language mdl (acronym for 'mathematics development language')." The latest version of Dmitri's translators from metamath to mdl and back can be downloaded from http://mathdevlanguage.sourceforge.net/. Currently only Linux is supported, but Dmitri says is should not be difficult to port it to other platforms that have a g++ compiler.
(11-Sep-2009) The metamath program (version 0.07.48) has been updated to enforce the whitespace requirement of the current spec.
(10-Sep-2009) Matthew Leitch has written an nice article, "How to write mathematics clearly", that briefly mentions Metamath. Overall it makes some excellent points. (I have written to him about a few things I disagree with.)
(28-May-2009) AsteroidMeta is back on-line. Note the URL change.
(12-May-2009) Charles Greathouse wrote a Greasemonkey script to reformat the axiom list on Metamath web site proof pages. This is a beta version; he will appreciate feedback.
(11-May-2009) Stefan Allan modified the metamath program to add the command "show statement xxx /mnemonics", which produces the output file Mnemosyne.txt for use with the Mnemosyne project. The current Metamath program download incorporates this command. Instructions: Create the file mnemosyne.txt with e.g. "show statement ax-* /mnemonics". In the Mnemosyne program, load the file by choosing File->Import then file format "Q and A on separate lines". Notes: (1) Don't try to load all of set.mm, it will crash the program due to a bug in Mnemosyne. (2) On my computer, the arrows in ax-1 don't display. Stefan reports that they do on his computer. (Both are Windows XP.)
(3-May-2009) Steven Baldasty wrote a Metamath syntax highlighting file for the gedit editor. Screenshot.
(1-May-2009) Users on a gaming forum discuss our 2+2=4 proof. Notable comments include "Ew math!" and "Whoever wrote this has absolutely no life."
(12-Mar-2009) Chris Capel has created a Javascript theorem viewer demo that (1) shows substitutions and (2) allows expanding and collapsing proof steps. You are invited to take a look and give him feedback at his Metablog.
(28-Feb-2009) Chris Capel has written a Metamath proof verifier in C#, available at http://pdf23ds.net/bzr/MathEditor/Verifier/Verifier.cs and weighing in at 550 lines. Also, that same URL without the file on it is a Bazaar repository.
(2-Dec-2008) A new section was added to the Deduction Theorem page, called Logic, Metalogic, Metametalogic, and Metametametalogic.
(24-Aug-2008) (From ocat): The 1-Aug-2008 version of mmj2 is ready (mmj2.zip), size = 1,534,041 bytes. This version contains the Theorem Loader enhancement which provides a "sandboxing" capability for user theorems and dynamic update of new theorems to the Metamath database already loaded in memory by mmj2. Also, the new "mmj2 Service" feature enables calling mmj2 as a subroutine, or having mmj2 call your program, and provides access to the mmj2 data structures and objects loaded in memory (i.e. get started writing those Jython programs!) See also mmj2 on AsteroidMeta.
(23-May-2008) Gérard Lang pointed me to Bob Solovay's note on AC and strongly inaccessible cardinals. One of the eventual goals for set.mm is to prove the Axiom of Choice from Grothendieck's axiom, like Mizar does, and this note may be helpful for anyone wanting to attempt that. Separately, I also came across a history of the size reduction of grothprim (viewable in Firefox and some versions of Internet Explorer).
(14-Apr-2008) A "/join" qualifier was added to the "search" command in the metamath program (version 0.07.37). This qualifier will join the $e hypotheses to the $a or $p for searching, so that math tokens in the $e's can be matched as well. For example, "search *com* +v" produces no results, but "search *com* +v /join" yields commutative laws involving vector addition. Thanks to Stefan Allan for suggesting this idea.
(8-Apr-2008) The 8,000th theorem, hlrel, was added to the Metamath Proof Explorer part of the database.
(2-Mar-2008) I added a small section to the end of the Deduction Theorem page.
(17-Feb-2008) ocat has uploaded the "1-Mar-2008" mmj2: mmj2.zip. See the description.
(16-Jan-2008) O'Cat has written mmj2 Proof Assistant Quick Tips.
(30-Dec-2007) "How to build a library of formalized mathematics".
(22-Dec-2007) The Metamath Proof Explorer was included in the top 30 science resources for 2007 by the University at Albany Science Library.
(17-Dec-2007) Metamath's Wikipedia entry says, "This article may require cleanup to meet Wikipedia's quality standards" (see its discussion page). Volunteers are welcome. :) (In the interest of objectivity, I don't edit this entry.)
(20-Nov-2007) Jeff Hoffman created nicod.mm and posted it to the Google Metamath Group.
(19-Nov-2007) Reinder Verlinde suggested adding tooltips to the hyperlinks on the proof pages, which I did for proof step hyperlinks. Discussion.
(5-Nov-2007) A Usenet challenge. :)
(4-Aug-2007) I added a "Request for comments on proposed 'maps to' notation" at the bottom of the AsteroidMeta set.mm discussion page.
(21-Jun-2007) A preprint (PDF file) describing Kurt Maes' axiom of choice with 5 quantifiers, proved in set.mm as ackm.
(20-Jun-2007) The 7,000th theorem, ifpr, was added to the Metamath Proof Explorer part of the database.
(29-Apr-2007) Blog mentions of Metamath: here and here.
(21-Mar-2007) Paul Chapman is working on a new proof browser, which has highlighting that allows you to see the referenced theorem before and after the substitution was made. Here is a screenshot of theorem 0nn0 and a screenshot of theorem 2p2e4.
(15-Mar-2007) A picture of Penny the cat guarding the us.metamath.org server and making the rounds.
(16-Feb-2007) For convenience, the program "drule.c" (pronounced "D-rule", not "drool") mentioned in pmproofs.txt can now be downloaded (drule.c) without having to ask me for it. The same disclaimer applies: even though this program works and has no known bugs, it was not intended for general release. Read the comments at the top of the program for instructions.
(28-Jan-2007) Jason Orendorff set up a new mailing list for Metamath: http://groups.google.com/group/metamath.
(20-Jan-2007) Bob Solovay provided a revised version of his Metamath database for Peano arithmetic, peano.mm.
(2-Jan-2007) Raph Levien has set up a wiki called Barghest for the Ghilbert language and software.
(26-Dec-2006) I posted an explanation of theorem ecoprass on Usenet.
(2-Dec-2006) Berislav Žarnić translated the Metamath Solitaire applet to Croatian.
(26-Nov-2006) Dan Getz has created an RSS feed for new theorems as they appear on this page.
(6-Nov-2006) The first 3 paragraphs in Appendix 2: Note on the Axioms were rewritten to clarify the connection between Tarski's axiom system and Metamath.
(31-Oct-2006) ocat asked for a do-over due to a bug in mmj2 -- if you downloaded the mmj2.zip version dated 10/28/2006, then download the new version dated 10/30.
(29-Oct-2006) ocat has announced that the
long-awaited 1-Nov-2006 release of mmj2 is available now.
The new "Unify+Get Hints" is quite
useful, and any proof can be generated as follows. With "?" in the Hyp
field and Ref field blank, select "Unify+Get Hints". Select a hint from
the list and put it in the Ref field. Edit any $n dummy variables to
become the desired wffs. Rinse and repeat for the new proof steps
generated, until the proof is done.
The new tutorial, mmj2PATutorial.bat,
explains this in detail. One way to reduce or avoid dummy $n's is to
fill in the Hyp field with a comma-separated list of any known
hypothesis matches to earlier proof steps, keeping a "?" in the list to
indicate that the remaining hypotheses are unknown. Then "Unify+Get
Hints" can be applied. The tutorial page
\mmj2\data\mmp\PATutorial\Page405.mmp has an example.
Don't forget that the eimm
export/import program lets you go back and forth between the mmj2 and
the metamath program proof assistants, without exiting from either one,
to exploit the best features of each as required.
(21-Oct-2006) Martin Kiselkov has written a Metamath proof verifier in the Lua scripting language, called verify.lua. While it is not practical as an everyday verifier - he writes that it takes about 40 minutes to verify set.mm on a a Pentium 4 - it could be useful to someone learning Lua or Metamath, and importantly it provides another independent way of verifying the correctness of Metamath proofs. His code looks like it is nicely structured and very readable. He is currently working on a faster version in C++.
(19-Oct-2006) New AsteroidMeta page by Raph, Distinctors_vs_binders.
(13-Oct-2006) I put a simple Metamath browser on my PDA (Palm Tungsten E) so that I don't have to lug around my laptop. Here is a screenshot. It isn't polished, but I'll provide the file + instructions if anyone wants it.
(3-Oct-2006) A blog entry, Principia for Reverse Mathematics.
(28-Sep-2006) A blog entry, Metamath responds.
(26-Sep-2006) A blog entry, Metamath isn't hygienic.
(11-Aug-2006) A blog entry, Metamath and the Peano Induction Axiom.
(26-Jul-2006) A new open problem in predicate calculus was added.
(18-Jun-2006) The 6,000th theorem, mt4d, was added to the Metamath Proof Explorer part of the database.
(9-May-2006) Luca Ciciriello has upgraded the t2mf program, which is a C
program used to create the MIDI files on the
Metamath Music Page, so
that it works on MacOS X. This is a nice accomplishment, since the
original program was written before C was standardized by ANSI and will
not compile on modern compilers.
Unfortunately, the original program source states no copyright terms.
The main author, Tim Thompson, has kindly agreed to release his code to
public domain, but two other authors have also contributed to the code,
and so far I have been unable to contact them for copyright clearance.
Therefore I cannot offer the MacOS X version for public download on this
site until this is resolved. Update 10-May-2006: Another author,
M. Czeiszperger, has released his contribution to public domain.
If you are interested in Luca's modified source code,
please contact me directly.
(18-Apr-2006) Incomplete proofs in progress can now be interchanged between the Metamath program's CLI Proof Assistant and mmj2's GUI Proof Assistant, using a new export-import program called eimm. This can be done without exiting either proof assistant, so that the strengths of each approach can be exploited during proof development. See "Use Case 5a" and "Use Case 5b" at mmj2ProofAssistantFeedback.
(28-Mar-2006) Scott Fenton updated his second version of Metamath Solitaire (the one that uses external axioms). He writes: "I've switched to making it a standalone program, as it seems silly to have an applet that can't be run in a web browser. Check the README file for further info." The download is mmsol-0.5.tar.gz.
(27-Mar-2006) Scott Fenton has updated the Metamath Solitaire Java
applet to Java 1.5: (1) QSort has been stripped out: its functionality
is in the Collections class that Sun ships; (2) all Vectors have been
replaced by ArrayLists; (3) generic types have been tossed in wherever
they fit: this cuts back drastically on casting; and (4) any warnings
Eclipse spouted out have been dealt with. I haven't yet updated it
officially, because I don't know if it will work with Microsoft's JVM in
older versions of Internet Explorer. The current official version is
compiled with Java 1.3, because it won't work with Microsoft's JVM if it
is compiled with Java 1.4. (As distasteful as that seems,
I will get complaints from users if it
doesn't work with Microsoft's JVM.) If anyone can verify that Scott's new
version runs on Microsoft's JVM, I would be grateful. Scott's new
version is mm.java-1.5.gz; after
uncompressing it, rename it to mm.java,
use it to replace the existing mm.java file in the
Metamath Solitaire download, and recompile according to instructions
in the mm.java comments.
Scott has also created a second version, mmsol-0.2.tar.gz, that reads
the axioms from ASCII files, instead of having the axioms hard-coded in
the program. This can be very useful if you want to play with custom
axioms, and you can also add a collection of starting theorems as
"axioms" to work from. However, it must be run from the local directory
with appletviewer, since the default Java security model doesn't allow
reading files from a browser. It works with the JDK 5 Update 6
Java download.
To compile (from Windows Command Prompt): C:\Program
Files\Java\jdk1.5.0_06\bin\javac.exe mm.java
To run (from Windows Command Prompt): C:\Program
Files\Java\jdk1.5.0_06\bin\appletviewer.exe mms.html
(21-Jan-2006) Juha Arpiainen proved the independence of axiom ax-11 from the others. This was published as an open problem in my 1995 paper (Remark 9.5 on PDF page 17). See Item 9a on the Workshop Miscellany for his seven-line proof. See also the Asteroid Meta metamathMathQuestions page under the heading "Axiom of variable substitution: ax-11". Congratulations, Juha!
(20-Oct-2005) Juha Arpiainen is working on a proof verifier in Common Lisp called Bourbaki. Its proof language has its roots in Metamath, with the goal of providing a more powerful syntax and definitional soundness checking. See its documentation and related discussion.
(17-Oct-2005) Marnix Klooster has written a Metamath proof verifier in Haskell, called Hmm. Also see his Announcement. The complete program (Hmm.hs, HmmImpl.hs, and HmmVerify.hs) has only 444 lines of code, excluding comments and blank lines. It verifies compressed as well as regular proofs; moreover, it transparently verifies both per-spec compressed proofs and the flawed format he uncovered (see comment below of 16-Oct-05).
(16-Oct-2005) Marnix Klooster noticed that for large proofs, the compressed proof format did not match the spec in the book. His algorithm to correct the problem has been put into the Metamath program (version 0.07.6). The program still verifies older proofs with the incorrect format, but the user will be nagged to update them with 'save proof *'. In set.mm, 285 out of 6376 proofs are affected. (The incorrect format did not affect proof correctness or verification, since the compression and decompression algorithms matched each other.)
(13-Sep-2005) Scott Fenton found an interesting axiom, ax46, which could be used to replace both ax-4 and ax-6.
(29-Jul-2005) Metamath was selected as site of the week by American Scientist Online.
(8-Jul-2005) Roy Longton has contributed 53 new theorems to the Quantum Logic Explorer. You can see them in the Theorem List starting at lem3.3.3lem1. He writes, "If you want, you can post an open challenge to see if anyone can find shorter proofs of the theorems I submitted."
(10-May-2005) A Usenet post I posted about the infinite prime proof; another one about indexed unions.
(3-May-2005) The theorem divexpt is the 5,000th theorem added to the Metamath Proof Explorer database.
(12-Apr-2005) Raph Levien solved the open problem in item 16 on the Workshop Miscellany page and as a corollary proved that axiom ax-9 is independent from the other axioms of predicate calculus and equality. This is the first such independence proof so far; a goal is to prove all of them independent (or to derive any redundant ones from the others).
(8-Mar-2005) I added a paragraph above our complex number axioms table, summarizing the construction and indicating where Dedekind cuts are defined. Thanks to Andrew Buhr for comments on this.
(16-Feb-2005) The Metamath Music Page is mentioned as a reference or resource for a university course called Math, Mind, and Music. .
(28-Jan-2005) Steven Cullinane parodied the Metamath Music Page in his blog.
(18-Jan-2005) Waldek Hebisch upgraded the Metamath program to run on the AMD64 64-bit processor.
(17-Jan-2005) A symbol list summary was added to the beginning of the Hilbert Space Explorer Home Page. Thanks to Mladen Pavicic for suggesting this.
(6-Jan-2005) Someone assembled an amazon.com list of some of the books in the Metamath Proof Explorer Bibliography.
(4-Jan-2005) The definition of ordinal exponentiation was decided on after this Usenet discussion.
(19-Dec-2004) A bit of trivia: my Erdös number is 2, as you can see from this list.
(20-Oct-2004) I started this Usenet discussion about the "reals are uncountable" proof (127 comments; last one on Nov. 12).
(12-Oct-2004) gch-kn shows the equivalence of the Generalized Continuum Hypothesis and Prof. Nambiar's Axiom of Combinatorial Sets. This proof answers his Open Problem 2 (PDF file).
(5-Aug-2004) I gave a talk on "Hilbert Lattice Equations" at the Argonne workshop.
(25-Jul-2004) The theorem nthruz is the 4,000th theorem added to the Metamath Proof Explorer database.
(27-May-2004) Josiah Burroughs contributed the proofs u1lemn1b, u1lem3var1, oi3oa3lem1, and oi3oa3 to the Quantum Logic Explorer database ql.mm.
(23-May-2004) Some minor typos found by Josh Purinton were corrected in the Metamath book. In addition, Josh simplified the definition of the closure of a pre-statement of a formal system in Appendix C.
(5-May-2004) Gregory Bush has found shorter proofs for 67 of the 193 propositional calculus theorems listed in Principia Mathematica, thus establishing 67 new records. (This was challenge #4 on the open problems page.)
| Copyright terms: Public domain | W3C HTML validation [external] |